1 # This file was created automatically by SWIG.
2 # Don't modify this file, modify the SWIG interface instead.
6 def _swig_setattr_nondynamic(self
,class_type
,name
,value
,static
=1):
8 if isinstance(value
, class_type
):
9 self
.__dict
__[name
] = value
.this
10 if hasattr(value
,"thisown"): self
.__dict
__["thisown"] = value
.thisown
13 method
= class_type
.__swig
_setmethods
__.get(name
,None)
14 if method
: return method(self
,value
)
15 if (not static
) or hasattr(self
,name
) or (name
== "thisown"):
16 self
.__dict
__[name
] = value
18 raise AttributeError("You cannot add attributes to %s" % self
)
20 def _swig_setattr(self
,class_type
,name
,value
):
21 return _swig_setattr_nondynamic(self
,class_type
,name
,value
,0)
23 def _swig_getattr(self
,class_type
,name
):
24 method
= class_type
.__swig
_getmethods
__.get(name
,None)
25 if method
: return method(self
)
26 raise AttributeError,name
30 _object
= types
.ObjectType
32 except AttributeError:
38 def _swig_setattr_nondynamic_method(set):
39 def set_attr(self
,name
,value
):
40 if hasattr(self
,name
) or (name
in ("this", "thisown")):
43 raise AttributeError("You cannot add attributes to %s" % self
)
47 #// Give a reference to the dictionary of this module to the C++ extension
49 _core_
._wxPySetDictionary
(vars())
51 #// A little trick to make 'wx' be a reference to this module so wx.Names can
54 wx
= _sys
.modules
[__name__
]
57 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
59 def _deprecated(callable, msg
=None):
61 Create a wrapper function that will raise a DeprecationWarning
62 before calling the callable.
65 msg
= "%s is deprecated" % callable
66 def deprecatedWrapper(*args
, **kwargs
):
68 warnings
.warn(msg
, DeprecationWarning, stacklevel
=2)
69 return callable(*args
, **kwargs
)
70 deprecatedWrapper
.__doc
__ = msg
71 return deprecatedWrapper
74 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
76 NOT_FOUND
= _core_
.NOT_FOUND
77 VSCROLL
= _core_
.VSCROLL
78 HSCROLL
= _core_
.HSCROLL
79 CAPTION
= _core_
.CAPTION
80 DOUBLE_BORDER
= _core_
.DOUBLE_BORDER
81 SUNKEN_BORDER
= _core_
.SUNKEN_BORDER
82 RAISED_BORDER
= _core_
.RAISED_BORDER
83 BORDER
= _core_
.BORDER
84 SIMPLE_BORDER
= _core_
.SIMPLE_BORDER
85 STATIC_BORDER
= _core_
.STATIC_BORDER
86 TRANSPARENT_WINDOW
= _core_
.TRANSPARENT_WINDOW
87 NO_BORDER
= _core_
.NO_BORDER
88 DEFAULT_CONTROL_BORDER
= _core_
.DEFAULT_CONTROL_BORDER
89 DEFAULT_STATUSBAR_STYLE
= _core_
.DEFAULT_STATUSBAR_STYLE
90 TAB_TRAVERSAL
= _core_
.TAB_TRAVERSAL
91 WANTS_CHARS
= _core_
.WANTS_CHARS
92 POPUP_WINDOW
= _core_
.POPUP_WINDOW
93 CENTER_FRAME
= _core_
.CENTER_FRAME
94 CENTRE_ON_SCREEN
= _core_
.CENTRE_ON_SCREEN
95 CENTER_ON_SCREEN
= _core_
.CENTER_ON_SCREEN
96 CLIP_CHILDREN
= _core_
.CLIP_CHILDREN
97 CLIP_SIBLINGS
= _core_
.CLIP_SIBLINGS
98 ALWAYS_SHOW_SB
= _core_
.ALWAYS_SHOW_SB
99 RETAINED
= _core_
.RETAINED
100 BACKINGSTORE
= _core_
.BACKINGSTORE
101 COLOURED
= _core_
.COLOURED
102 FIXED_LENGTH
= _core_
.FIXED_LENGTH
103 LB_NEEDED_SB
= _core_
.LB_NEEDED_SB
104 LB_ALWAYS_SB
= _core_
.LB_ALWAYS_SB
105 LB_SORT
= _core_
.LB_SORT
106 LB_SINGLE
= _core_
.LB_SINGLE
107 LB_MULTIPLE
= _core_
.LB_MULTIPLE
108 LB_EXTENDED
= _core_
.LB_EXTENDED
109 LB_OWNERDRAW
= _core_
.LB_OWNERDRAW
110 LB_HSCROLL
= _core_
.LB_HSCROLL
111 PROCESS_ENTER
= _core_
.PROCESS_ENTER
112 PASSWORD
= _core_
.PASSWORD
113 CB_SIMPLE
= _core_
.CB_SIMPLE
114 CB_DROPDOWN
= _core_
.CB_DROPDOWN
115 CB_SORT
= _core_
.CB_SORT
116 CB_READONLY
= _core_
.CB_READONLY
117 RA_HORIZONTAL
= _core_
.RA_HORIZONTAL
118 RA_VERTICAL
= _core_
.RA_VERTICAL
119 RA_SPECIFY_ROWS
= _core_
.RA_SPECIFY_ROWS
120 RA_SPECIFY_COLS
= _core_
.RA_SPECIFY_COLS
121 RA_USE_CHECKBOX
= _core_
.RA_USE_CHECKBOX
122 RB_GROUP
= _core_
.RB_GROUP
123 RB_SINGLE
= _core_
.RB_SINGLE
124 SB_HORIZONTAL
= _core_
.SB_HORIZONTAL
125 SB_VERTICAL
= _core_
.SB_VERTICAL
126 RB_USE_CHECKBOX
= _core_
.RB_USE_CHECKBOX
127 ST_SIZEGRIP
= _core_
.ST_SIZEGRIP
128 ST_NO_AUTORESIZE
= _core_
.ST_NO_AUTORESIZE
129 FLOOD_SURFACE
= _core_
.FLOOD_SURFACE
130 FLOOD_BORDER
= _core_
.FLOOD_BORDER
131 ODDEVEN_RULE
= _core_
.ODDEVEN_RULE
132 WINDING_RULE
= _core_
.WINDING_RULE
133 TOOL_TOP
= _core_
.TOOL_TOP
134 TOOL_BOTTOM
= _core_
.TOOL_BOTTOM
135 TOOL_LEFT
= _core_
.TOOL_LEFT
136 TOOL_RIGHT
= _core_
.TOOL_RIGHT
138 YES_NO
= _core_
.YES_NO
139 CANCEL
= _core_
.CANCEL
142 NO_DEFAULT
= _core_
.NO_DEFAULT
143 YES_DEFAULT
= _core_
.YES_DEFAULT
144 ICON_EXCLAMATION
= _core_
.ICON_EXCLAMATION
145 ICON_HAND
= _core_
.ICON_HAND
146 ICON_QUESTION
= _core_
.ICON_QUESTION
147 ICON_INFORMATION
= _core_
.ICON_INFORMATION
148 ICON_STOP
= _core_
.ICON_STOP
149 ICON_ASTERISK
= _core_
.ICON_ASTERISK
150 ICON_MASK
= _core_
.ICON_MASK
151 ICON_WARNING
= _core_
.ICON_WARNING
152 ICON_ERROR
= _core_
.ICON_ERROR
153 FORWARD
= _core_
.FORWARD
154 BACKWARD
= _core_
.BACKWARD
159 SIZE_AUTO_WIDTH
= _core_
.SIZE_AUTO_WIDTH
160 SIZE_AUTO_HEIGHT
= _core_
.SIZE_AUTO_HEIGHT
161 SIZE_AUTO
= _core_
.SIZE_AUTO
162 SIZE_USE_EXISTING
= _core_
.SIZE_USE_EXISTING
163 SIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE
= _core_
.SIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE
164 SIZE_FORCE
= _core_
.SIZE_FORCE
165 PORTRAIT
= _core_
.PORTRAIT
166 LANDSCAPE
= _core_
.LANDSCAPE
167 PRINT_QUALITY_HIGH
= _core_
.PRINT_QUALITY_HIGH
168 PRINT_QUALITY_MEDIUM
= _core_
.PRINT_QUALITY_MEDIUM
169 PRINT_QUALITY_LOW
= _core_
.PRINT_QUALITY_LOW
170 PRINT_QUALITY_DRAFT
= _core_
.PRINT_QUALITY_DRAFT
171 ID_ANY
= _core_
.ID_ANY
172 ID_SEPARATOR
= _core_
.ID_SEPARATOR
173 ID_NONE
= _core_
.ID_NONE
174 ID_LOWEST
= _core_
.ID_LOWEST
175 ID_OPEN
= _core_
.ID_OPEN
176 ID_CLOSE
= _core_
.ID_CLOSE
177 ID_NEW
= _core_
.ID_NEW
178 ID_SAVE
= _core_
.ID_SAVE
179 ID_SAVEAS
= _core_
.ID_SAVEAS
180 ID_REVERT
= _core_
.ID_REVERT
181 ID_EXIT
= _core_
.ID_EXIT
182 ID_UNDO
= _core_
.ID_UNDO
183 ID_REDO
= _core_
.ID_REDO
184 ID_HELP
= _core_
.ID_HELP
185 ID_PRINT
= _core_
.ID_PRINT
186 ID_PRINT_SETUP
= _core_
.ID_PRINT_SETUP
187 ID_PREVIEW
= _core_
.ID_PREVIEW
188 ID_ABOUT
= _core_
.ID_ABOUT
189 ID_HELP_CONTENTS
= _core_
.ID_HELP_CONTENTS
190 ID_HELP_COMMANDS
= _core_
.ID_HELP_COMMANDS
191 ID_HELP_PROCEDURES
= _core_
.ID_HELP_PROCEDURES
192 ID_HELP_CONTEXT
= _core_
.ID_HELP_CONTEXT
193 ID_CLOSE_ALL
= _core_
.ID_CLOSE_ALL
194 ID_PREFERENCES
= _core_
.ID_PREFERENCES
195 ID_CUT
= _core_
.ID_CUT
196 ID_COPY
= _core_
.ID_COPY
197 ID_PASTE
= _core_
.ID_PASTE
198 ID_CLEAR
= _core_
.ID_CLEAR
199 ID_FIND
= _core_
.ID_FIND
200 ID_DUPLICATE
= _core_
.ID_DUPLICATE
201 ID_SELECTALL
= _core_
.ID_SELECTALL
202 ID_DELETE
= _core_
.ID_DELETE
203 ID_REPLACE
= _core_
.ID_REPLACE
204 ID_REPLACE_ALL
= _core_
.ID_REPLACE_ALL
205 ID_PROPERTIES
= _core_
.ID_PROPERTIES
206 ID_VIEW_DETAILS
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_DETAILS
207 ID_VIEW_LARGEICONS
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_LARGEICONS
208 ID_VIEW_SMALLICONS
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_SMALLICONS
209 ID_VIEW_LIST
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_LIST
210 ID_VIEW_SORTDATE
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_SORTDATE
211 ID_VIEW_SORTNAME
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_SORTNAME
212 ID_VIEW_SORTSIZE
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_SORTSIZE
213 ID_VIEW_SORTTYPE
= _core_
.ID_VIEW_SORTTYPE
214 ID_FILE1
= _core_
.ID_FILE1
215 ID_FILE2
= _core_
.ID_FILE2
216 ID_FILE3
= _core_
.ID_FILE3
217 ID_FILE4
= _core_
.ID_FILE4
218 ID_FILE5
= _core_
.ID_FILE5
219 ID_FILE6
= _core_
.ID_FILE6
220 ID_FILE7
= _core_
.ID_FILE7
221 ID_FILE8
= _core_
.ID_FILE8
222 ID_FILE9
= _core_
.ID_FILE9
224 ID_CANCEL
= _core_
.ID_CANCEL
225 ID_APPLY
= _core_
.ID_APPLY
226 ID_YES
= _core_
.ID_YES
228 ID_STATIC
= _core_
.ID_STATIC
229 ID_FORWARD
= _core_
.ID_FORWARD
230 ID_BACKWARD
= _core_
.ID_BACKWARD
231 ID_DEFAULT
= _core_
.ID_DEFAULT
232 ID_MORE
= _core_
.ID_MORE
233 ID_SETUP
= _core_
.ID_SETUP
234 ID_RESET
= _core_
.ID_RESET
235 ID_CONTEXT_HELP
= _core_
.ID_CONTEXT_HELP
236 ID_YESTOALL
= _core_
.ID_YESTOALL
237 ID_NOTOALL
= _core_
.ID_NOTOALL
238 ID_ABORT
= _core_
.ID_ABORT
239 ID_RETRY
= _core_
.ID_RETRY
240 ID_IGNORE
= _core_
.ID_IGNORE
241 ID_ADD
= _core_
.ID_ADD
242 ID_REMOVE
= _core_
.ID_REMOVE
244 ID_DOWN
= _core_
.ID_DOWN
245 ID_HOME
= _core_
.ID_HOME
246 ID_REFRESH
= _core_
.ID_REFRESH
247 ID_STOP
= _core_
.ID_STOP
248 ID_INDEX
= _core_
.ID_INDEX
249 ID_BOLD
= _core_
.ID_BOLD
250 ID_ITALIC
= _core_
.ID_ITALIC
251 ID_JUSTIFY_CENTER
= _core_
.ID_JUSTIFY_CENTER
252 ID_JUSTIFY_FILL
= _core_
.ID_JUSTIFY_FILL
253 ID_JUSTIFY_RIGHT
= _core_
.ID_JUSTIFY_RIGHT
254 ID_JUSTIFY_LEFT
= _core_
.ID_JUSTIFY_LEFT
255 ID_UNDERLINE
= _core_
.ID_UNDERLINE
256 ID_INDENT
= _core_
.ID_INDENT
257 ID_UNINDENT
= _core_
.ID_UNINDENT
258 ID_ZOOM_100
= _core_
.ID_ZOOM_100
259 ID_ZOOM_FIT
= _core_
.ID_ZOOM_FIT
260 ID_ZOOM_IN
= _core_
.ID_ZOOM_IN
261 ID_ZOOM_OUT
= _core_
.ID_ZOOM_OUT
262 ID_UNDELETE
= _core_
.ID_UNDELETE
263 ID_REVERT_TO_SAVED
= _core_
.ID_REVERT_TO_SAVED
264 ID_HIGHEST
= _core_
.ID_HIGHEST
267 HIDE_READONLY
= _core_
.HIDE_READONLY
268 OVERWRITE_PROMPT
= _core_
.OVERWRITE_PROMPT
269 FILE_MUST_EXIST
= _core_
.FILE_MUST_EXIST
270 MULTIPLE
= _core_
.MULTIPLE
271 CHANGE_DIR
= _core_
.CHANGE_DIR
272 ACCEL_ALT
= _core_
.ACCEL_ALT
273 ACCEL_CTRL
= _core_
.ACCEL_CTRL
274 ACCEL_SHIFT
= _core_
.ACCEL_SHIFT
275 ACCEL_NORMAL
= _core_
.ACCEL_NORMAL
276 PD_AUTO_HIDE
= _core_
.PD_AUTO_HIDE
277 PD_APP_MODAL
= _core_
.PD_APP_MODAL
278 PD_CAN_ABORT
= _core_
.PD_CAN_ABORT
279 PD_ELAPSED_TIME
= _core_
.PD_ELAPSED_TIME
280 PD_ESTIMATED_TIME
= _core_
.PD_ESTIMATED_TIME
281 PD_REMAINING_TIME
= _core_
.PD_REMAINING_TIME
282 PD_SMOOTH
= _core_
.PD_SMOOTH
283 PD_CAN_SKIP
= _core_
.PD_CAN_SKIP
284 DD_NEW_DIR_BUTTON
= _core_
.DD_NEW_DIR_BUTTON
285 DD_DEFAULT_STYLE
= _core_
.DD_DEFAULT_STYLE
286 MENU_TEAROFF
= _core_
.MENU_TEAROFF
287 MB_DOCKABLE
= _core_
.MB_DOCKABLE
288 NO_FULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE
= _core_
.NO_FULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE
289 FULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE
= _core_
.FULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE
290 LI_HORIZONTAL
= _core_
.LI_HORIZONTAL
291 LI_VERTICAL
= _core_
.LI_VERTICAL
292 WS_EX_VALIDATE_RECURSIVELY
= _core_
.WS_EX_VALIDATE_RECURSIVELY
293 WS_EX_BLOCK_EVENTS
= _core_
.WS_EX_BLOCK_EVENTS
294 WS_EX_TRANSIENT
= _core_
.WS_EX_TRANSIENT
295 WS_EX_THEMED_BACKGROUND
= _core_
.WS_EX_THEMED_BACKGROUND
296 WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE
= _core_
.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE
297 WS_EX_PROCESS_UI_UPDATES
= _core_
.WS_EX_PROCESS_UI_UPDATES
298 MM_TEXT
= _core_
.MM_TEXT
299 MM_LOMETRIC
= _core_
.MM_LOMETRIC
300 MM_HIMETRIC
= _core_
.MM_HIMETRIC
301 MM_LOENGLISH
= _core_
.MM_LOENGLISH
302 MM_HIENGLISH
= _core_
.MM_HIENGLISH
303 MM_TWIPS
= _core_
.MM_TWIPS
304 MM_ISOTROPIC
= _core_
.MM_ISOTROPIC
305 MM_ANISOTROPIC
= _core_
.MM_ANISOTROPIC
306 MM_POINTS
= _core_
.MM_POINTS
307 MM_METRIC
= _core_
.MM_METRIC
308 CENTRE
= _core_
.CENTRE
309 CENTER
= _core_
.CENTER
310 HORIZONTAL
= _core_
.HORIZONTAL
311 VERTICAL
= _core_
.VERTICAL
318 BOTTOM
= _core_
.BOTTOM
324 ALIGN_NOT
= _core_
.ALIGN_NOT
325 ALIGN_CENTER_HORIZONTAL
= _core_
.ALIGN_CENTER_HORIZONTAL
326 ALIGN_CENTRE_HORIZONTAL
= _core_
.ALIGN_CENTRE_HORIZONTAL
327 ALIGN_LEFT
= _core_
.ALIGN_LEFT
328 ALIGN_TOP
= _core_
.ALIGN_TOP
329 ALIGN_RIGHT
= _core_
.ALIGN_RIGHT
330 ALIGN_BOTTOM
= _core_
.ALIGN_BOTTOM
331 ALIGN_CENTER_VERTICAL
= _core_
.ALIGN_CENTER_VERTICAL
332 ALIGN_CENTRE_VERTICAL
= _core_
.ALIGN_CENTRE_VERTICAL
333 ALIGN_CENTER
= _core_
.ALIGN_CENTER
334 ALIGN_CENTRE
= _core_
.ALIGN_CENTRE
335 ALIGN_MASK
= _core_
.ALIGN_MASK
336 STRETCH_NOT
= _core_
.STRETCH_NOT
337 SHRINK
= _core_
.SHRINK
339 EXPAND
= _core_
.EXPAND
340 SHAPED
= _core_
.SHAPED
341 FIXED_MINSIZE
= _core_
.FIXED_MINSIZE
343 ADJUST_MINSIZE
= _core_
.ADJUST_MINSIZE
344 BORDER_DEFAULT
= _core_
.BORDER_DEFAULT
345 BORDER_NONE
= _core_
.BORDER_NONE
346 BORDER_STATIC
= _core_
.BORDER_STATIC
347 BORDER_SIMPLE
= _core_
.BORDER_SIMPLE
348 BORDER_RAISED
= _core_
.BORDER_RAISED
349 BORDER_SUNKEN
= _core_
.BORDER_SUNKEN
350 BORDER_DOUBLE
= _core_
.BORDER_DOUBLE
351 BORDER_MASK
= _core_
.BORDER_MASK
352 BG_STYLE_SYSTEM
= _core_
.BG_STYLE_SYSTEM
353 BG_STYLE_COLOUR
= _core_
.BG_STYLE_COLOUR
354 BG_STYLE_CUSTOM
= _core_
.BG_STYLE_CUSTOM
355 DEFAULT
= _core_
.DEFAULT
356 DECORATIVE
= _core_
.DECORATIVE
358 SCRIPT
= _core_
.SCRIPT
360 MODERN
= _core_
.MODERN
361 TELETYPE
= _core_
.TELETYPE
362 VARIABLE
= _core_
.VARIABLE
364 NORMAL
= _core_
.NORMAL
367 ITALIC
= _core_
.ITALIC
371 LONG_DASH
= _core_
.LONG_DASH
372 SHORT_DASH
= _core_
.SHORT_DASH
373 DOT_DASH
= _core_
.DOT_DASH
374 USER_DASH
= _core_
.USER_DASH
375 TRANSPARENT
= _core_
.TRANSPARENT
376 STIPPLE
= _core_
.STIPPLE
377 STIPPLE_MASK
= _core_
.STIPPLE_MASK
378 STIPPLE_MASK_OPAQUE
= _core_
.STIPPLE_MASK_OPAQUE
379 BDIAGONAL_HATCH
= _core_
.BDIAGONAL_HATCH
380 CROSSDIAG_HATCH
= _core_
.CROSSDIAG_HATCH
381 FDIAGONAL_HATCH
= _core_
.FDIAGONAL_HATCH
382 CROSS_HATCH
= _core_
.CROSS_HATCH
383 HORIZONTAL_HATCH
= _core_
.HORIZONTAL_HATCH
384 VERTICAL_HATCH
= _core_
.VERTICAL_HATCH
385 JOIN_BEVEL
= _core_
.JOIN_BEVEL
386 JOIN_MITER
= _core_
.JOIN_MITER
387 JOIN_ROUND
= _core_
.JOIN_ROUND
388 CAP_ROUND
= _core_
.CAP_ROUND
389 CAP_PROJECTING
= _core_
.CAP_PROJECTING
390 CAP_BUTT
= _core_
.CAP_BUTT
393 INVERT
= _core_
.INVERT
394 OR_REVERSE
= _core_
.OR_REVERSE
395 AND_REVERSE
= _core_
.AND_REVERSE
398 AND_INVERT
= _core_
.AND_INVERT
402 SRC_INVERT
= _core_
.SRC_INVERT
403 OR_INVERT
= _core_
.OR_INVERT
407 WXK_BACK
= _core_
.WXK_BACK
408 WXK_TAB
= _core_
.WXK_TAB
409 WXK_RETURN
= _core_
.WXK_RETURN
410 WXK_ESCAPE
= _core_
.WXK_ESCAPE
411 WXK_SPACE
= _core_
.WXK_SPACE
412 WXK_DELETE
= _core_
.WXK_DELETE
413 WXK_START
= _core_
.WXK_START
414 WXK_LBUTTON
= _core_
.WXK_LBUTTON
415 WXK_RBUTTON
= _core_
.WXK_RBUTTON
416 WXK_CANCEL
= _core_
.WXK_CANCEL
417 WXK_MBUTTON
= _core_
.WXK_MBUTTON
418 WXK_CLEAR
= _core_
.WXK_CLEAR
419 WXK_SHIFT
= _core_
.WXK_SHIFT
420 WXK_ALT
= _core_
.WXK_ALT
421 WXK_CONTROL
= _core_
.WXK_CONTROL
422 WXK_MENU
= _core_
.WXK_MENU
423 WXK_PAUSE
= _core_
.WXK_PAUSE
424 WXK_CAPITAL
= _core_
.WXK_CAPITAL
425 WXK_PRIOR
= _core_
.WXK_PRIOR
426 WXK_NEXT
= _core_
.WXK_NEXT
427 WXK_END
= _core_
.WXK_END
428 WXK_HOME
= _core_
.WXK_HOME
429 WXK_LEFT
= _core_
.WXK_LEFT
430 WXK_UP
= _core_
.WXK_UP
431 WXK_RIGHT
= _core_
.WXK_RIGHT
432 WXK_DOWN
= _core_
.WXK_DOWN
433 WXK_SELECT
= _core_
.WXK_SELECT
434 WXK_PRINT
= _core_
.WXK_PRINT
435 WXK_EXECUTE
= _core_
.WXK_EXECUTE
436 WXK_SNAPSHOT
= _core_
.WXK_SNAPSHOT
437 WXK_INSERT
= _core_
.WXK_INSERT
438 WXK_HELP
= _core_
.WXK_HELP
439 WXK_NUMPAD0
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD0
440 WXK_NUMPAD1
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD1
441 WXK_NUMPAD2
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD2
442 WXK_NUMPAD3
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD3
443 WXK_NUMPAD4
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD4
444 WXK_NUMPAD5
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD5
445 WXK_NUMPAD6
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD6
446 WXK_NUMPAD7
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD7
447 WXK_NUMPAD8
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD8
448 WXK_NUMPAD9
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD9
449 WXK_MULTIPLY
= _core_
.WXK_MULTIPLY
450 WXK_ADD
= _core_
.WXK_ADD
451 WXK_SEPARATOR
= _core_
.WXK_SEPARATOR
452 WXK_SUBTRACT
= _core_
.WXK_SUBTRACT
453 WXK_DECIMAL
= _core_
.WXK_DECIMAL
454 WXK_DIVIDE
= _core_
.WXK_DIVIDE
455 WXK_F1
= _core_
.WXK_F1
456 WXK_F2
= _core_
.WXK_F2
457 WXK_F3
= _core_
.WXK_F3
458 WXK_F4
= _core_
.WXK_F4
459 WXK_F5
= _core_
.WXK_F5
460 WXK_F6
= _core_
.WXK_F6
461 WXK_F7
= _core_
.WXK_F7
462 WXK_F8
= _core_
.WXK_F8
463 WXK_F9
= _core_
.WXK_F9
464 WXK_F10
= _core_
.WXK_F10
465 WXK_F11
= _core_
.WXK_F11
466 WXK_F12
= _core_
.WXK_F12
467 WXK_F13
= _core_
.WXK_F13
468 WXK_F14
= _core_
.WXK_F14
469 WXK_F15
= _core_
.WXK_F15
470 WXK_F16
= _core_
.WXK_F16
471 WXK_F17
= _core_
.WXK_F17
472 WXK_F18
= _core_
.WXK_F18
473 WXK_F19
= _core_
.WXK_F19
474 WXK_F20
= _core_
.WXK_F20
475 WXK_F21
= _core_
.WXK_F21
476 WXK_F22
= _core_
.WXK_F22
477 WXK_F23
= _core_
.WXK_F23
478 WXK_F24
= _core_
.WXK_F24
479 WXK_NUMLOCK
= _core_
.WXK_NUMLOCK
480 WXK_SCROLL
= _core_
.WXK_SCROLL
481 WXK_PAGEUP
= _core_
.WXK_PAGEUP
482 WXK_PAGEDOWN
= _core_
.WXK_PAGEDOWN
483 WXK_NUMPAD_SPACE
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_SPACE
484 WXK_NUMPAD_TAB
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_TAB
485 WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER
486 WXK_NUMPAD_F1
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_F1
487 WXK_NUMPAD_F2
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_F2
488 WXK_NUMPAD_F3
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_F3
489 WXK_NUMPAD_F4
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_F4
490 WXK_NUMPAD_HOME
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_HOME
491 WXK_NUMPAD_LEFT
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_LEFT
492 WXK_NUMPAD_UP
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_UP
493 WXK_NUMPAD_RIGHT
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_RIGHT
494 WXK_NUMPAD_DOWN
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_DOWN
495 WXK_NUMPAD_PRIOR
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_PRIOR
496 WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEUP
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEUP
497 WXK_NUMPAD_NEXT
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_NEXT
498 WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEDOWN
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEDOWN
499 WXK_NUMPAD_END
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_END
500 WXK_NUMPAD_BEGIN
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_BEGIN
501 WXK_NUMPAD_INSERT
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_INSERT
502 WXK_NUMPAD_DELETE
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_DELETE
503 WXK_NUMPAD_EQUAL
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_EQUAL
504 WXK_NUMPAD_MULTIPLY
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_MULTIPLY
505 WXK_NUMPAD_ADD
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_ADD
506 WXK_NUMPAD_SEPARATOR
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_SEPARATOR
507 WXK_NUMPAD_SUBTRACT
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_SUBTRACT
508 WXK_NUMPAD_DECIMAL
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_DECIMAL
509 WXK_NUMPAD_DIVIDE
= _core_
.WXK_NUMPAD_DIVIDE
510 WXK_WINDOWS_LEFT
= _core_
.WXK_WINDOWS_LEFT
511 WXK_WINDOWS_RIGHT
= _core_
.WXK_WINDOWS_RIGHT
512 WXK_WINDOWS_MENU
= _core_
.WXK_WINDOWS_MENU
513 WXK_COMMAND
= _core_
.WXK_COMMAND
514 WXK_SPECIAL1
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL1
515 WXK_SPECIAL2
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL2
516 WXK_SPECIAL3
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL3
517 WXK_SPECIAL4
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL4
518 WXK_SPECIAL5
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL5
519 WXK_SPECIAL6
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL6
520 WXK_SPECIAL7
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL7
521 WXK_SPECIAL8
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL8
522 WXK_SPECIAL9
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL9
523 WXK_SPECIAL10
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL10
524 WXK_SPECIAL11
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL11
525 WXK_SPECIAL12
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL12
526 WXK_SPECIAL13
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL13
527 WXK_SPECIAL14
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL14
528 WXK_SPECIAL15
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL15
529 WXK_SPECIAL16
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL16
530 WXK_SPECIAL17
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL17
531 WXK_SPECIAL18
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL18
532 WXK_SPECIAL19
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL19
533 WXK_SPECIAL20
= _core_
.WXK_SPECIAL20
534 PAPER_NONE
= _core_
.PAPER_NONE
535 PAPER_LETTER
= _core_
.PAPER_LETTER
536 PAPER_LEGAL
= _core_
.PAPER_LEGAL
537 PAPER_A4
= _core_
.PAPER_A4
538 PAPER_CSHEET
= _core_
.PAPER_CSHEET
539 PAPER_DSHEET
= _core_
.PAPER_DSHEET
540 PAPER_ESHEET
= _core_
.PAPER_ESHEET
541 PAPER_LETTERSMALL
= _core_
.PAPER_LETTERSMALL
542 PAPER_TABLOID
= _core_
.PAPER_TABLOID
543 PAPER_LEDGER
= _core_
.PAPER_LEDGER
544 PAPER_STATEMENT
= _core_
.PAPER_STATEMENT
545 PAPER_EXECUTIVE
= _core_
.PAPER_EXECUTIVE
546 PAPER_A3
= _core_
.PAPER_A3
547 PAPER_A4SMALL
= _core_
.PAPER_A4SMALL
548 PAPER_A5
= _core_
.PAPER_A5
549 PAPER_B4
= _core_
.PAPER_B4
550 PAPER_B5
= _core_
.PAPER_B5
551 PAPER_FOLIO
= _core_
.PAPER_FOLIO
552 PAPER_QUARTO
= _core_
.PAPER_QUARTO
553 PAPER_10X14
= _core_
.PAPER_10X14
554 PAPER_11X17
= _core_
.PAPER_11X17
555 PAPER_NOTE
= _core_
.PAPER_NOTE
556 PAPER_ENV_9
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_9
557 PAPER_ENV_10
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_10
558 PAPER_ENV_11
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_11
559 PAPER_ENV_12
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_12
560 PAPER_ENV_14
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_14
561 PAPER_ENV_DL
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_DL
562 PAPER_ENV_C5
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_C5
563 PAPER_ENV_C3
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_C3
564 PAPER_ENV_C4
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_C4
565 PAPER_ENV_C6
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_C6
566 PAPER_ENV_C65
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_C65
567 PAPER_ENV_B4
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_B4
568 PAPER_ENV_B5
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_B5
569 PAPER_ENV_B6
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_B6
570 PAPER_ENV_ITALY
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_ITALY
571 PAPER_ENV_MONARCH
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_MONARCH
572 PAPER_ENV_PERSONAL
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_PERSONAL
573 PAPER_FANFOLD_US
= _core_
.PAPER_FANFOLD_US
574 PAPER_FANFOLD_STD_GERMAN
= _core_
.PAPER_FANFOLD_STD_GERMAN
575 PAPER_FANFOLD_LGL_GERMAN
= _core_
.PAPER_FANFOLD_LGL_GERMAN
576 PAPER_ISO_B4
= _core_
.PAPER_ISO_B4
577 PAPER_JAPANESE_POSTCARD
= _core_
.PAPER_JAPANESE_POSTCARD
578 PAPER_9X11
= _core_
.PAPER_9X11
579 PAPER_10X11
= _core_
.PAPER_10X11
580 PAPER_15X11
= _core_
.PAPER_15X11
581 PAPER_ENV_INVITE
= _core_
.PAPER_ENV_INVITE
582 PAPER_LETTER_EXTRA
= _core_
.PAPER_LETTER_EXTRA
583 PAPER_LEGAL_EXTRA
= _core_
.PAPER_LEGAL_EXTRA
584 PAPER_TABLOID_EXTRA
= _core_
.PAPER_TABLOID_EXTRA
585 PAPER_A4_EXTRA
= _core_
.PAPER_A4_EXTRA
586 PAPER_LETTER_TRANSVERSE
= _core_
.PAPER_LETTER_TRANSVERSE
587 PAPER_A4_TRANSVERSE
= _core_
.PAPER_A4_TRANSVERSE
588 PAPER_LETTER_EXTRA_TRANSVERSE
= _core_
.PAPER_LETTER_EXTRA_TRANSVERSE
589 PAPER_A_PLUS
= _core_
.PAPER_A_PLUS
590 PAPER_B_PLUS
= _core_
.PAPER_B_PLUS
591 PAPER_LETTER_PLUS
= _core_
.PAPER_LETTER_PLUS
592 PAPER_A4_PLUS
= _core_
.PAPER_A4_PLUS
593 PAPER_A5_TRANSVERSE
= _core_
.PAPER_A5_TRANSVERSE
594 PAPER_B5_TRANSVERSE
= _core_
.PAPER_B5_TRANSVERSE
595 PAPER_A3_EXTRA
= _core_
.PAPER_A3_EXTRA
596 PAPER_A5_EXTRA
= _core_
.PAPER_A5_EXTRA
597 PAPER_B5_EXTRA
= _core_
.PAPER_B5_EXTRA
598 PAPER_A2
= _core_
.PAPER_A2
599 PAPER_A3_TRANSVERSE
= _core_
.PAPER_A3_TRANSVERSE
600 PAPER_A3_EXTRA_TRANSVERSE
= _core_
.PAPER_A3_EXTRA_TRANSVERSE
601 PAPER_DBL_JAPANESE_POSTCARD
= _core_
.PAPER_DBL_JAPANESE_POSTCARD
602 PAPER_A6
= _core_
.PAPER_A6
603 PAPER_JENV_KAKU2
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_KAKU2
604 PAPER_JENV_KAKU3
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_KAKU3
605 PAPER_JENV_CHOU3
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_CHOU3
606 PAPER_JENV_CHOU4
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_CHOU4
607 PAPER_LETTER_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_LETTER_ROTATED
608 PAPER_A3_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_A3_ROTATED
609 PAPER_A4_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_A4_ROTATED
610 PAPER_A5_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_A5_ROTATED
611 PAPER_B4_JIS_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_B4_JIS_ROTATED
612 PAPER_B5_JIS_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_B5_JIS_ROTATED
613 PAPER_JAPANESE_POSTCARD_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_JAPANESE_POSTCARD_ROTATED
614 PAPER_DBL_JAPANESE_POSTCARD_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_DBL_JAPANESE_POSTCARD_ROTATED
615 PAPER_A6_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_A6_ROTATED
616 PAPER_JENV_KAKU2_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_KAKU2_ROTATED
617 PAPER_JENV_KAKU3_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_KAKU3_ROTATED
618 PAPER_JENV_CHOU3_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_CHOU3_ROTATED
619 PAPER_JENV_CHOU4_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_CHOU4_ROTATED
620 PAPER_B6_JIS
= _core_
.PAPER_B6_JIS
621 PAPER_B6_JIS_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_B6_JIS_ROTATED
622 PAPER_12X11
= _core_
.PAPER_12X11
623 PAPER_JENV_YOU4
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_YOU4
624 PAPER_JENV_YOU4_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_JENV_YOU4_ROTATED
625 PAPER_P16K
= _core_
.PAPER_P16K
626 PAPER_P32K
= _core_
.PAPER_P32K
627 PAPER_P32KBIG
= _core_
.PAPER_P32KBIG
628 PAPER_PENV_1
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_1
629 PAPER_PENV_2
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_2
630 PAPER_PENV_3
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_3
631 PAPER_PENV_4
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_4
632 PAPER_PENV_5
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_5
633 PAPER_PENV_6
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_6
634 PAPER_PENV_7
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_7
635 PAPER_PENV_8
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_8
636 PAPER_PENV_9
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_9
637 PAPER_PENV_10
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_10
638 PAPER_P16K_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_P16K_ROTATED
639 PAPER_P32K_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_P32K_ROTATED
640 PAPER_P32KBIG_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_P32KBIG_ROTATED
641 PAPER_PENV_1_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_1_ROTATED
642 PAPER_PENV_2_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_2_ROTATED
643 PAPER_PENV_3_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_3_ROTATED
644 PAPER_PENV_4_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_4_ROTATED
645 PAPER_PENV_5_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_5_ROTATED
646 PAPER_PENV_6_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_6_ROTATED
647 PAPER_PENV_7_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_7_ROTATED
648 PAPER_PENV_8_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_8_ROTATED
649 PAPER_PENV_9_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_9_ROTATED
650 PAPER_PENV_10_ROTATED
= _core_
.PAPER_PENV_10_ROTATED
651 DUPLEX_SIMPLEX
= _core_
.DUPLEX_SIMPLEX
652 DUPLEX_HORIZONTAL
= _core_
.DUPLEX_HORIZONTAL
653 DUPLEX_VERTICAL
= _core_
.DUPLEX_VERTICAL
654 ITEM_SEPARATOR
= _core_
.ITEM_SEPARATOR
655 ITEM_NORMAL
= _core_
.ITEM_NORMAL
656 ITEM_CHECK
= _core_
.ITEM_CHECK
657 ITEM_RADIO
= _core_
.ITEM_RADIO
658 ITEM_MAX
= _core_
.ITEM_MAX
659 HT_NOWHERE
= _core_
.HT_NOWHERE
660 HT_SCROLLBAR_FIRST
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_FIRST
661 HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_LINE_1
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_LINE_1
662 HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_LINE_2
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_LINE_2
663 HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_PAGE_1
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_PAGE_1
664 HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_PAGE_2
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_ARROW_PAGE_2
665 HT_SCROLLBAR_THUMB
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_THUMB
666 HT_SCROLLBAR_BAR_1
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_BAR_1
667 HT_SCROLLBAR_BAR_2
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_BAR_2
668 HT_SCROLLBAR_LAST
= _core_
.HT_SCROLLBAR_LAST
669 HT_WINDOW_OUTSIDE
= _core_
.HT_WINDOW_OUTSIDE
670 HT_WINDOW_INSIDE
= _core_
.HT_WINDOW_INSIDE
671 HT_WINDOW_VERT_SCROLLBAR
= _core_
.HT_WINDOW_VERT_SCROLLBAR
672 HT_WINDOW_HORZ_SCROLLBAR
= _core_
.HT_WINDOW_HORZ_SCROLLBAR
673 HT_WINDOW_CORNER
= _core_
.HT_WINDOW_CORNER
674 HT_MAX
= _core_
.HT_MAX
675 MOD_NONE
= _core_
.MOD_NONE
676 MOD_ALT
= _core_
.MOD_ALT
677 MOD_CONTROL
= _core_
.MOD_CONTROL
678 MOD_ALTGR
= _core_
.MOD_ALTGR
679 MOD_SHIFT
= _core_
.MOD_SHIFT
680 MOD_META
= _core_
.MOD_META
681 MOD_WIN
= _core_
.MOD_WIN
682 MOD_CMD
= _core_
.MOD_CMD
683 MOD_ALL
= _core_
.MOD_ALL
684 UPDATE_UI_NONE
= _core_
.UPDATE_UI_NONE
685 UPDATE_UI_RECURSE
= _core_
.UPDATE_UI_RECURSE
686 UPDATE_UI_FROMIDLE
= _core_
.UPDATE_UI_FROMIDLE
687 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
689 class Object(object):
691 The base class for most wx objects, although in wxPython not
692 much functionality is needed nor exposed.
694 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
696 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxObject instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
697 def GetClassName(*args
, **kwargs
):
699 GetClassName(self) -> String
701 Returns the class name of the C++ class using wxRTTI.
703 return _core_
.Object_GetClassName(*args
, **kwargs
)
705 def Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
):
709 Deletes the C++ object this Python object is a proxy for.
711 return _core_
.Object_Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
)
714 class ObjectPtr(Object
):
715 def __init__(self
, this
):
717 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
718 self
.__class
__ = Object
719 _core_
.Object_swigregister(ObjectPtr
)
720 _wxPySetDictionary
= _core_
._wxPySetDictionary
722 _wxPyFixStockObjects
= _core_
._wxPyFixStockObjects
725 EmptyString
= cvar
.EmptyString
727 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
729 BITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
730 BITMAP_TYPE_BMP
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_BMP
731 BITMAP_TYPE_ICO
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_ICO
732 BITMAP_TYPE_CUR
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_CUR
733 BITMAP_TYPE_XBM
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_XBM
734 BITMAP_TYPE_XBM_DATA
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_XBM_DATA
735 BITMAP_TYPE_XPM
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_XPM
736 BITMAP_TYPE_XPM_DATA
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_XPM_DATA
737 BITMAP_TYPE_TIF
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_TIF
738 BITMAP_TYPE_GIF
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_GIF
739 BITMAP_TYPE_PNG
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_PNG
740 BITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
741 BITMAP_TYPE_PNM
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_PNM
742 BITMAP_TYPE_PCX
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_PCX
743 BITMAP_TYPE_PICT
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_PICT
744 BITMAP_TYPE_ICON
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_ICON
745 BITMAP_TYPE_ANI
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_ANI
746 BITMAP_TYPE_IFF
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_IFF
747 BITMAP_TYPE_MACCURSOR
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_MACCURSOR
748 BITMAP_TYPE_ANY
= _core_
.BITMAP_TYPE_ANY
749 CURSOR_NONE
= _core_
.CURSOR_NONE
750 CURSOR_ARROW
= _core_
.CURSOR_ARROW
751 CURSOR_RIGHT_ARROW
= _core_
.CURSOR_RIGHT_ARROW
752 CURSOR_BULLSEYE
= _core_
.CURSOR_BULLSEYE
753 CURSOR_CHAR
= _core_
.CURSOR_CHAR
754 CURSOR_CROSS
= _core_
.CURSOR_CROSS
755 CURSOR_HAND
= _core_
.CURSOR_HAND
756 CURSOR_IBEAM
= _core_
.CURSOR_IBEAM
757 CURSOR_LEFT_BUTTON
= _core_
.CURSOR_LEFT_BUTTON
758 CURSOR_MAGNIFIER
= _core_
.CURSOR_MAGNIFIER
759 CURSOR_MIDDLE_BUTTON
= _core_
.CURSOR_MIDDLE_BUTTON
760 CURSOR_NO_ENTRY
= _core_
.CURSOR_NO_ENTRY
761 CURSOR_PAINT_BRUSH
= _core_
.CURSOR_PAINT_BRUSH
762 CURSOR_PENCIL
= _core_
.CURSOR_PENCIL
763 CURSOR_POINT_LEFT
= _core_
.CURSOR_POINT_LEFT
764 CURSOR_POINT_RIGHT
= _core_
.CURSOR_POINT_RIGHT
765 CURSOR_QUESTION_ARROW
= _core_
.CURSOR_QUESTION_ARROW
766 CURSOR_RIGHT_BUTTON
= _core_
.CURSOR_RIGHT_BUTTON
767 CURSOR_SIZENESW
= _core_
.CURSOR_SIZENESW
768 CURSOR_SIZENS
= _core_
.CURSOR_SIZENS
769 CURSOR_SIZENWSE
= _core_
.CURSOR_SIZENWSE
770 CURSOR_SIZEWE
= _core_
.CURSOR_SIZEWE
771 CURSOR_SIZING
= _core_
.CURSOR_SIZING
772 CURSOR_SPRAYCAN
= _core_
.CURSOR_SPRAYCAN
773 CURSOR_WAIT
= _core_
.CURSOR_WAIT
774 CURSOR_WATCH
= _core_
.CURSOR_WATCH
775 CURSOR_BLANK
= _core_
.CURSOR_BLANK
776 CURSOR_DEFAULT
= _core_
.CURSOR_DEFAULT
777 CURSOR_COPY_ARROW
= _core_
.CURSOR_COPY_ARROW
778 CURSOR_ARROWWAIT
= _core_
.CURSOR_ARROWWAIT
779 CURSOR_MAX
= _core_
.CURSOR_MAX
780 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
784 wx.Size is a useful data structure used to represent the size of
785 something. It simply contians integer width and height
786 proprtites. In most places in wxPython where a wx.Size is
787 expected a (width, height) tuple can be used instead.
790 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxSize instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
791 width
= property(_core_
.Size_width_get
, _core_
.Size_width_set
)
792 height
= property(_core_
.Size_height_get
, _core_
.Size_height_set
)
793 x
= width
; y
= height
794 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
796 __init__(self, int w=0, int h=0) -> Size
798 Creates a size object.
800 newobj
= _core_
.new_Size(*args
, **kwargs
)
801 self
.this
= newobj
.this
804 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_Size
):
807 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
810 def __eq__(*args
, **kwargs
):
812 __eq__(self, Size sz) -> bool
814 Test for equality of wx.Size objects.
816 return _core_
.Size___eq__(*args
, **kwargs
)
818 def __ne__(*args
, **kwargs
):
820 __ne__(self, Size sz) -> bool
824 return _core_
.Size___ne__(*args
, **kwargs
)
826 def __add__(*args
, **kwargs
):
828 __add__(self, Size sz) -> Size
830 Add sz's proprties to this and return the result.
832 return _core_
.Size___add__(*args
, **kwargs
)
834 def __sub__(*args
, **kwargs
):
836 __sub__(self, Size sz) -> Size
838 Subtract sz's properties from this and return the result.
840 return _core_
.Size___sub__(*args
, **kwargs
)
842 def IncTo(*args
, **kwargs
):
846 Increments this object so that both of its dimensions are not less
847 than the corresponding dimensions of the size.
849 return _core_
.Size_IncTo(*args
, **kwargs
)
851 def DecTo(*args
, **kwargs
):
855 Decrements this object so that both of its dimensions are not greater
856 than the corresponding dimensions of the size.
858 return _core_
.Size_DecTo(*args
, **kwargs
)
860 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
862 Set(self, int w, int h)
864 Set both width and height.
866 return _core_
.Size_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
868 def SetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
869 """SetWidth(self, int w)"""
870 return _core_
.Size_SetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
872 def SetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
873 """SetHeight(self, int h)"""
874 return _core_
.Size_SetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
876 def GetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
877 """GetWidth(self) -> int"""
878 return _core_
.Size_GetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
880 def GetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
881 """GetHeight(self) -> int"""
882 return _core_
.Size_GetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
884 def IsFullySpecified(*args
, **kwargs
):
886 IsFullySpecified(self) -> bool
888 Returns True if both components of the size are non-default values.
890 return _core_
.Size_IsFullySpecified(*args
, **kwargs
)
892 def SetDefaults(*args
, **kwargs
):
894 SetDefaults(self, Size size)
896 Combine this size with the other one replacing the default components
897 of this object (i.e. equal to -1) with those of the other.
899 return _core_
.Size_SetDefaults(*args
, **kwargs
)
901 def Get(*args
, **kwargs
):
903 Get() -> (width,height)
905 Returns the width and height properties as a tuple.
907 return _core_
.Size_Get(*args
, **kwargs
)
909 asTuple
= wx
._deprecated
(Get
, "asTuple is deprecated, use `Get` instead")
910 def __str__(self
): return str(self
.Get())
911 def __repr__(self
): return 'wx.Size'+str(self
.Get())
912 def __len__(self
): return len(self
.Get())
913 def __getitem__(self
, index
): return self
.Get()[index
]
914 def __setitem__(self
, index
, val
):
915 if index
== 0: self
.width
= val
916 elif index
== 1: self
.height
= val
917 else: raise IndexError
918 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Get() != (0,0)
919 __safe_for_unpickling__
= True
920 def __reduce__(self
): return (wx
.Size
, self
.Get())
924 def __init__(self
, this
):
926 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
927 self
.__class
__ = Size
928 _core_
.Size_swigregister(SizePtr
)
930 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
932 class RealPoint(object):
934 A data structure for representing a point or position with floating
935 point x and y properties. In wxPython most places that expect a
936 wx.RealPoint can also accept a (x,y) tuple.
939 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxRealPoint instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
940 x
= property(_core_
.RealPoint_x_get
, _core_
.RealPoint_x_set
)
941 y
= property(_core_
.RealPoint_y_get
, _core_
.RealPoint_y_set
)
942 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
944 __init__(self, double x=0.0, double y=0.0) -> RealPoint
946 Create a wx.RealPoint object
948 newobj
= _core_
.new_RealPoint(*args
, **kwargs
)
949 self
.this
= newobj
.this
952 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_RealPoint
):
955 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
958 def __eq__(*args
, **kwargs
):
960 __eq__(self, RealPoint pt) -> bool
962 Test for equality of wx.RealPoint objects.
964 return _core_
.RealPoint___eq__(*args
, **kwargs
)
966 def __ne__(*args
, **kwargs
):
968 __ne__(self, RealPoint pt) -> bool
970 Test for inequality of wx.RealPoint objects.
972 return _core_
.RealPoint___ne__(*args
, **kwargs
)
974 def __add__(*args
, **kwargs
):
976 __add__(self, RealPoint pt) -> RealPoint
978 Add pt's proprties to this and return the result.
980 return _core_
.RealPoint___add__(*args
, **kwargs
)
982 def __sub__(*args
, **kwargs
):
984 __sub__(self, RealPoint pt) -> RealPoint
986 Subtract pt's proprties from this and return the result
988 return _core_
.RealPoint___sub__(*args
, **kwargs
)
990 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
992 Set(self, double x, double y)
994 Set both the x and y properties
996 return _core_
.RealPoint_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
998 def Get(*args
, **kwargs
):
1002 Return the x and y properties as a tuple.
1004 return _core_
.RealPoint_Get(*args
, **kwargs
)
1006 asTuple
= wx
._deprecated
(Get
, "asTuple is deprecated, use `Get` instead")
1007 def __str__(self
): return str(self
.Get())
1008 def __repr__(self
): return 'wx.RealPoint'+str(self
.Get())
1009 def __len__(self
): return len(self
.Get())
1010 def __getitem__(self
, index
): return self
.Get()[index
]
1011 def __setitem__(self
, index
, val
):
1012 if index
== 0: self
.x
= val
1013 elif index
== 1: self
.y
= val
1014 else: raise IndexError
1015 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Get() != (0.0, 0.0)
1016 __safe_for_unpickling__
= True
1017 def __reduce__(self
): return (wx
.RealPoint
, self
.Get())
1020 class RealPointPtr(RealPoint
):
1021 def __init__(self
, this
):
1023 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1024 self
.__class
__ = RealPoint
1025 _core_
.RealPoint_swigregister(RealPointPtr
)
1027 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
1029 class Point(object):
1031 A data structure for representing a point or position with integer x
1032 and y properties. Most places in wxPython that expect a wx.Point can
1033 also accept a (x,y) tuple.
1036 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPoint instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1037 x
= property(_core_
.Point_x_get
, _core_
.Point_x_set
)
1038 y
= property(_core_
.Point_y_get
, _core_
.Point_y_set
)
1039 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1041 __init__(self, int x=0, int y=0) -> Point
1043 Create a wx.Point object
1045 newobj
= _core_
.new_Point(*args
, **kwargs
)
1046 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1049 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_Point
):
1052 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
1055 def __eq__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1057 __eq__(self, Point pt) -> bool
1059 Test for equality of wx.Point objects.
1061 return _core_
.Point___eq__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1063 def __ne__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1065 __ne__(self, Point pt) -> bool
1067 Test for inequality of wx.Point objects.
1069 return _core_
.Point___ne__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1071 def __add__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1073 __add__(self, Point pt) -> Point
1075 Add pt's proprties to this and return the result.
1077 return _core_
.Point___add__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1079 def __sub__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1081 __sub__(self, Point pt) -> Point
1083 Subtract pt's proprties from this and return the result
1085 return _core_
.Point___sub__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1087 def __iadd__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1089 __iadd__(self, Point pt) -> Point
1091 Add pt to this object.
1093 return _core_
.Point___iadd__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1095 def __isub__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1097 __isub__(self, Point pt) -> Point
1099 Subtract pt from this object.
1101 return _core_
.Point___isub__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1103 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
1105 Set(self, long x, long y)
1107 Set both the x and y properties
1109 return _core_
.Point_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
1111 def Get(*args
, **kwargs
):
1115 Return the x and y properties as a tuple.
1117 return _core_
.Point_Get(*args
, **kwargs
)
1119 asTuple
= wx
._deprecated
(Get
, "asTuple is deprecated, use `Get` instead")
1120 def __str__(self
): return str(self
.Get())
1121 def __repr__(self
): return 'wx.Point'+str(self
.Get())
1122 def __len__(self
): return len(self
.Get())
1123 def __getitem__(self
, index
): return self
.Get()[index
]
1124 def __setitem__(self
, index
, val
):
1125 if index
== 0: self
.x
= val
1126 elif index
== 1: self
.y
= val
1127 else: raise IndexError
1128 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Get() != (0,0)
1129 __safe_for_unpickling__
= True
1130 def __reduce__(self
): return (wx
.Point
, self
.Get())
1133 class PointPtr(Point
):
1134 def __init__(self
, this
):
1136 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1137 self
.__class
__ = Point
1138 _core_
.Point_swigregister(PointPtr
)
1140 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
1144 A class for representing and manipulating rectangles. It has x, y,
1145 width and height properties. In wxPython most palces that expect a
1146 wx.Rect can also accept a (x,y,width,height) tuple.
1149 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxRect instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1150 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1152 __init__(self, int x=0, int y=0, int width=0, int height=0) -> Rect
1154 Create a new Rect object.
1156 newobj
= _core_
.new_Rect(*args
, **kwargs
)
1157 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1160 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_Rect
):
1163 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
1166 def GetX(*args
, **kwargs
):
1167 """GetX(self) -> int"""
1168 return _core_
.Rect_GetX(*args
, **kwargs
)
1170 def SetX(*args
, **kwargs
):
1171 """SetX(self, int x)"""
1172 return _core_
.Rect_SetX(*args
, **kwargs
)
1174 def GetY(*args
, **kwargs
):
1175 """GetY(self) -> int"""
1176 return _core_
.Rect_GetY(*args
, **kwargs
)
1178 def SetY(*args
, **kwargs
):
1179 """SetY(self, int y)"""
1180 return _core_
.Rect_SetY(*args
, **kwargs
)
1182 def GetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
1183 """GetWidth(self) -> int"""
1184 return _core_
.Rect_GetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
1186 def SetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
1187 """SetWidth(self, int w)"""
1188 return _core_
.Rect_SetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
1190 def GetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
1191 """GetHeight(self) -> int"""
1192 return _core_
.Rect_GetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
1194 def SetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
1195 """SetHeight(self, int h)"""
1196 return _core_
.Rect_SetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
1198 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
1199 """GetPosition(self) -> Point"""
1200 return _core_
.Rect_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
1202 def SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
1203 """SetPosition(self, Point p)"""
1204 return _core_
.Rect_SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
1206 def GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
1207 """GetSize(self) -> Size"""
1208 return _core_
.Rect_GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
1210 def SetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
1211 """SetSize(self, Size s)"""
1212 return _core_
.Rect_SetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
1214 def IsEmpty(*args
, **kwargs
):
1215 """IsEmpty(self) -> bool"""
1216 return _core_
.Rect_IsEmpty(*args
, **kwargs
)
1218 def GetTopLeft(*args
, **kwargs
):
1219 """GetTopLeft(self) -> Point"""
1220 return _core_
.Rect_GetTopLeft(*args
, **kwargs
)
1222 def SetTopLeft(*args
, **kwargs
):
1223 """SetTopLeft(self, Point p)"""
1224 return _core_
.Rect_SetTopLeft(*args
, **kwargs
)
1226 def GetBottomRight(*args
, **kwargs
):
1227 """GetBottomRight(self) -> Point"""
1228 return _core_
.Rect_GetBottomRight(*args
, **kwargs
)
1230 def SetBottomRight(*args
, **kwargs
):
1231 """SetBottomRight(self, Point p)"""
1232 return _core_
.Rect_SetBottomRight(*args
, **kwargs
)
1234 def GetLeft(*args
, **kwargs
):
1235 """GetLeft(self) -> int"""
1236 return _core_
.Rect_GetLeft(*args
, **kwargs
)
1238 def GetTop(*args
, **kwargs
):
1239 """GetTop(self) -> int"""
1240 return _core_
.Rect_GetTop(*args
, **kwargs
)
1242 def GetBottom(*args
, **kwargs
):
1243 """GetBottom(self) -> int"""
1244 return _core_
.Rect_GetBottom(*args
, **kwargs
)
1246 def GetRight(*args
, **kwargs
):
1247 """GetRight(self) -> int"""
1248 return _core_
.Rect_GetRight(*args
, **kwargs
)
1250 def SetLeft(*args
, **kwargs
):
1251 """SetLeft(self, int left)"""
1252 return _core_
.Rect_SetLeft(*args
, **kwargs
)
1254 def SetRight(*args
, **kwargs
):
1255 """SetRight(self, int right)"""
1256 return _core_
.Rect_SetRight(*args
, **kwargs
)
1258 def SetTop(*args
, **kwargs
):
1259 """SetTop(self, int top)"""
1260 return _core_
.Rect_SetTop(*args
, **kwargs
)
1262 def SetBottom(*args
, **kwargs
):
1263 """SetBottom(self, int bottom)"""
1264 return _core_
.Rect_SetBottom(*args
, **kwargs
)
1266 position
= property(GetPosition
, SetPosition
)
1267 size
= property(GetSize
, SetSize
)
1268 left
= property(GetLeft
, SetLeft
)
1269 right
= property(GetRight
, SetRight
)
1270 top
= property(GetTop
, SetTop
)
1271 bottom
= property(GetBottom
, SetBottom
)
1273 def Inflate(*args
, **kwargs
):
1275 Inflate(self, int dx, int dy) -> Rect
1277 Increases the size of the rectangle.
1279 The left border is moved farther left and the right border is moved
1280 farther right by ``dx``. The upper border is moved farther up and the
1281 bottom border is moved farther down by ``dy``. (Note the the width and
1282 height of the rectangle thus change by ``2*dx`` and ``2*dy``,
1283 respectively.) If one or both of ``dx`` and ``dy`` are negative, the
1284 opposite happens: the rectangle size decreases in the respective
1287 The change is made to the rectangle inplace, if instead you need a
1288 copy that is inflated, preserving the original then make the copy
1291 copy = wx.Rect(*original)
1296 return _core_
.Rect_Inflate(*args
, **kwargs
)
1298 def Deflate(*args
, **kwargs
):
1300 Deflate(self, int dx, int dy) -> Rect
1302 Decrease the rectangle size. This method is the opposite of `Inflate`
1303 in that Deflate(a,b) is equivalent to Inflate(-a,-b). Please refer to
1304 `Inflate` for a full description.
1306 return _core_
.Rect_Deflate(*args
, **kwargs
)
1308 def OffsetXY(*args
, **kwargs
):
1310 OffsetXY(self, int dx, int dy)
1312 Moves the rectangle by the specified offset. If dx is positive, the
1313 rectangle is moved to the right, if dy is positive, it is moved to the
1314 bottom, otherwise it is moved to the left or top respectively.
1316 return _core_
.Rect_OffsetXY(*args
, **kwargs
)
1318 def Offset(*args
, **kwargs
):
1320 Offset(self, Point pt)
1322 Same as OffsetXY but uses dx,dy from Point
1324 return _core_
.Rect_Offset(*args
, **kwargs
)
1326 def Intersect(*args
, **kwargs
):
1328 Intersect(self, Rect rect) -> Rect
1330 Returns the intersectsion of this rectangle and rect.
1332 return _core_
.Rect_Intersect(*args
, **kwargs
)
1334 def Union(*args
, **kwargs
):
1336 Union(self, Rect rect) -> Rect
1338 Returns the union of this rectangle and rect.
1340 return _core_
.Rect_Union(*args
, **kwargs
)
1342 def __add__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1344 __add__(self, Rect rect) -> Rect
1346 Add the properties of rect to this rectangle and return the result.
1348 return _core_
.Rect___add__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1350 def __iadd__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1352 __iadd__(self, Rect rect) -> Rect
1354 Add the properties of rect to this rectangle, updating this rectangle.
1356 return _core_
.Rect___iadd__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1358 def __eq__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1360 __eq__(self, Rect rect) -> bool
1364 return _core_
.Rect___eq__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1366 def __ne__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1368 __ne__(self, Rect rect) -> bool
1370 Test for inequality.
1372 return _core_
.Rect___ne__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1374 def InsideXY(*args
, **kwargs
):
1376 InsideXY(self, int x, int y) -> bool
1378 Return True if the point is (not strcitly) inside the rect.
1380 return _core_
.Rect_InsideXY(*args
, **kwargs
)
1382 def Inside(*args
, **kwargs
):
1384 Inside(self, Point pt) -> bool
1386 Return True if the point is (not strcitly) inside the rect.
1388 return _core_
.Rect_Inside(*args
, **kwargs
)
1390 def Intersects(*args
, **kwargs
):
1392 Intersects(self, Rect rect) -> bool
1394 Returns True if the rectangles have a non empty intersection.
1396 return _core_
.Rect_Intersects(*args
, **kwargs
)
1398 x
= property(_core_
.Rect_x_get
, _core_
.Rect_x_set
)
1399 y
= property(_core_
.Rect_y_get
, _core_
.Rect_y_set
)
1400 width
= property(_core_
.Rect_width_get
, _core_
.Rect_width_set
)
1401 height
= property(_core_
.Rect_height_get
, _core_
.Rect_height_set
)
1402 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
1404 Set(self, int x=0, int y=0, int width=0, int height=0)
1406 Set all rectangle properties.
1408 return _core_
.Rect_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
1410 def Get(*args
, **kwargs
):
1412 Get() -> (x,y,width,height)
1414 Return the rectangle properties as a tuple.
1416 return _core_
.Rect_Get(*args
, **kwargs
)
1418 asTuple
= wx
._deprecated
(Get
, "asTuple is deprecated, use `Get` instead")
1419 def __str__(self
): return str(self
.Get())
1420 def __repr__(self
): return 'wx.Rect'+str(self
.Get())
1421 def __len__(self
): return len(self
.Get())
1422 def __getitem__(self
, index
): return self
.Get()[index
]
1423 def __setitem__(self
, index
, val
):
1424 if index
== 0: self
.x
= val
1425 elif index
== 1: self
.y
= val
1426 elif index
== 2: self
.width
= val
1427 elif index
== 3: self
.height
= val
1428 else: raise IndexError
1429 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Get() != (0,0,0,0)
1430 __safe_for_unpickling__
= True
1431 def __reduce__(self
): return (wx
.Rect
, self
.Get())
1434 class RectPtr(Rect
):
1435 def __init__(self
, this
):
1437 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1438 self
.__class
__ = Rect
1439 _core_
.Rect_swigregister(RectPtr
)
1441 def RectPP(*args
, **kwargs
):
1443 RectPP(Point topLeft, Point bottomRight) -> Rect
1445 Create a new Rect object from Points representing two corners.
1447 val
= _core_
.new_RectPP(*args
, **kwargs
)
1451 def RectPS(*args
, **kwargs
):
1453 RectPS(Point pos, Size size) -> Rect
1455 Create a new Rect from a position and size.
1457 val
= _core_
.new_RectPS(*args
, **kwargs
)
1461 def RectS(*args
, **kwargs
):
1463 RectS(Size size) -> Rect
1465 Create a new Rect from a size only.
1467 val
= _core_
.new_RectS(*args
, **kwargs
)
1472 def IntersectRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
1474 IntersectRect(Rect r1, Rect r2) -> Rect
1476 Calculate and return the intersection of r1 and r2.
1478 return _core_
.IntersectRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
1479 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
1481 class Point2D(object):
1483 wx.Point2Ds represent a point or a vector in a 2d coordinate system
1484 with floating point values.
1487 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPoint2D instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1488 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1490 __init__(self, double x=0.0, double y=0.0) -> Point2D
1492 Create a w.Point2D object.
1494 newobj
= _core_
.new_Point2D(*args
, **kwargs
)
1495 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1498 def GetFloor(*args
, **kwargs
):
1504 return _core_
.Point2D_GetFloor(*args
, **kwargs
)
1506 def GetRounded(*args
, **kwargs
):
1508 GetRounded() -> (x,y)
1512 return _core_
.Point2D_GetRounded(*args
, **kwargs
)
1514 def GetVectorLength(*args
, **kwargs
):
1515 """GetVectorLength(self) -> double"""
1516 return _core_
.Point2D_GetVectorLength(*args
, **kwargs
)
1518 def GetVectorAngle(*args
, **kwargs
):
1519 """GetVectorAngle(self) -> double"""
1520 return _core_
.Point2D_GetVectorAngle(*args
, **kwargs
)
1522 def SetVectorLength(*args
, **kwargs
):
1523 """SetVectorLength(self, double length)"""
1524 return _core_
.Point2D_SetVectorLength(*args
, **kwargs
)
1526 def SetVectorAngle(*args
, **kwargs
):
1527 """SetVectorAngle(self, double degrees)"""
1528 return _core_
.Point2D_SetVectorAngle(*args
, **kwargs
)
1530 def SetPolarCoordinates(self
, angle
, length
):
1531 self
.SetVectorLength(length
)
1532 self
.SetVectorAngle(angle
)
1533 def Normalize(self
):
1534 self
.SetVectorLength(1.0)
1536 def GetDistance(*args
, **kwargs
):
1537 """GetDistance(self, Point2D pt) -> double"""
1538 return _core_
.Point2D_GetDistance(*args
, **kwargs
)
1540 def GetDistanceSquare(*args
, **kwargs
):
1541 """GetDistanceSquare(self, Point2D pt) -> double"""
1542 return _core_
.Point2D_GetDistanceSquare(*args
, **kwargs
)
1544 def GetDotProduct(*args
, **kwargs
):
1545 """GetDotProduct(self, Point2D vec) -> double"""
1546 return _core_
.Point2D_GetDotProduct(*args
, **kwargs
)
1548 def GetCrossProduct(*args
, **kwargs
):
1549 """GetCrossProduct(self, Point2D vec) -> double"""
1550 return _core_
.Point2D_GetCrossProduct(*args
, **kwargs
)
1552 def __neg__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1554 __neg__(self) -> Point2D
1556 the reflection of this point
1558 return _core_
.Point2D___neg__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1560 def __iadd__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1561 """__iadd__(self, Point2D pt) -> Point2D"""
1562 return _core_
.Point2D___iadd__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1564 def __isub__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1565 """__isub__(self, Point2D pt) -> Point2D"""
1566 return _core_
.Point2D___isub__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1568 def __imul__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1569 """__imul__(self, Point2D pt) -> Point2D"""
1570 return _core_
.Point2D___imul__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1572 def __idiv__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1573 """__idiv__(self, Point2D pt) -> Point2D"""
1574 return _core_
.Point2D___idiv__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1576 def __eq__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1578 __eq__(self, Point2D pt) -> bool
1582 return _core_
.Point2D___eq__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1584 def __ne__(*args
, **kwargs
):
1586 __ne__(self, Point2D pt) -> bool
1590 return _core_
.Point2D___ne__(*args
, **kwargs
)
1592 x
= property(_core_
.Point2D_x_get
, _core_
.Point2D_x_set
)
1593 y
= property(_core_
.Point2D_y_get
, _core_
.Point2D_y_set
)
1594 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
1595 """Set(self, double x=0, double y=0)"""
1596 return _core_
.Point2D_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
1598 def Get(*args
, **kwargs
):
1602 Return x and y properties as a tuple.
1604 return _core_
.Point2D_Get(*args
, **kwargs
)
1606 asTuple
= wx
._deprecated
(Get
, "asTuple is deprecated, use `Get` instead")
1607 def __str__(self
): return str(self
.Get())
1608 def __repr__(self
): return 'wx.Point2D'+str(self
.Get())
1609 def __len__(self
): return len(self
.Get())
1610 def __getitem__(self
, index
): return self
.Get()[index
]
1611 def __setitem__(self
, index
, val
):
1612 if index
== 0: self
.x
= val
1613 elif index
== 1: self
.y
= val
1614 else: raise IndexError
1615 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Get() != (0.0, 0.0)
1616 __safe_for_unpickling__
= True
1617 def __reduce__(self
): return (wx
.Point2D
, self
.Get())
1620 class Point2DPtr(Point2D
):
1621 def __init__(self
, this
):
1623 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1624 self
.__class
__ = Point2D
1625 _core_
.Point2D_swigregister(Point2DPtr
)
1627 def Point2DCopy(*args
, **kwargs
):
1629 Point2DCopy(Point2D pt) -> Point2D
1631 Create a w.Point2D object.
1633 val
= _core_
.new_Point2DCopy(*args
, **kwargs
)
1637 def Point2DFromPoint(*args
, **kwargs
):
1639 Point2DFromPoint(Point pt) -> Point2D
1641 Create a w.Point2D object.
1643 val
= _core_
.new_Point2DFromPoint(*args
, **kwargs
)
1647 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
1649 FromStart
= _core_
.FromStart
1650 FromCurrent
= _core_
.FromCurrent
1651 FromEnd
= _core_
.FromEnd
1652 class InputStream(object):
1653 """Proxy of C++ InputStream class"""
1655 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPyInputStream instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1656 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1657 """__init__(self, PyObject p) -> InputStream"""
1658 newobj
= _core_
.new_InputStream(*args
, **kwargs
)
1659 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1662 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_InputStream
):
1665 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
1668 def close(*args
, **kwargs
):
1670 return _core_
.InputStream_close(*args
, **kwargs
)
1672 def flush(*args
, **kwargs
):
1674 return _core_
.InputStream_flush(*args
, **kwargs
)
1676 def eof(*args
, **kwargs
):
1677 """eof(self) -> bool"""
1678 return _core_
.InputStream_eof(*args
, **kwargs
)
1680 def read(*args
, **kwargs
):
1681 """read(self, int size=-1) -> PyObject"""
1682 return _core_
.InputStream_read(*args
, **kwargs
)
1684 def readline(*args
, **kwargs
):
1685 """readline(self, int size=-1) -> PyObject"""
1686 return _core_
.InputStream_readline(*args
, **kwargs
)
1688 def readlines(*args
, **kwargs
):
1689 """readlines(self, int sizehint=-1) -> PyObject"""
1690 return _core_
.InputStream_readlines(*args
, **kwargs
)
1692 def seek(*args
, **kwargs
):
1693 """seek(self, int offset, int whence=0)"""
1694 return _core_
.InputStream_seek(*args
, **kwargs
)
1696 def tell(*args
, **kwargs
):
1697 """tell(self) -> int"""
1698 return _core_
.InputStream_tell(*args
, **kwargs
)
1700 def Peek(*args
, **kwargs
):
1701 """Peek(self) -> char"""
1702 return _core_
.InputStream_Peek(*args
, **kwargs
)
1704 def GetC(*args
, **kwargs
):
1705 """GetC(self) -> char"""
1706 return _core_
.InputStream_GetC(*args
, **kwargs
)
1708 def LastRead(*args
, **kwargs
):
1709 """LastRead(self) -> size_t"""
1710 return _core_
.InputStream_LastRead(*args
, **kwargs
)
1712 def CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
):
1713 """CanRead(self) -> bool"""
1714 return _core_
.InputStream_CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
)
1716 def Eof(*args
, **kwargs
):
1717 """Eof(self) -> bool"""
1718 return _core_
.InputStream_Eof(*args
, **kwargs
)
1720 def Ungetch(*args
, **kwargs
):
1721 """Ungetch(self, char c) -> bool"""
1722 return _core_
.InputStream_Ungetch(*args
, **kwargs
)
1724 def SeekI(*args
, **kwargs
):
1725 """SeekI(self, long pos, int mode=FromStart) -> long"""
1726 return _core_
.InputStream_SeekI(*args
, **kwargs
)
1728 def TellI(*args
, **kwargs
):
1729 """TellI(self) -> long"""
1730 return _core_
.InputStream_TellI(*args
, **kwargs
)
1733 class InputStreamPtr(InputStream
):
1734 def __init__(self
, this
):
1736 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1737 self
.__class
__ = InputStream
1738 _core_
.InputStream_swigregister(InputStreamPtr
)
1739 DefaultPosition
= cvar
.DefaultPosition
1740 DefaultSize
= cvar
.DefaultSize
1742 class OutputStream(object):
1743 """Proxy of C++ OutputStream class"""
1744 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
1746 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxOutputStream instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1747 def write(*args
, **kwargs
):
1748 """write(self, PyObject obj)"""
1749 return _core_
.OutputStream_write(*args
, **kwargs
)
1752 class OutputStreamPtr(OutputStream
):
1753 def __init__(self
, this
):
1755 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1756 self
.__class
__ = OutputStream
1757 _core_
.OutputStream_swigregister(OutputStreamPtr
)
1759 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
1761 class FSFile(Object
):
1762 """Proxy of C++ FSFile class"""
1764 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxFSFile instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1765 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1767 __init__(self, InputStream stream, String loc, String mimetype, String anchor,
1768 DateTime modif) -> FSFile
1770 newobj
= _core_
.new_FSFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
1771 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1774 self
.thisown
= 0 # It will normally be deleted by the user of the wx.FileSystem
1776 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_FSFile
):
1779 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
1782 def GetStream(*args
, **kwargs
):
1783 """GetStream(self) -> InputStream"""
1784 return _core_
.FSFile_GetStream(*args
, **kwargs
)
1786 def GetMimeType(*args
, **kwargs
):
1787 """GetMimeType(self) -> String"""
1788 return _core_
.FSFile_GetMimeType(*args
, **kwargs
)
1790 def GetLocation(*args
, **kwargs
):
1791 """GetLocation(self) -> String"""
1792 return _core_
.FSFile_GetLocation(*args
, **kwargs
)
1794 def GetAnchor(*args
, **kwargs
):
1795 """GetAnchor(self) -> String"""
1796 return _core_
.FSFile_GetAnchor(*args
, **kwargs
)
1798 def GetModificationTime(*args
, **kwargs
):
1799 """GetModificationTime(self) -> DateTime"""
1800 return _core_
.FSFile_GetModificationTime(*args
, **kwargs
)
1803 class FSFilePtr(FSFile
):
1804 def __init__(self
, this
):
1806 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1807 self
.__class
__ = FSFile
1808 _core_
.FSFile_swigregister(FSFilePtr
)
1810 class CPPFileSystemHandler(object):
1811 """Proxy of C++ CPPFileSystemHandler class"""
1812 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
1814 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxFileSystemHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1816 class CPPFileSystemHandlerPtr(CPPFileSystemHandler
):
1817 def __init__(self
, this
):
1819 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1820 self
.__class
__ = CPPFileSystemHandler
1821 _core_
.CPPFileSystemHandler_swigregister(CPPFileSystemHandlerPtr
)
1823 class FileSystemHandler(CPPFileSystemHandler
):
1824 """Proxy of C++ FileSystemHandler class"""
1826 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPyFileSystemHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1827 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1828 """__init__(self) -> FileSystemHandler"""
1829 newobj
= _core_
.new_FileSystemHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
1830 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1833 self
._setCallbackInfo
(self
, FileSystemHandler
)
1835 def _setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
):
1836 """_setCallbackInfo(self, PyObject self, PyObject _class)"""
1837 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler__setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
)
1839 def CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
):
1840 """CanOpen(self, String location) -> bool"""
1841 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
)
1843 def OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
1844 """OpenFile(self, FileSystem fs, String location) -> FSFile"""
1845 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
1847 def FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
):
1848 """FindFirst(self, String spec, int flags=0) -> String"""
1849 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
)
1851 def FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
):
1852 """FindNext(self) -> String"""
1853 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
)
1855 def GetProtocol(*args
, **kwargs
):
1856 """GetProtocol(self, String location) -> String"""
1857 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_GetProtocol(*args
, **kwargs
)
1859 def GetLeftLocation(*args
, **kwargs
):
1860 """GetLeftLocation(self, String location) -> String"""
1861 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_GetLeftLocation(*args
, **kwargs
)
1863 def GetAnchor(*args
, **kwargs
):
1864 """GetAnchor(self, String location) -> String"""
1865 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_GetAnchor(*args
, **kwargs
)
1867 def GetRightLocation(*args
, **kwargs
):
1868 """GetRightLocation(self, String location) -> String"""
1869 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_GetRightLocation(*args
, **kwargs
)
1871 def GetMimeTypeFromExt(*args
, **kwargs
):
1872 """GetMimeTypeFromExt(self, String location) -> String"""
1873 return _core_
.FileSystemHandler_GetMimeTypeFromExt(*args
, **kwargs
)
1876 class FileSystemHandlerPtr(FileSystemHandler
):
1877 def __init__(self
, this
):
1879 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1880 self
.__class
__ = FileSystemHandler
1881 _core_
.FileSystemHandler_swigregister(FileSystemHandlerPtr
)
1883 class FileSystem(Object
):
1884 """Proxy of C++ FileSystem class"""
1886 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxFileSystem instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1887 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1888 """__init__(self) -> FileSystem"""
1889 newobj
= _core_
.new_FileSystem(*args
, **kwargs
)
1890 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1893 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_FileSystem
):
1896 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
1899 def ChangePathTo(*args
, **kwargs
):
1900 """ChangePathTo(self, String location, bool is_dir=False)"""
1901 return _core_
.FileSystem_ChangePathTo(*args
, **kwargs
)
1903 def GetPath(*args
, **kwargs
):
1904 """GetPath(self) -> String"""
1905 return _core_
.FileSystem_GetPath(*args
, **kwargs
)
1907 def OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
1908 """OpenFile(self, String location) -> FSFile"""
1909 return _core_
.FileSystem_OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
1911 def FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
):
1912 """FindFirst(self, String spec, int flags=0) -> String"""
1913 return _core_
.FileSystem_FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
)
1915 def FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
):
1916 """FindNext(self) -> String"""
1917 return _core_
.FileSystem_FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
)
1919 def AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
1920 """AddHandler(CPPFileSystemHandler handler)"""
1921 return _core_
.FileSystem_AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
1923 AddHandler
= staticmethod(AddHandler
)
1924 def CleanUpHandlers(*args
, **kwargs
):
1925 """CleanUpHandlers()"""
1926 return _core_
.FileSystem_CleanUpHandlers(*args
, **kwargs
)
1928 CleanUpHandlers
= staticmethod(CleanUpHandlers
)
1929 def FileNameToURL(*args
, **kwargs
):
1930 """FileNameToURL(String filename) -> String"""
1931 return _core_
.FileSystem_FileNameToURL(*args
, **kwargs
)
1933 FileNameToURL
= staticmethod(FileNameToURL
)
1934 def URLToFileName(*args
, **kwargs
):
1935 """URLToFileName(String url) -> String"""
1936 return _core_
.FileSystem_URLToFileName(*args
, **kwargs
)
1938 URLToFileName
= staticmethod(URLToFileName
)
1940 class FileSystemPtr(FileSystem
):
1941 def __init__(self
, this
):
1943 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1944 self
.__class
__ = FileSystem
1945 _core_
.FileSystem_swigregister(FileSystemPtr
)
1947 def FileSystem_AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
1948 """FileSystem_AddHandler(CPPFileSystemHandler handler)"""
1949 return _core_
.FileSystem_AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
1951 def FileSystem_CleanUpHandlers(*args
, **kwargs
):
1952 """FileSystem_CleanUpHandlers()"""
1953 return _core_
.FileSystem_CleanUpHandlers(*args
, **kwargs
)
1955 def FileSystem_FileNameToURL(*args
, **kwargs
):
1956 """FileSystem_FileNameToURL(String filename) -> String"""
1957 return _core_
.FileSystem_FileNameToURL(*args
, **kwargs
)
1959 def FileSystem_URLToFileName(*args
, **kwargs
):
1960 """FileSystem_URLToFileName(String url) -> String"""
1961 return _core_
.FileSystem_URLToFileName(*args
, **kwargs
)
1963 class InternetFSHandler(CPPFileSystemHandler
):
1964 """Proxy of C++ InternetFSHandler class"""
1966 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxInternetFSHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1967 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1968 """__init__(self) -> InternetFSHandler"""
1969 newobj
= _core_
.new_InternetFSHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
1970 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1973 def CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
):
1974 """CanOpen(self, String location) -> bool"""
1975 return _core_
.InternetFSHandler_CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
)
1977 def OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
1978 """OpenFile(self, FileSystem fs, String location) -> FSFile"""
1979 return _core_
.InternetFSHandler_OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
1982 class InternetFSHandlerPtr(InternetFSHandler
):
1983 def __init__(self
, this
):
1985 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
1986 self
.__class
__ = InternetFSHandler
1987 _core_
.InternetFSHandler_swigregister(InternetFSHandlerPtr
)
1989 class ZipFSHandler(CPPFileSystemHandler
):
1990 """Proxy of C++ ZipFSHandler class"""
1992 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxZipFSHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
1993 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
1994 """__init__(self) -> ZipFSHandler"""
1995 newobj
= _core_
.new_ZipFSHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
1996 self
.this
= newobj
.this
1999 def CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
):
2000 """CanOpen(self, String location) -> bool"""
2001 return _core_
.ZipFSHandler_CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
)
2003 def OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2004 """OpenFile(self, FileSystem fs, String location) -> FSFile"""
2005 return _core_
.ZipFSHandler_OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2007 def FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
):
2008 """FindFirst(self, String spec, int flags=0) -> String"""
2009 return _core_
.ZipFSHandler_FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
)
2011 def FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
):
2012 """FindNext(self) -> String"""
2013 return _core_
.ZipFSHandler_FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
)
2016 class ZipFSHandlerPtr(ZipFSHandler
):
2017 def __init__(self
, this
):
2019 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
2020 self
.__class
__ = ZipFSHandler
2021 _core_
.ZipFSHandler_swigregister(ZipFSHandlerPtr
)
2024 def __wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_wxImage(*args
, **kwargs
):
2025 """__wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_wxImage(String filename, Image image, long type)"""
2026 return _core_
.__wxMemoryFSHandler
_AddFile
_wxImage
(*args
, **kwargs
)
2028 def __wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_wxBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
2029 """__wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_wxBitmap(String filename, Bitmap bitmap, long type)"""
2030 return _core_
.__wxMemoryFSHandler
_AddFile
_wxBitmap
(*args
, **kwargs
)
2032 def __wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_Data(*args
, **kwargs
):
2033 """__wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_Data(String filename, PyObject data)"""
2034 return _core_
.__wxMemoryFSHandler
_AddFile
_Data
(*args
, **kwargs
)
2035 def MemoryFSHandler_AddFile(filename
, dataItem
, imgType
=-1):
2037 Add 'file' to the memory filesystem. The dataItem parameter can
2038 either be a `wx.Bitmap`, `wx.Image` or a string that can contain
2039 arbitrary data. If a bitmap or image is used then the imgType
2040 parameter should specify what kind of image file it should be
2041 written as, wx.BITMAP_TYPE_PNG, etc.
2043 if isinstance(dataItem
, wx
.Image
):
2044 __wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_wxImage(filename
, dataItem
, imgType
)
2045 elif isinstance(dataItem
, wx
.Bitmap
):
2046 __wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_wxBitmap(filename
, dataItem
, imgType
)
2047 elif type(dataItem
) == str:
2048 __wxMemoryFSHandler_AddFile_Data(filename
, dataItem
)
2050 raise TypeError, 'wx.Image, wx.Bitmap or string expected'
2052 class MemoryFSHandler(CPPFileSystemHandler
):
2053 """Proxy of C++ MemoryFSHandler class"""
2055 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMemoryFSHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
2056 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
2057 """__init__(self) -> MemoryFSHandler"""
2058 newobj
= _core_
.new_MemoryFSHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
2059 self
.this
= newobj
.this
2062 def RemoveFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2063 """RemoveFile(String filename)"""
2064 return _core_
.MemoryFSHandler_RemoveFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2066 RemoveFile
= staticmethod(RemoveFile
)
2067 AddFile
= staticmethod(MemoryFSHandler_AddFile
)
2068 def CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
):
2069 """CanOpen(self, String location) -> bool"""
2070 return _core_
.MemoryFSHandler_CanOpen(*args
, **kwargs
)
2072 def OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2073 """OpenFile(self, FileSystem fs, String location) -> FSFile"""
2074 return _core_
.MemoryFSHandler_OpenFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2076 def FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
):
2077 """FindFirst(self, String spec, int flags=0) -> String"""
2078 return _core_
.MemoryFSHandler_FindFirst(*args
, **kwargs
)
2080 def FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
):
2081 """FindNext(self) -> String"""
2082 return _core_
.MemoryFSHandler_FindNext(*args
, **kwargs
)
2085 class MemoryFSHandlerPtr(MemoryFSHandler
):
2086 def __init__(self
, this
):
2088 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
2089 self
.__class
__ = MemoryFSHandler
2090 _core_
.MemoryFSHandler_swigregister(MemoryFSHandlerPtr
)
2092 def MemoryFSHandler_RemoveFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2093 """MemoryFSHandler_RemoveFile(String filename)"""
2094 return _core_
.MemoryFSHandler_RemoveFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2096 IMAGE_ALPHA_TRANSPARENT
= _core_
.IMAGE_ALPHA_TRANSPARENT
2097 IMAGE_ALPHA_THRESHOLD
= _core_
.IMAGE_ALPHA_THRESHOLD
2098 IMAGE_ALPHA_OPAQUE
= _core_
.IMAGE_ALPHA_OPAQUE
2099 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
2101 class ImageHandler(Object
):
2103 This is the base class for implementing image file loading/saving, and
2104 image creation from data. It is used within `wx.Image` and is not
2105 normally seen by the application.
2107 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
2109 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxImageHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
2110 def GetName(*args
, **kwargs
):
2111 """GetName(self) -> String"""
2112 return _core_
.ImageHandler_GetName(*args
, **kwargs
)
2114 def GetExtension(*args
, **kwargs
):
2115 """GetExtension(self) -> String"""
2116 return _core_
.ImageHandler_GetExtension(*args
, **kwargs
)
2118 def GetType(*args
, **kwargs
):
2119 """GetType(self) -> long"""
2120 return _core_
.ImageHandler_GetType(*args
, **kwargs
)
2122 def GetMimeType(*args
, **kwargs
):
2123 """GetMimeType(self) -> String"""
2124 return _core_
.ImageHandler_GetMimeType(*args
, **kwargs
)
2126 def CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
):
2127 """CanRead(self, String name) -> bool"""
2128 return _core_
.ImageHandler_CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
)
2130 def SetName(*args
, **kwargs
):
2131 """SetName(self, String name)"""
2132 return _core_
.ImageHandler_SetName(*args
, **kwargs
)
2134 def SetExtension(*args
, **kwargs
):
2135 """SetExtension(self, String extension)"""
2136 return _core_
.ImageHandler_SetExtension(*args
, **kwargs
)
2138 def SetType(*args
, **kwargs
):
2139 """SetType(self, long type)"""
2140 return _core_
.ImageHandler_SetType(*args
, **kwargs
)
2142 def SetMimeType(*args
, **kwargs
):
2143 """SetMimeType(self, String mimetype)"""
2144 return _core_
.ImageHandler_SetMimeType(*args
, **kwargs
)
2147 class ImageHandlerPtr(ImageHandler
):
2148 def __init__(self
, this
):
2150 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
2151 self
.__class
__ = ImageHandler
2152 _core_
.ImageHandler_swigregister(ImageHandlerPtr
)
2154 class PyImageHandler(ImageHandler
):
2156 This is the base class for implementing image file loading/saving, and
2157 image creation from data, all written in Python. To create a custom
2158 image handler derive a new class from wx.PyImageHandler and provide
2159 the following methods::
2161 def DoCanRead(self, stream) --> bool
2162 '''Check if this handler can read the image on the stream'''
2164 def LoadFile(self, image, stream, verbose, index) --> bool
2165 '''Load image data from the stream and load it into image.'''
2167 def SaveFile(self, image, stream, verbose) --> bool
2168 '''Save the iamge data in image to the stream using
2169 this handler's image file format.'''
2171 def GetImageCount(self, stream) --> int
2172 '''If this image format can hold more than one image,
2173 how many does the image on the stream have?'''
2175 To activate your handler create an instance of it and pass it to
2176 `wx.Image_AddHandler`. Be sure to call `SetName`, `SetType`, and
2177 `SetExtension` from your constructor.
2181 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPyImageHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
2182 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
2184 __init__(self) -> PyImageHandler
2186 This is the base class for implementing image file loading/saving, and
2187 image creation from data, all written in Python. To create a custom
2188 image handler derive a new class from wx.PyImageHandler and provide
2189 the following methods::
2191 def DoCanRead(self, stream) --> bool
2192 '''Check if this handler can read the image on the stream'''
2194 def LoadFile(self, image, stream, verbose, index) --> bool
2195 '''Load image data from the stream and load it into image.'''
2197 def SaveFile(self, image, stream, verbose) --> bool
2198 '''Save the iamge data in image to the stream using
2199 this handler's image file format.'''
2201 def GetImageCount(self, stream) --> int
2202 '''If this image format can hold more than one image,
2203 how many does the image on the stream have?'''
2205 To activate your handler create an instance of it and pass it to
2206 `wx.Image_AddHandler`. Be sure to call `SetName`, `SetType`, and
2207 `SetExtension` from your constructor.
2210 newobj
= _core_
.new_PyImageHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
2211 self
.this
= newobj
.this
2216 def _SetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
):
2217 """_SetSelf(self, PyObject self)"""
2218 return _core_
.PyImageHandler__SetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
)
2221 class PyImageHandlerPtr(PyImageHandler
):
2222 def __init__(self
, this
):
2224 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
2225 self
.__class
__ = PyImageHandler
2226 _core_
.PyImageHandler_swigregister(PyImageHandlerPtr
)
2228 class ImageHistogram(object):
2229 """Proxy of C++ ImageHistogram class"""
2231 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxImageHistogram instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
2232 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
2233 """__init__(self) -> ImageHistogram"""
2234 newobj
= _core_
.new_ImageHistogram(*args
, **kwargs
)
2235 self
.this
= newobj
.this
2238 def MakeKey(*args
, **kwargs
):
2240 MakeKey(byte r, byte g, byte b) -> unsigned long
2242 Get the key in the histogram for the given RGB values
2244 return _core_
.ImageHistogram_MakeKey(*args
, **kwargs
)
2246 MakeKey
= staticmethod(MakeKey
)
2247 def FindFirstUnusedColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
2249 FindFirstUnusedColour(int startR=1, int startG=0, int startB=0) -> (success, r, g, b)
2251 Find first colour that is not used in the image and has higher RGB
2252 values than startR, startG, startB. Returns a tuple consisting of a
2253 success flag and rgb values.
2255 return _core_
.ImageHistogram_FindFirstUnusedColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
2257 def GetCount(*args
, **kwargs
):
2259 GetCount(self, unsigned long key) -> unsigned long
2261 Returns the pixel count for the given key. Use `MakeKey` to create a
2262 key value from a RGB tripple.
2264 return _core_
.ImageHistogram_GetCount(*args
, **kwargs
)
2266 def GetCountRGB(*args
, **kwargs
):
2268 GetCountRGB(self, byte r, byte g, byte b) -> unsigned long
2270 Returns the pixel count for the given RGB values.
2272 return _core_
.ImageHistogram_GetCountRGB(*args
, **kwargs
)
2274 def GetCountColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
2276 GetCountColour(self, Colour colour) -> unsigned long
2278 Returns the pixel count for the given `wx.Colour` value.
2280 return _core_
.ImageHistogram_GetCountColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
2283 class ImageHistogramPtr(ImageHistogram
):
2284 def __init__(self
, this
):
2286 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
2287 self
.__class
__ = ImageHistogram
2288 _core_
.ImageHistogram_swigregister(ImageHistogramPtr
)
2290 def ImageHistogram_MakeKey(*args
, **kwargs
):
2292 ImageHistogram_MakeKey(byte r, byte g, byte b) -> unsigned long
2294 Get the key in the histogram for the given RGB values
2296 return _core_
.ImageHistogram_MakeKey(*args
, **kwargs
)
2298 class Image_RGBValue(object):
2300 An object that contains values for red, green and blue which represent
2301 the value of a color. It is used by `wx.Image.HSVtoRGB` and
2302 `wx.Image.RGBtoHSV`, which converts between HSV color space and RGB
2306 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxImage_RGBValue instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
2307 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
2309 __init__(self, byte r=0, byte g=0, byte b=0) -> Image_RGBValue
2313 newobj
= _core_
.new_Image_RGBValue(*args
, **kwargs
)
2314 self
.this
= newobj
.this
2317 red
= property(_core_
.Image_RGBValue_red_get
, _core_
.Image_RGBValue_red_set
)
2318 green
= property(_core_
.Image_RGBValue_green_get
, _core_
.Image_RGBValue_green_set
)
2319 blue
= property(_core_
.Image_RGBValue_blue_get
, _core_
.Image_RGBValue_blue_set
)
2321 class Image_RGBValuePtr(Image_RGBValue
):
2322 def __init__(self
, this
):
2324 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
2325 self
.__class
__ = Image_RGBValue
2326 _core_
.Image_RGBValue_swigregister(Image_RGBValuePtr
)
2328 class Image_HSVValue(object):
2330 An object that contains values for hue, saturation and value which
2331 represent the value of a color. It is used by `wx.Image.HSVtoRGB` and
2332 `wx.Image.RGBtoHSV`, which +converts between HSV color space and RGB
2336 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxImage_HSVValue instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
2337 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
2339 __init__(self, double h=0.0, double s=0.0, double v=0.0) -> Image_HSVValue
2343 newobj
= _core_
.new_Image_HSVValue(*args
, **kwargs
)
2344 self
.this
= newobj
.this
2347 hue
= property(_core_
.Image_HSVValue_hue_get
, _core_
.Image_HSVValue_hue_set
)
2348 saturation
= property(_core_
.Image_HSVValue_saturation_get
, _core_
.Image_HSVValue_saturation_set
)
2349 value
= property(_core_
.Image_HSVValue_value_get
, _core_
.Image_HSVValue_value_set
)
2351 class Image_HSVValuePtr(Image_HSVValue
):
2352 def __init__(self
, this
):
2354 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
2355 self
.__class
__ = Image_HSVValue
2356 _core_
.Image_HSVValue_swigregister(Image_HSVValuePtr
)
2358 class Image(Object
):
2360 A platform-independent image class. An image can be created from
2361 data, or using `wx.Bitmap.ConvertToImage`, or loaded from a file in a
2362 variety of formats. Functions are available to set and get image
2363 bits, so it can be used for basic image manipulation.
2365 A wx.Image cannot be drawn directly to a `wx.DC`. Instead, a
2366 platform-specific `wx.Bitmap` object must be created from it using the
2367 `wx.BitmapFromImage` constructor. This bitmap can then be drawn in a
2368 device context, using `wx.DC.DrawBitmap`.
2370 One colour value of the image may be used as a mask colour which will
2371 lead to the automatic creation of a `wx.Mask` object associated to the
2374 wx.Image supports alpha channel data, that is in addition to a byte
2375 for the red, green and blue colour components for each pixel it also
2376 stores a byte representing the pixel opacity. An alpha value of 0
2377 corresponds to a transparent pixel (null opacity) while a value of 255
2378 means that the pixel is 100% opaque.
2380 Unlike RGB data, not all images have an alpha channel and before using
2381 `GetAlpha` you should check if this image contains an alpha channel
2382 with `HasAlpha`. Note that currently only images loaded from PNG files
2383 with transparency information will have an alpha channel.
2386 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxImage instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
2387 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
2389 __init__(self, String name, long type=BITMAP_TYPE_ANY, int index=-1) -> Image
2391 Loads an image from a file.
2393 newobj
= _core_
.new_Image(*args
, **kwargs
)
2394 self
.this
= newobj
.this
2397 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_Image
):
2400 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
2403 def Create(*args
, **kwargs
):
2405 Create(self, int width, int height, bool clear=True)
2407 Creates a fresh image. If clear is ``True``, the new image will be
2408 initialized to black. Otherwise, the image data will be uninitialized.
2410 return _core_
.Image_Create(*args
, **kwargs
)
2412 def Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
):
2416 Destroys the image data.
2418 return _core_
.Image_Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
)
2420 def Scale(*args
, **kwargs
):
2422 Scale(self, int width, int height) -> Image
2424 Returns a scaled version of the image. This is also useful for scaling
2425 bitmaps in general as the only other way to scale bitmaps is to blit a
2426 `wx.MemoryDC` into another `wx.MemoryDC`.
2428 return _core_
.Image_Scale(*args
, **kwargs
)
2430 def ShrinkBy(*args
, **kwargs
):
2432 ShrinkBy(self, int xFactor, int yFactor) -> Image
2434 Return a version of the image scaled smaller by the given factors.
2436 return _core_
.Image_ShrinkBy(*args
, **kwargs
)
2438 def Rescale(*args
, **kwargs
):
2440 Rescale(self, int width, int height) -> Image
2442 Changes the size of the image in-place by scaling it: after a call to
2443 this function, the image will have the given width and height.
2445 Returns the (modified) image itself.
2447 return _core_
.Image_Rescale(*args
, **kwargs
)
2449 def Resize(*args
, **kwargs
):
2451 Resize(self, Size size, Point pos, int r=-1, int g=-1, int b=-1) -> Image
2453 Changes the size of the image in-place without scaling it, by adding
2454 either a border with the given colour or cropping as necessary. The
2455 image is pasted into a new image with the given size and background
2456 colour at the position pos relative to the upper left of the new
2457 image. If red = green = blue = -1 then use either the current mask
2458 colour if set or find, use, and set a suitable mask colour for any
2459 newly exposed areas.
2461 Returns the (modified) image itself.
2463 return _core_
.Image_Resize(*args
, **kwargs
)
2465 def SetRGB(*args
, **kwargs
):
2467 SetRGB(self, int x, int y, byte r, byte g, byte b)
2469 Sets the pixel at the given coordinate. This routine performs
2470 bounds-checks for the coordinate so it can be considered a safe way to
2471 manipulate the data, but in some cases this might be too slow so that
2472 the data will have to be set directly. In that case you will have to
2473 get access to the image data using the `GetData` method.
2475 return _core_
.Image_SetRGB(*args
, **kwargs
)
2477 def SetRGBRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
2479 SetRGBRect(self, Rect rect, byte r, byte g, byte b)
2481 Sets the colour of the pixels within the given rectangle. This routine
2482 performs bounds-checks for the rectangle so it can be considered a
2483 safe way to manipulate the data.
2485 return _core_
.Image_SetRGBRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
2487 def GetRed(*args
, **kwargs
):
2489 GetRed(self, int x, int y) -> byte
2491 Returns the red intensity at the given coordinate.
2493 return _core_
.Image_GetRed(*args
, **kwargs
)
2495 def GetGreen(*args
, **kwargs
):
2497 GetGreen(self, int x, int y) -> byte
2499 Returns the green intensity at the given coordinate.
2501 return _core_
.Image_GetGreen(*args
, **kwargs
)
2503 def GetBlue(*args
, **kwargs
):
2505 GetBlue(self, int x, int y) -> byte
2507 Returns the blue intensity at the given coordinate.
2509 return _core_
.Image_GetBlue(*args
, **kwargs
)
2511 def SetAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
):
2513 SetAlpha(self, int x, int y, byte alpha)
2515 Sets the alpha value for the given pixel. This function should only be
2516 called if the image has alpha channel data, use `HasAlpha` to check
2519 return _core_
.Image_SetAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
)
2521 def GetAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
):
2523 GetAlpha(self, int x, int y) -> byte
2525 Returns the alpha value for the given pixel. This function may only be
2526 called for the images with alpha channel, use `HasAlpha` to check for
2529 The returned value is the *opacity* of the image, i.e. the value of 0
2530 corresponds to the fully transparent pixels while the value of 255 to
2531 the fully opaque pixels.
2533 return _core_
.Image_GetAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
)
2535 def HasAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
):
2537 HasAlpha(self) -> bool
2539 Returns true if this image has alpha channel, false otherwise.
2541 return _core_
.Image_HasAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
)
2543 def InitAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
):
2547 Initializes the image alpha channel data. It is an error to call it if
2548 the image already has alpha data. If it doesn't, alpha data will be by
2549 default initialized to all pixels being fully opaque. But if the image
2550 has a a mask colour, all mask pixels will be completely transparent.
2552 return _core_
.Image_InitAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
)
2554 def IsTransparent(*args
, **kwargs
):
2556 IsTransparent(self, int x, int y, byte threshold=IMAGE_ALPHA_THRESHOLD) -> bool
2558 Returns ``True`` if this pixel is masked or has an alpha value less
2559 than the spcified threshold.
2561 return _core_
.Image_IsTransparent(*args
, **kwargs
)
2563 def FindFirstUnusedColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
2565 FindFirstUnusedColour(int startR=1, int startG=0, int startB=0) -> (success, r, g, b)
2567 Find first colour that is not used in the image and has higher RGB
2568 values than startR, startG, startB. Returns a tuple consisting of a
2569 success flag and rgb values.
2571 return _core_
.Image_FindFirstUnusedColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
2573 def ConvertAlphaToMask(*args
, **kwargs
):
2575 ConvertAlphaToMask(self, byte threshold=IMAGE_ALPHA_THRESHOLD) -> bool
2577 If the image has alpha channel, this method converts it to mask. All
2578 pixels with alpha value less than ``threshold`` are replaced with the
2579 mask colour and the alpha channel is removed. The mask colour is
2580 chosen automatically using `FindFirstUnusedColour`.
2582 If the image image doesn't have alpha channel, ConvertAlphaToMask does
2585 return _core_
.Image_ConvertAlphaToMask(*args
, **kwargs
)
2587 def ConvertColourToAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
):
2589 ConvertColourToAlpha(self, byte r, byte g, byte b) -> bool
2591 This method converts an image where the original alpha information is
2592 only available as a shades of a colour (actually shades of grey)
2593 typically when you draw anti-aliased text into a bitmap. The DC
2594 drawing routines draw grey values on the black background although
2595 they actually mean to draw white with differnt alpha values. This
2596 method reverses it, assuming a black (!) background and white text.
2597 The method will then fill up the whole image with the colour given.
2599 return _core_
.Image_ConvertColourToAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
)
2601 def SetMaskFromImage(*args
, **kwargs
):
2603 SetMaskFromImage(self, Image mask, byte mr, byte mg, byte mb) -> bool
2605 Sets the image's mask so that the pixels that have RGB value of
2606 ``(mr,mg,mb)`` in ``mask`` will be masked in this image. This is done
2607 by first finding an unused colour in the image, setting this colour as
2608 the mask colour and then using this colour to draw all pixels in the
2609 image who corresponding pixel in mask has given RGB value.
2611 Returns ``False`` if ``mask`` does not have same dimensions as the
2612 image or if there is no unused colour left. Returns ``True`` if the
2613 mask was successfully applied.
2615 Note that this method involves computing the histogram, which is
2616 computationally intensive operation.
2618 return _core_
.Image_SetMaskFromImage(*args
, **kwargs
)
2620 def CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
):
2622 CanRead(String filename) -> bool
2624 Returns True if the image handlers can read this file.
2626 return _core_
.Image_CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
)
2628 CanRead
= staticmethod(CanRead
)
2629 def GetImageCount(*args
, **kwargs
):
2631 GetImageCount(String filename, long type=BITMAP_TYPE_ANY) -> int
2633 If the image file contains more than one image and the image handler
2634 is capable of retrieving these individually, this function will return
2635 the number of available images.
2637 return _core_
.Image_GetImageCount(*args
, **kwargs
)
2639 GetImageCount
= staticmethod(GetImageCount
)
2640 def LoadFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2642 LoadFile(self, String name, long type=BITMAP_TYPE_ANY, int index=-1) -> bool
2644 Loads an image from a file. If no handler type is provided, the
2645 library will try to autodetect the format.
2647 return _core_
.Image_LoadFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2649 def LoadMimeFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2651 LoadMimeFile(self, String name, String mimetype, int index=-1) -> bool
2653 Loads an image from a file, specifying the image type with a MIME type
2656 return _core_
.Image_LoadMimeFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2658 def SaveFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2660 SaveFile(self, String name, int type) -> bool
2662 Saves an image in the named file.
2664 return _core_
.Image_SaveFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2666 def SaveMimeFile(*args
, **kwargs
):
2668 SaveMimeFile(self, String name, String mimetype) -> bool
2670 Saves an image in the named file.
2672 return _core_
.Image_SaveMimeFile(*args
, **kwargs
)
2674 def CanReadStream(*args
, **kwargs
):
2676 CanReadStream(InputStream stream) -> bool
2678 Returns True if the image handlers can read an image file from the
2679 data currently on the input stream, or a readable Python file-like
2682 return _core_
.Image_CanReadStream(*args
, **kwargs
)
2684 CanReadStream
= staticmethod(CanReadStream
)
2685 def LoadStream(*args
, **kwargs
):
2687 LoadStream(self, InputStream stream, long type=BITMAP_TYPE_ANY, int index=-1) -> bool
2689 Loads an image from an input stream or a readable Python file-like
2690 object. If no handler type is provided, the library will try to
2691 autodetect the format.
2693 return _core_
.Image_LoadStream(*args
, **kwargs
)
2695 def LoadMimeStream(*args
, **kwargs
):
2697 LoadMimeStream(self, InputStream stream, String mimetype, int index=-1) -> bool
2699 Loads an image from an input stream or a readable Python file-like
2700 object, using a MIME type string to specify the image file format.
2702 return _core_
.Image_LoadMimeStream(*args
, **kwargs
)
2704 def Ok(*args
, **kwargs
):
2708 Returns true if image data is present.
2710 return _core_
.Image_Ok(*args
, **kwargs
)
2712 def GetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
2714 GetWidth(self) -> int
2716 Gets the width of the image in pixels.
2718 return _core_
.Image_GetWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
2720 def GetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
2722 GetHeight(self) -> int
2724 Gets the height of the image in pixels.
2726 return _core_
.Image_GetHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
2728 def GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
2730 GetSize(self) -> Size
2732 Returns the size of the image in pixels.
2734 return _core_
.Image_GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
2736 def GetSubImage(*args
, **kwargs
):
2738 GetSubImage(self, Rect rect) -> Image
2740 Returns a sub image of the current one as long as the rect belongs
2741 entirely to the image.
2743 return _core_
.Image_GetSubImage(*args
, **kwargs
)
2745 def Size(*args
, **kwargs
):
2747 Size(self, Size size, Point pos, int r=-1, int g=-1, int b=-1) -> Image
2749 Returns a resized version of this image without scaling it by adding
2750 either a border with the given colour or cropping as necessary. The
2751 image is pasted into a new image with the given size and background
2752 colour at the position ``pos`` relative to the upper left of the new
2753 image. If red = green = blue = -1 then use either the current mask
2754 colour if set or find, use, and set a suitable mask colour for any
2755 newly exposed areas.
2757 return _core_
.Image_Size(*args
, **kwargs
)
2759 def Copy(*args
, **kwargs
):
2763 Returns an identical copy of the image.
2765 return _core_
.Image_Copy(*args
, **kwargs
)
2767 def Paste(*args
, **kwargs
):
2769 Paste(self, Image image, int x, int y)
2771 Pastes ``image`` into this instance and takes care of the mask colour
2772 and any out of bounds problems.
2774 return _core_
.Image_Paste(*args
, **kwargs
)
2776 def GetData(*args
, **kwargs
):
2778 GetData(self) -> PyObject
2780 Returns a string containing a copy of the RGB bytes of the image.
2782 return _core_
.Image_GetData(*args
, **kwargs
)
2784 def SetData(*args
, **kwargs
):
2786 SetData(self, buffer data)
2788 Resets the Image's RGB data from a buffer of RGB bytes. Accepts
2789 either a string or a buffer object holding the data and the length of
2790 the data must be width*height*3.
2792 return _core_
.Image_SetData(*args
, **kwargs
)
2794 def GetDataBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
):
2796 GetDataBuffer(self) -> PyObject
2798 Returns a writable Python buffer object that is pointing at the RGB
2799 image data buffer inside the wx.Image. You need to ensure that you do
2800 not use this buffer object after the image has been destroyed.
2802 return _core_
.Image_GetDataBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
)
2804 def SetDataBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
):
2806 SetDataBuffer(self, buffer data)
2808 Sets the internal image data pointer to point at a Python buffer
2809 object. This can save making an extra copy of the data but you must
2810 ensure that the buffer object lives longer than the wx.Image does.
2812 return _core_
.Image_SetDataBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
)
2814 def GetAlphaData(*args
, **kwargs
):
2816 GetAlphaData(self) -> PyObject
2818 Returns a string containing a copy of the alpha bytes of the image.
2820 return _core_
.Image_GetAlphaData(*args
, **kwargs
)
2822 def SetAlphaData(*args
, **kwargs
):
2824 SetAlphaData(self, buffer alpha)
2826 Resets the Image's alpha data from a buffer of bytes. Accepts either
2827 a string or a buffer object holding the data and the length of the
2828 data must be width*height.
2830 return _core_
.Image_SetAlphaData(*args
, **kwargs
)
2832 def GetAlphaBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
):
2833 """GetAlphaBuffer(self) -> PyObject"""
2834 return _core_
.Image_GetAlphaBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
)
2836 def SetAlphaBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
):
2837 """SetAlphaBuffer(self, buffer alpha)"""
2838 return _core_
.Image_SetAlphaBuffer(*args
, **kwargs
)
2840 def SetMaskColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
2842 SetMaskColour(self, byte r, byte g, byte b)
2844 Sets the mask colour for this image (and tells the image to use the
2847 return _core_
.Image_SetMaskColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
2849 def GetOrFindMaskColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
2851 GetOrFindMaskColour() -> (r,g,b)
2853 Get the current mask colour or find a suitable colour.
2855 return _core_
.Image_GetOrFindMaskColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
2857 def GetMaskRed(*args
, **kwargs
):
2859 GetMaskRed(self) -> byte
2861 Gets the red component of the mask colour.
2863 return _core_
.Image_GetMaskRed(*args
, **kwargs
)
2865 def GetMaskGreen(*args
, **kwargs
):
2867 GetMaskGreen(self) -> byte
2869 Gets the green component of the mask colour.
2871 return _core_
.Image_GetMaskGreen(*args
, **kwargs
)
2873 def GetMaskBlue(*args
, **kwargs
):
2875 GetMaskBlue(self) -> byte
2877 Gets the blue component of the mask colour.
2879 return _core_
.Image_GetMaskBlue(*args
, **kwargs
)
2881 def SetMask(*args
, **kwargs
):
2883 SetMask(self, bool mask=True)
2885 Specifies whether there is a mask or not. The area of the mask is
2886 determined by the current mask colour.
2888 return _core_
.Image_SetMask(*args
, **kwargs
)
2890 def HasMask(*args
, **kwargs
):
2892 HasMask(self) -> bool
2894 Returns ``True`` if there is a mask active, ``False`` otherwise.
2896 return _core_
.Image_HasMask(*args
, **kwargs
)
2898 def Rotate(*args
, **kwargs
):
2900 Rotate(self, double angle, Point centre_of_rotation, bool interpolating=True,
2901 Point offset_after_rotation=None) -> Image
2903 Rotates the image about the given point, by ``angle`` radians. Passing
2904 ``True`` to ``interpolating`` results in better image quality, but is
2905 slower. If the image has a mask, then the mask colour is used for the
2906 uncovered pixels in the rotated image background. Otherwise, black
2907 will be used as the fill colour.
2909 Returns the rotated image, leaving this image intact.
2911 return _core_
.Image_Rotate(*args
, **kwargs
)
2913 def Rotate90(*args
, **kwargs
):
2915 Rotate90(self, bool clockwise=True) -> Image
2917 Returns a copy of the image rotated 90 degrees in the direction
2918 indicated by ``clockwise``.
2920 return _core_
.Image_Rotate90(*args
, **kwargs
)
2922 def Mirror(*args
, **kwargs
):
2924 Mirror(self, bool horizontally=True) -> Image
2926 Returns a mirrored copy of the image. The parameter ``horizontally``
2927 indicates the orientation.
2929 return _core_
.Image_Mirror(*args
, **kwargs
)
2931 def Replace(*args
, **kwargs
):
2933 Replace(self, byte r1, byte g1, byte b1, byte r2, byte g2, byte b2)
2935 Replaces the colour specified by ``(r1,g1,b1)`` by the colour
2938 return _core_
.Image_Replace(*args
, **kwargs
)
2940 def ConvertToMono(*args
, **kwargs
):
2942 ConvertToMono(self, byte r, byte g, byte b) -> Image
2944 Returns monochromatic version of the image. The returned image has
2945 white colour where the original has ``(r,g,b)`` colour and black
2946 colour everywhere else.
2948 return _core_
.Image_ConvertToMono(*args
, **kwargs
)
2950 def SetOption(*args
, **kwargs
):
2952 SetOption(self, String name, String value)
2954 Sets an image handler defined option. For example, when saving as a
2955 JPEG file, the option ``wx.IMAGE_OPTION_QUALITY`` is used, which is a
2956 number between 0 and 100 (0 is terrible, 100 is very good).
2958 return _core_
.Image_SetOption(*args
, **kwargs
)
2960 def SetOptionInt(*args
, **kwargs
):
2962 SetOptionInt(self, String name, int value)
2964 Sets an image option as an integer.
2966 return _core_
.Image_SetOptionInt(*args
, **kwargs
)
2968 def GetOption(*args
, **kwargs
):
2970 GetOption(self, String name) -> String
2972 Gets the value of an image handler option.
2974 return _core_
.Image_GetOption(*args
, **kwargs
)
2976 def GetOptionInt(*args
, **kwargs
):
2978 GetOptionInt(self, String name) -> int
2980 Gets the value of an image handler option as an integer. If the given
2981 option is not present, the function returns 0.
2983 return _core_
.Image_GetOptionInt(*args
, **kwargs
)
2985 def HasOption(*args
, **kwargs
):
2987 HasOption(self, String name) -> bool
2989 Returns true if the given option is present.
2991 return _core_
.Image_HasOption(*args
, **kwargs
)
2993 def CountColours(*args
, **kwargs
):
2994 """CountColours(self, unsigned long stopafter=(unsigned long) -1) -> unsigned long"""
2995 return _core_
.Image_CountColours(*args
, **kwargs
)
2997 def ComputeHistogram(*args
, **kwargs
):
2998 """ComputeHistogram(self, ImageHistogram h) -> unsigned long"""
2999 return _core_
.Image_ComputeHistogram(*args
, **kwargs
)
3001 def AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3002 """AddHandler(ImageHandler handler)"""
3003 return _core_
.Image_AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3005 AddHandler
= staticmethod(AddHandler
)
3006 def InsertHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3007 """InsertHandler(ImageHandler handler)"""
3008 return _core_
.Image_InsertHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3010 InsertHandler
= staticmethod(InsertHandler
)
3011 def RemoveHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3012 """RemoveHandler(String name) -> bool"""
3013 return _core_
.Image_RemoveHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3015 RemoveHandler
= staticmethod(RemoveHandler
)
3016 def GetImageExtWildcard(*args
, **kwargs
):
3018 GetImageExtWildcard() -> String
3020 Iterates all registered wxImageHandler objects, and returns a string
3021 containing file extension masks suitable for passing to file open/save
3024 return _core_
.Image_GetImageExtWildcard(*args
, **kwargs
)
3026 GetImageExtWildcard
= staticmethod(GetImageExtWildcard
)
3027 def ConvertToBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
3028 """ConvertToBitmap(self, int depth=-1) -> Bitmap"""
3029 return _core_
.Image_ConvertToBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
)
3031 def ConvertToMonoBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
3032 """ConvertToMonoBitmap(self, byte red, byte green, byte blue) -> Bitmap"""
3033 return _core_
.Image_ConvertToMonoBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
)
3035 def RotateHue(*args
, **kwargs
):
3037 RotateHue(self, double angle)
3039 Rotates the hue of each pixel of the image. Hue is a double in the
3040 range -1.0..1.0 where -1.0 is -360 degrees and 1.0 is 360 degrees
3042 return _core_
.Image_RotateHue(*args
, **kwargs
)
3044 def RGBtoHSV(*args
, **kwargs
):
3046 RGBtoHSV(Image_RGBValue rgb) -> Image_HSVValue
3048 Converts a color in RGB color space to HSV color space.
3050 return _core_
.Image_RGBtoHSV(*args
, **kwargs
)
3052 RGBtoHSV
= staticmethod(RGBtoHSV
)
3053 def HSVtoRGB(*args
, **kwargs
):
3055 HSVtoRGB(Image_HSVValue hsv) -> Image_RGBValue
3057 Converts a color in HSV color space to RGB color space.
3059 return _core_
.Image_HSVtoRGB(*args
, **kwargs
)
3061 HSVtoRGB
= staticmethod(HSVtoRGB
)
3062 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Ok()
3064 class ImagePtr(Image
):
3065 def __init__(self
, this
):
3067 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3068 self
.__class
__ = Image
3069 _core_
.Image_swigregister(ImagePtr
)
3071 def ImageFromMime(*args
, **kwargs
):
3073 ImageFromMime(String name, String mimetype, int index=-1) -> Image
3075 Loads an image from a file, using a MIME type string (such as
3076 'image/jpeg') to specify image type.
3078 val
= _core_
.new_ImageFromMime(*args
, **kwargs
)
3082 def ImageFromStream(*args
, **kwargs
):
3084 ImageFromStream(InputStream stream, long type=BITMAP_TYPE_ANY, int index=-1) -> Image
3086 Loads an image from an input stream, or any readable Python file-like
3089 val
= _core_
.new_ImageFromStream(*args
, **kwargs
)
3093 def ImageFromStreamMime(*args
, **kwargs
):
3095 ImageFromStreamMime(InputStream stream, String mimetype, int index=-1) -> Image
3097 Loads an image from an input stream, or any readable Python file-like
3098 object, specifying the image format with a MIME type string.
3100 val
= _core_
.new_ImageFromStreamMime(*args
, **kwargs
)
3104 def EmptyImage(*args
, **kwargs
):
3106 EmptyImage(int width=0, int height=0, bool clear=True) -> Image
3108 Construct an empty image of a given size, optionally setting all
3111 val
= _core_
.new_EmptyImage(*args
, **kwargs
)
3115 def ImageFromBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
3117 ImageFromBitmap(Bitmap bitmap) -> Image
3119 Construct an Image from a `wx.Bitmap`.
3121 val
= _core_
.new_ImageFromBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
)
3125 def ImageFromData(*args
, **kwargs
):
3127 ImageFromData(int width, int height, buffer data) -> Image
3129 Construct an Image from a buffer of RGB bytes. Accepts either a
3130 string or a buffer object holding the data and the length of the data
3131 must be width*height*3.
3133 val
= _core_
.new_ImageFromData(*args
, **kwargs
)
3137 def ImageFromDataWithAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
):
3139 ImageFromDataWithAlpha(int width, int height, buffer data, buffer alpha) -> Image
3141 Construct an Image from a buffer of RGB bytes with an Alpha channel.
3142 Accepts either a string or a buffer object holding the data and the
3143 length of the data must be width*height*3 bytes, and the length of the
3144 alpha data must be width*height bytes.
3146 val
= _core_
.new_ImageFromDataWithAlpha(*args
, **kwargs
)
3150 def Image_CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
):
3152 Image_CanRead(String filename) -> bool
3154 Returns True if the image handlers can read this file.
3156 return _core_
.Image_CanRead(*args
, **kwargs
)
3158 def Image_GetImageCount(*args
, **kwargs
):
3160 Image_GetImageCount(String filename, long type=BITMAP_TYPE_ANY) -> int
3162 If the image file contains more than one image and the image handler
3163 is capable of retrieving these individually, this function will return
3164 the number of available images.
3166 return _core_
.Image_GetImageCount(*args
, **kwargs
)
3168 def Image_CanReadStream(*args
, **kwargs
):
3170 Image_CanReadStream(InputStream stream) -> bool
3172 Returns True if the image handlers can read an image file from the
3173 data currently on the input stream, or a readable Python file-like
3176 return _core_
.Image_CanReadStream(*args
, **kwargs
)
3178 def Image_AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3179 """Image_AddHandler(ImageHandler handler)"""
3180 return _core_
.Image_AddHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3182 def Image_InsertHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3183 """Image_InsertHandler(ImageHandler handler)"""
3184 return _core_
.Image_InsertHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3186 def Image_RemoveHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3187 """Image_RemoveHandler(String name) -> bool"""
3188 return _core_
.Image_RemoveHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3190 def Image_GetImageExtWildcard(*args
, **kwargs
):
3192 Image_GetImageExtWildcard() -> String
3194 Iterates all registered wxImageHandler objects, and returns a string
3195 containing file extension masks suitable for passing to file open/save
3198 return _core_
.Image_GetImageExtWildcard(*args
, **kwargs
)
3200 def Image_RGBtoHSV(*args
, **kwargs
):
3202 Image_RGBtoHSV(Image_RGBValue rgb) -> Image_HSVValue
3204 Converts a color in RGB color space to HSV color space.
3206 return _core_
.Image_RGBtoHSV(*args
, **kwargs
)
3208 def Image_HSVtoRGB(*args
, **kwargs
):
3210 Image_HSVtoRGB(Image_HSVValue hsv) -> Image_RGBValue
3212 Converts a color in HSV color space to RGB color space.
3214 return _core_
.Image_HSVtoRGB(*args
, **kwargs
)
3216 def InitAllImageHandlers():
3218 The former functionality of InitAllImageHanders is now done internal to
3219 the _core_ extension module and so this function has become a simple NOP.
3223 IMAGE_RESOLUTION_INCHES
= _core_
.IMAGE_RESOLUTION_INCHES
3224 IMAGE_RESOLUTION_CM
= _core_
.IMAGE_RESOLUTION_CM
3225 PNG_TYPE_COLOUR
= _core_
.PNG_TYPE_COLOUR
3226 PNG_TYPE_GREY
= _core_
.PNG_TYPE_GREY
3227 PNG_TYPE_GREY_RED
= _core_
.PNG_TYPE_GREY_RED
3228 BMP_24BPP
= _core_
.BMP_24BPP
3229 BMP_8BPP
= _core_
.BMP_8BPP
3230 BMP_8BPP_GREY
= _core_
.BMP_8BPP_GREY
3231 BMP_8BPP_GRAY
= _core_
.BMP_8BPP_GRAY
3232 BMP_8BPP_RED
= _core_
.BMP_8BPP_RED
3233 BMP_8BPP_PALETTE
= _core_
.BMP_8BPP_PALETTE
3234 BMP_4BPP
= _core_
.BMP_4BPP
3235 BMP_1BPP
= _core_
.BMP_1BPP
3236 BMP_1BPP_BW
= _core_
.BMP_1BPP_BW
3237 class BMPHandler(ImageHandler
):
3238 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.bmp bitmap files."""
3240 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxBMPHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3241 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3243 __init__(self) -> BMPHandler
3245 A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.bmp bitmap files.
3247 newobj
= _core_
.new_BMPHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3248 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3252 class BMPHandlerPtr(BMPHandler
):
3253 def __init__(self
, this
):
3255 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3256 self
.__class
__ = BMPHandler
3257 _core_
.BMPHandler_swigregister(BMPHandlerPtr
)
3258 NullImage
= cvar
.NullImage
3259 IMAGE_OPTION_FILENAME
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_FILENAME
3260 IMAGE_OPTION_BMP_FORMAT
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_BMP_FORMAT
3261 IMAGE_OPTION_CUR_HOTSPOT_X
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_CUR_HOTSPOT_X
3262 IMAGE_OPTION_CUR_HOTSPOT_Y
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_CUR_HOTSPOT_Y
3263 IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTION
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTION
3264 IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTIONX
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTIONX
3265 IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTIONY
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTIONY
3266 IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTIONUNIT
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_RESOLUTIONUNIT
3267 IMAGE_OPTION_QUALITY
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_QUALITY
3268 IMAGE_OPTION_BITSPERSAMPLE
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_BITSPERSAMPLE
3269 IMAGE_OPTION_SAMPLESPERPIXEL
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_SAMPLESPERPIXEL
3270 IMAGE_OPTION_COMPRESSION
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_COMPRESSION
3271 IMAGE_OPTION_IMAGEDESCRIPTOR
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_IMAGEDESCRIPTOR
3272 IMAGE_OPTION_PNG_FORMAT
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_PNG_FORMAT
3273 IMAGE_OPTION_PNG_BITDEPTH
= cvar
.IMAGE_OPTION_PNG_BITDEPTH
3275 class ICOHandler(BMPHandler
):
3276 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.ico icon files."""
3278 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxICOHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3279 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3281 __init__(self) -> ICOHandler
3283 A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.ico icon files.
3285 newobj
= _core_
.new_ICOHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3286 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3290 class ICOHandlerPtr(ICOHandler
):
3291 def __init__(self
, this
):
3293 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3294 self
.__class
__ = ICOHandler
3295 _core_
.ICOHandler_swigregister(ICOHandlerPtr
)
3297 class CURHandler(ICOHandler
):
3298 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.cur cursor files."""
3300 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxCURHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3301 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3303 __init__(self) -> CURHandler
3305 A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.cur cursor files.
3307 newobj
= _core_
.new_CURHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3308 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3312 class CURHandlerPtr(CURHandler
):
3313 def __init__(self
, this
):
3315 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3316 self
.__class
__ = CURHandler
3317 _core_
.CURHandler_swigregister(CURHandlerPtr
)
3319 class ANIHandler(CURHandler
):
3320 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.ani animated cursor files."""
3322 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxANIHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3323 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3325 __init__(self) -> ANIHandler
3327 A `wx.ImageHandler` for \*.ani animated cursor files.
3329 newobj
= _core_
.new_ANIHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3330 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3334 class ANIHandlerPtr(ANIHandler
):
3335 def __init__(self
, this
):
3337 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3338 self
.__class
__ = ANIHandler
3339 _core_
.ANIHandler_swigregister(ANIHandlerPtr
)
3341 class PNGHandler(ImageHandler
):
3342 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for PNG image files."""
3344 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPNGHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3345 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3347 __init__(self) -> PNGHandler
3349 A `wx.ImageHandler` for PNG image files.
3351 newobj
= _core_
.new_PNGHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3352 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3356 class PNGHandlerPtr(PNGHandler
):
3357 def __init__(self
, this
):
3359 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3360 self
.__class
__ = PNGHandler
3361 _core_
.PNGHandler_swigregister(PNGHandlerPtr
)
3363 class GIFHandler(ImageHandler
):
3364 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for GIF image files."""
3366 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxGIFHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3367 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3369 __init__(self) -> GIFHandler
3371 A `wx.ImageHandler` for GIF image files.
3373 newobj
= _core_
.new_GIFHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3374 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3378 class GIFHandlerPtr(GIFHandler
):
3379 def __init__(self
, this
):
3381 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3382 self
.__class
__ = GIFHandler
3383 _core_
.GIFHandler_swigregister(GIFHandlerPtr
)
3385 class PCXHandler(ImageHandler
):
3386 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for PCX imager files."""
3388 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPCXHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3389 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3391 __init__(self) -> PCXHandler
3393 A `wx.ImageHandler` for PCX imager files.
3395 newobj
= _core_
.new_PCXHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3396 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3400 class PCXHandlerPtr(PCXHandler
):
3401 def __init__(self
, this
):
3403 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3404 self
.__class
__ = PCXHandler
3405 _core_
.PCXHandler_swigregister(PCXHandlerPtr
)
3407 class JPEGHandler(ImageHandler
):
3408 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for JPEG/JPG image files."""
3410 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxJPEGHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3411 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3413 __init__(self) -> JPEGHandler
3415 A `wx.ImageHandler` for JPEG/JPG image files.
3417 newobj
= _core_
.new_JPEGHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3418 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3422 class JPEGHandlerPtr(JPEGHandler
):
3423 def __init__(self
, this
):
3425 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3426 self
.__class
__ = JPEGHandler
3427 _core_
.JPEGHandler_swigregister(JPEGHandlerPtr
)
3429 class PNMHandler(ImageHandler
):
3430 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for PNM image files."""
3432 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPNMHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3433 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3435 __init__(self) -> PNMHandler
3437 A `wx.ImageHandler` for PNM image files.
3439 newobj
= _core_
.new_PNMHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3440 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3444 class PNMHandlerPtr(PNMHandler
):
3445 def __init__(self
, this
):
3447 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3448 self
.__class
__ = PNMHandler
3449 _core_
.PNMHandler_swigregister(PNMHandlerPtr
)
3451 class XPMHandler(ImageHandler
):
3452 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for XPM image."""
3454 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxXPMHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3455 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3457 __init__(self) -> XPMHandler
3459 A `wx.ImageHandler` for XPM image.
3461 newobj
= _core_
.new_XPMHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3462 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3466 class XPMHandlerPtr(XPMHandler
):
3467 def __init__(self
, this
):
3469 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3470 self
.__class
__ = XPMHandler
3471 _core_
.XPMHandler_swigregister(XPMHandlerPtr
)
3473 class TIFFHandler(ImageHandler
):
3474 """A `wx.ImageHandler` for TIFF image files."""
3476 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxTIFFHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3477 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3479 __init__(self) -> TIFFHandler
3481 A `wx.ImageHandler` for TIFF image files.
3483 newobj
= _core_
.new_TIFFHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3484 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3488 class TIFFHandlerPtr(TIFFHandler
):
3489 def __init__(self
, this
):
3491 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3492 self
.__class
__ = TIFFHandler
3493 _core_
.TIFFHandler_swigregister(TIFFHandlerPtr
)
3495 QUANTIZE_INCLUDE_WINDOWS_COLOURS
= _core_
.QUANTIZE_INCLUDE_WINDOWS_COLOURS
3496 QUANTIZE_FILL_DESTINATION_IMAGE
= _core_
.QUANTIZE_FILL_DESTINATION_IMAGE
3497 class Quantize(object):
3498 """Performs quantization, or colour reduction, on a wxImage."""
3499 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
3501 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxQuantize instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3502 def Quantize(*args
, **kwargs
):
3504 Quantize(Image src, Image dest, int desiredNoColours=236, int flags=wxQUANTIZE_INCLUDE_WINDOWS_COLOURS|wxQUANTIZE_FILL_DESTINATION_IMAGE) -> bool
3506 Reduce the colours in the source image and put the result into the
3507 destination image, setting the palette in the destination if
3508 needed. Both images may be the same, to overwrite the source image.
3510 return _core_
.Quantize_Quantize(*args
, **kwargs
)
3512 Quantize
= staticmethod(Quantize
)
3514 class QuantizePtr(Quantize
):
3515 def __init__(self
, this
):
3517 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3518 self
.__class
__ = Quantize
3519 _core_
.Quantize_swigregister(QuantizePtr
)
3521 def Quantize_Quantize(*args
, **kwargs
):
3523 Quantize_Quantize(Image src, Image dest, int desiredNoColours=236, int flags=wxQUANTIZE_INCLUDE_WINDOWS_COLOURS|wxQUANTIZE_FILL_DESTINATION_IMAGE) -> bool
3525 Reduce the colours in the source image and put the result into the
3526 destination image, setting the palette in the destination if
3527 needed. Both images may be the same, to overwrite the source image.
3529 return _core_
.Quantize_Quantize(*args
, **kwargs
)
3531 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
3533 class EvtHandler(Object
):
3534 """Proxy of C++ EvtHandler class"""
3536 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxEvtHandler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
3537 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
3538 """__init__(self) -> EvtHandler"""
3539 newobj
= _core_
.new_EvtHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3540 self
.this
= newobj
.this
3543 def GetNextHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3544 """GetNextHandler(self) -> EvtHandler"""
3545 return _core_
.EvtHandler_GetNextHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3547 def GetPreviousHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3548 """GetPreviousHandler(self) -> EvtHandler"""
3549 return _core_
.EvtHandler_GetPreviousHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3551 def SetNextHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3552 """SetNextHandler(self, EvtHandler handler)"""
3553 return _core_
.EvtHandler_SetNextHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3555 def SetPreviousHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
3556 """SetPreviousHandler(self, EvtHandler handler)"""
3557 return _core_
.EvtHandler_SetPreviousHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
3559 def GetEvtHandlerEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
3560 """GetEvtHandlerEnabled(self) -> bool"""
3561 return _core_
.EvtHandler_GetEvtHandlerEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
3563 def SetEvtHandlerEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
3564 """SetEvtHandlerEnabled(self, bool enabled)"""
3565 return _core_
.EvtHandler_SetEvtHandlerEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
3567 def ProcessEvent(*args
, **kwargs
):
3568 """ProcessEvent(self, Event event) -> bool"""
3569 return _core_
.EvtHandler_ProcessEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
3571 def AddPendingEvent(*args
, **kwargs
):
3572 """AddPendingEvent(self, Event event)"""
3573 return _core_
.EvtHandler_AddPendingEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
3575 def ProcessPendingEvents(*args
, **kwargs
):
3576 """ProcessPendingEvents(self)"""
3577 return _core_
.EvtHandler_ProcessPendingEvents(*args
, **kwargs
)
3579 def Connect(*args
, **kwargs
):
3580 """Connect(self, int id, int lastId, int eventType, PyObject func)"""
3581 return _core_
.EvtHandler_Connect(*args
, **kwargs
)
3583 def Disconnect(*args
, **kwargs
):
3584 """Disconnect(self, int id, int lastId=-1, wxEventType eventType=wxEVT_NULL) -> bool"""
3585 return _core_
.EvtHandler_Disconnect(*args
, **kwargs
)
3587 def _setOORInfo(*args
, **kwargs
):
3588 """_setOORInfo(self, PyObject _self, bool incref=True)"""
3589 return _core_
.EvtHandler__setOORInfo(*args
, **kwargs
)
3591 def Bind(self
, event
, handler
, source
=None, id=wx
.ID_ANY
, id2
=wx
.ID_ANY
):
3593 Bind an event to an event handler.
3595 :param event: One of the EVT_* objects that specifies the
3596 type of event to bind,
3598 :param handler: A callable object to be invoked when the
3599 event is delivered to self. Pass None to
3600 disconnect an event handler.
3602 :param source: Sometimes the event originates from a
3603 different window than self, but you still
3604 want to catch it in self. (For example, a
3605 button event delivered to a frame.) By
3606 passing the source of the event, the event
3607 handling system is able to differentiate
3608 between the same event type from different
3611 :param id: Used to spcify the event source by ID instead
3614 :param id2: Used when it is desirable to bind a handler
3615 to a range of IDs, such as with EVT_MENU_RANGE.
3617 if source
is not None:
3619 event
.Bind(self
, id, id2
, handler
)
3621 def Unbind(self
, event
, source
=None, id=wx
.ID_ANY
, id2
=wx
.ID_ANY
):
3623 Disconencts the event handler binding for event from self.
3624 Returns True if successful.
3626 if source
is not None:
3628 return event
.Unbind(self
, id, id2
)
3631 class EvtHandlerPtr(EvtHandler
):
3632 def __init__(self
, this
):
3634 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
3635 self
.__class
__ = EvtHandler
3636 _core_
.EvtHandler_swigregister(EvtHandlerPtr
)
3638 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
3640 class PyEventBinder(object):
3642 Instances of this class are used to bind specific events to event
3645 def __init__(self
, evtType
, expectedIDs
=0):
3646 if expectedIDs
not in [0, 1, 2]:
3647 raise ValueError, "Invalid number of expectedIDs"
3648 self
.expectedIDs
= expectedIDs
3650 if type(evtType
) == list or type(evtType
) == tuple:
3651 self
.evtType
= evtType
3653 self
.evtType
= [evtType
]
3656 def Bind(self
, target
, id1
, id2
, function
):
3657 """Bind this set of event types to target."""
3658 for et
in self
.evtType
:
3659 target
.Connect(id1
, id2
, et
, function
)
3662 def Unbind(self
, target
, id1
, id2
):
3663 """Remove an event binding."""
3665 for et
in self
.evtType
:
3666 success
+= target
.Disconnect(id1
, id2
, et
)
3670 def __call__(self
, *args
):
3672 For backwards compatibility with the old EVT_* functions.
3673 Should be called with either (window, func), (window, ID,
3674 func) or (window, ID1, ID2, func) parameters depending on the
3677 assert len(args
) == 2 + self
.expectedIDs
3681 if self
.expectedIDs
== 0:
3683 elif self
.expectedIDs
== 1:
3686 elif self
.expectedIDs
== 2:
3691 raise ValueError, "Unexpected number of IDs"
3693 self
.Bind(target
, id1
, id2
, func
)
3696 # These two are square pegs that don't fit the PyEventBinder hole...
3697 def EVT_COMMAND(win
, id, cmd
, func
):
3698 win
.Connect(id, -1, cmd
, func
)
3699 def EVT_COMMAND_RANGE(win
, id1
, id2
, cmd
, func
):
3700 win
.Connect(id1
, id2
, cmd
, func
)
3703 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
3705 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
3707 EVENT_PROPAGATE_NONE
= _core_
.EVENT_PROPAGATE_NONE
3708 EVENT_PROPAGATE_MAX
= _core_
.EVENT_PROPAGATE_MAX
3710 def NewEventType(*args
, **kwargs
):
3711 """NewEventType() -> wxEventType"""
3712 return _core_
.NewEventType(*args
, **kwargs
)
3713 wxEVT_NULL
= _core_
.wxEVT_NULL
3714 wxEVT_FIRST
= _core_
.wxEVT_FIRST
3715 wxEVT_USER_FIRST
= _core_
.wxEVT_USER_FIRST
3716 wxEVT_COMMAND_BUTTON_CLICKED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_BUTTON_CLICKED
3717 wxEVT_COMMAND_CHECKBOX_CLICKED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_CHECKBOX_CLICKED
3718 wxEVT_COMMAND_CHOICE_SELECTED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_CHOICE_SELECTED
3719 wxEVT_COMMAND_LISTBOX_SELECTED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_LISTBOX_SELECTED
3720 wxEVT_COMMAND_LISTBOX_DOUBLECLICKED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_LISTBOX_DOUBLECLICKED
3721 wxEVT_COMMAND_CHECKLISTBOX_TOGGLED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_CHECKLISTBOX_TOGGLED
3722 wxEVT_COMMAND_MENU_SELECTED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_MENU_SELECTED
3723 wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_CLICKED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_CLICKED
3724 wxEVT_COMMAND_SLIDER_UPDATED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_SLIDER_UPDATED
3725 wxEVT_COMMAND_RADIOBOX_SELECTED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_RADIOBOX_SELECTED
3726 wxEVT_COMMAND_RADIOBUTTON_SELECTED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_RADIOBUTTON_SELECTED
3727 wxEVT_COMMAND_SCROLLBAR_UPDATED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_SCROLLBAR_UPDATED
3728 wxEVT_COMMAND_VLBOX_SELECTED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_VLBOX_SELECTED
3729 wxEVT_COMMAND_COMBOBOX_SELECTED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_COMBOBOX_SELECTED
3730 wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_RCLICKED
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_RCLICKED
3731 wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_ENTER
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_ENTER
3732 wxEVT_LEFT_DOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_LEFT_DOWN
3733 wxEVT_LEFT_UP
= _core_
.wxEVT_LEFT_UP
3734 wxEVT_MIDDLE_DOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_MIDDLE_DOWN
3735 wxEVT_MIDDLE_UP
= _core_
.wxEVT_MIDDLE_UP
3736 wxEVT_RIGHT_DOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_RIGHT_DOWN
3737 wxEVT_RIGHT_UP
= _core_
.wxEVT_RIGHT_UP
3738 wxEVT_MOTION
= _core_
.wxEVT_MOTION
3739 wxEVT_ENTER_WINDOW
= _core_
.wxEVT_ENTER_WINDOW
3740 wxEVT_LEAVE_WINDOW
= _core_
.wxEVT_LEAVE_WINDOW
3741 wxEVT_LEFT_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_LEFT_DCLICK
3742 wxEVT_MIDDLE_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_MIDDLE_DCLICK
3743 wxEVT_RIGHT_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_RIGHT_DCLICK
3744 wxEVT_SET_FOCUS
= _core_
.wxEVT_SET_FOCUS
3745 wxEVT_KILL_FOCUS
= _core_
.wxEVT_KILL_FOCUS
3746 wxEVT_CHILD_FOCUS
= _core_
.wxEVT_CHILD_FOCUS
3747 wxEVT_MOUSEWHEEL
= _core_
.wxEVT_MOUSEWHEEL
3748 wxEVT_NC_LEFT_DOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_LEFT_DOWN
3749 wxEVT_NC_LEFT_UP
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_LEFT_UP
3750 wxEVT_NC_MIDDLE_DOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_MIDDLE_DOWN
3751 wxEVT_NC_MIDDLE_UP
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_MIDDLE_UP
3752 wxEVT_NC_RIGHT_DOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_RIGHT_DOWN
3753 wxEVT_NC_RIGHT_UP
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_RIGHT_UP
3754 wxEVT_NC_MOTION
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_MOTION
3755 wxEVT_NC_ENTER_WINDOW
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_ENTER_WINDOW
3756 wxEVT_NC_LEAVE_WINDOW
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_LEAVE_WINDOW
3757 wxEVT_NC_LEFT_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_LEFT_DCLICK
3758 wxEVT_NC_MIDDLE_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_MIDDLE_DCLICK
3759 wxEVT_NC_RIGHT_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_RIGHT_DCLICK
3760 wxEVT_CHAR
= _core_
.wxEVT_CHAR
3761 wxEVT_CHAR_HOOK
= _core_
.wxEVT_CHAR_HOOK
3762 wxEVT_NAVIGATION_KEY
= _core_
.wxEVT_NAVIGATION_KEY
3763 wxEVT_KEY_DOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_KEY_DOWN
3764 wxEVT_KEY_UP
= _core_
.wxEVT_KEY_UP
3765 wxEVT_HOTKEY
= _core_
.wxEVT_HOTKEY
3766 wxEVT_SET_CURSOR
= _core_
.wxEVT_SET_CURSOR
3767 wxEVT_SCROLL_TOP
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_TOP
3768 wxEVT_SCROLL_BOTTOM
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_BOTTOM
3769 wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEUP
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEUP
3770 wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
3771 wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEUP
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEUP
3772 wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
3773 wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
3774 wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
3775 wxEVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
3776 wxEVT_SCROLL_ENDSCROLL
= wxEVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
3777 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_TOP
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_TOP
3778 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_BOTTOM
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_BOTTOM
3779 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEUP
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEUP
3780 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEDOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEDOWN
3781 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEUP
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEUP
3782 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEDOWN
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEDOWN
3783 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBTRACK
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBTRACK
3784 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBRELEASE
= _core_
.wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBRELEASE
3785 wxEVT_SIZE
= _core_
.wxEVT_SIZE
3786 wxEVT_MOVE
= _core_
.wxEVT_MOVE
3787 wxEVT_CLOSE_WINDOW
= _core_
.wxEVT_CLOSE_WINDOW
3788 wxEVT_END_SESSION
= _core_
.wxEVT_END_SESSION
3789 wxEVT_QUERY_END_SESSION
= _core_
.wxEVT_QUERY_END_SESSION
3790 wxEVT_ACTIVATE_APP
= _core_
.wxEVT_ACTIVATE_APP
3791 wxEVT_POWER
= _core_
.wxEVT_POWER
3792 wxEVT_ACTIVATE
= _core_
.wxEVT_ACTIVATE
3793 wxEVT_CREATE
= _core_
.wxEVT_CREATE
3794 wxEVT_DESTROY
= _core_
.wxEVT_DESTROY
3795 wxEVT_SHOW
= _core_
.wxEVT_SHOW
3796 wxEVT_ICONIZE
= _core_
.wxEVT_ICONIZE
3797 wxEVT_MAXIMIZE
= _core_
.wxEVT_MAXIMIZE
3798 wxEVT_MOUSE_CAPTURE_CHANGED
= _core_
.wxEVT_MOUSE_CAPTURE_CHANGED
3799 wxEVT_PAINT
= _core_
.wxEVT_PAINT
3800 wxEVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND
= _core_
.wxEVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND
3801 wxEVT_NC_PAINT
= _core_
.wxEVT_NC_PAINT
3802 wxEVT_PAINT_ICON
= _core_
.wxEVT_PAINT_ICON
3803 wxEVT_MENU_OPEN
= _core_
.wxEVT_MENU_OPEN
3804 wxEVT_MENU_CLOSE
= _core_
.wxEVT_MENU_CLOSE
3805 wxEVT_MENU_HIGHLIGHT
= _core_
.wxEVT_MENU_HIGHLIGHT
3806 wxEVT_CONTEXT_MENU
= _core_
.wxEVT_CONTEXT_MENU
3807 wxEVT_SYS_COLOUR_CHANGED
= _core_
.wxEVT_SYS_COLOUR_CHANGED
3808 wxEVT_DISPLAY_CHANGED
= _core_
.wxEVT_DISPLAY_CHANGED
3809 wxEVT_SETTING_CHANGED
= _core_
.wxEVT_SETTING_CHANGED
3810 wxEVT_QUERY_NEW_PALETTE
= _core_
.wxEVT_QUERY_NEW_PALETTE
3811 wxEVT_PALETTE_CHANGED
= _core_
.wxEVT_PALETTE_CHANGED
3812 wxEVT_DROP_FILES
= _core_
.wxEVT_DROP_FILES
3813 wxEVT_DRAW_ITEM
= _core_
.wxEVT_DRAW_ITEM
3814 wxEVT_MEASURE_ITEM
= _core_
.wxEVT_MEASURE_ITEM
3815 wxEVT_COMPARE_ITEM
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMPARE_ITEM
3816 wxEVT_INIT_DIALOG
= _core_
.wxEVT_INIT_DIALOG
3817 wxEVT_IDLE
= _core_
.wxEVT_IDLE
3818 wxEVT_UPDATE_UI
= _core_
.wxEVT_UPDATE_UI
3819 wxEVT_SIZING
= _core_
.wxEVT_SIZING
3820 wxEVT_MOVING
= _core_
.wxEVT_MOVING
3821 wxEVT_HIBERNATE
= _core_
.wxEVT_HIBERNATE
3822 wxEVT_COMMAND_LEFT_CLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_LEFT_CLICK
3823 wxEVT_COMMAND_LEFT_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_LEFT_DCLICK
3824 wxEVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_CLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_CLICK
3825 wxEVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_DCLICK
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_DCLICK
3826 wxEVT_COMMAND_SET_FOCUS
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_SET_FOCUS
3827 wxEVT_COMMAND_KILL_FOCUS
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_KILL_FOCUS
3828 wxEVT_COMMAND_ENTER
= _core_
.wxEVT_COMMAND_ENTER
3830 # Create some event binders
3831 EVT_SIZE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SIZE
)
3832 EVT_SIZING
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SIZING
)
3833 EVT_MOVE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MOVE
)
3834 EVT_MOVING
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MOVING
)
3835 EVT_CLOSE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_CLOSE_WINDOW
)
3836 EVT_END_SESSION
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_END_SESSION
)
3837 EVT_QUERY_END_SESSION
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_QUERY_END_SESSION
)
3838 EVT_PAINT
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_PAINT
)
3839 EVT_NC_PAINT
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_NC_PAINT
)
3840 EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND
)
3841 EVT_CHAR
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_CHAR
)
3842 EVT_KEY_DOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_KEY_DOWN
)
3843 EVT_KEY_UP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_KEY_UP
)
3844 EVT_HOTKEY
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_HOTKEY
, 1)
3845 EVT_CHAR_HOOK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_CHAR_HOOK
)
3846 EVT_MENU_OPEN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MENU_OPEN
)
3847 EVT_MENU_CLOSE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MENU_CLOSE
)
3848 EVT_MENU_HIGHLIGHT
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MENU_HIGHLIGHT
, 1)
3849 EVT_MENU_HIGHLIGHT_ALL
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MENU_HIGHLIGHT
)
3850 EVT_SET_FOCUS
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SET_FOCUS
)
3851 EVT_KILL_FOCUS
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_KILL_FOCUS
)
3852 EVT_CHILD_FOCUS
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_CHILD_FOCUS
)
3853 EVT_ACTIVATE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_ACTIVATE
)
3854 EVT_ACTIVATE_APP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_ACTIVATE_APP
)
3855 EVT_HIBERNATE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_HIBERNATE
)
3856 EVT_END_SESSION
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_END_SESSION
)
3857 EVT_QUERY_END_SESSION
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_QUERY_END_SESSION
)
3858 EVT_DROP_FILES
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_DROP_FILES
)
3859 EVT_INIT_DIALOG
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_INIT_DIALOG
)
3860 EVT_SYS_COLOUR_CHANGED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SYS_COLOUR_CHANGED
)
3861 EVT_DISPLAY_CHANGED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_DISPLAY_CHANGED
)
3862 EVT_SHOW
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SHOW
)
3863 EVT_MAXIMIZE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MAXIMIZE
)
3864 EVT_ICONIZE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_ICONIZE
)
3865 EVT_NAVIGATION_KEY
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_NAVIGATION_KEY
)
3866 EVT_PALETTE_CHANGED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_PALETTE_CHANGED
)
3867 EVT_QUERY_NEW_PALETTE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_QUERY_NEW_PALETTE
)
3868 EVT_WINDOW_CREATE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_CREATE
)
3869 EVT_WINDOW_DESTROY
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_DESTROY
)
3870 EVT_SET_CURSOR
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SET_CURSOR
)
3871 EVT_MOUSE_CAPTURE_CHANGED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MOUSE_CAPTURE_CHANGED
)
3873 EVT_LEFT_DOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_LEFT_DOWN
)
3874 EVT_LEFT_UP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_LEFT_UP
)
3875 EVT_MIDDLE_DOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MIDDLE_DOWN
)
3876 EVT_MIDDLE_UP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MIDDLE_UP
)
3877 EVT_RIGHT_DOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_RIGHT_DOWN
)
3878 EVT_RIGHT_UP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_RIGHT_UP
)
3879 EVT_MOTION
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MOTION
)
3880 EVT_LEFT_DCLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_LEFT_DCLICK
)
3881 EVT_MIDDLE_DCLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MIDDLE_DCLICK
)
3882 EVT_RIGHT_DCLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_RIGHT_DCLICK
)
3883 EVT_LEAVE_WINDOW
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_LEAVE_WINDOW
)
3884 EVT_ENTER_WINDOW
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_ENTER_WINDOW
)
3885 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_MOUSEWHEEL
)
3887 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS
= wx
.PyEventBinder([ wxEVT_LEFT_DOWN
,
3895 wxEVT_MIDDLE_DCLICK
,
3903 # Scrolling from wxWindow (sent to wxScrolledWindow)
3904 EVT_SCROLLWIN
= wx
.PyEventBinder([ wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_TOP
,
3905 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_BOTTOM
,
3906 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEUP
,
3907 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEDOWN
,
3908 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEUP
,
3909 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEDOWN
,
3910 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBTRACK
,
3911 wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBRELEASE
,
3914 EVT_SCROLLWIN_TOP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_TOP
)
3915 EVT_SCROLLWIN_BOTTOM
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_BOTTOM
)
3916 EVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEUP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEUP
)
3917 EVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEDOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEDOWN
)
3918 EVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEUP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEUP
)
3919 EVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEDOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEDOWN
)
3920 EVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBTRACK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBTRACK
)
3921 EVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBRELEASE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBRELEASE
)
3923 # Scrolling from wx.Slider and wx.ScrollBar
3924 EVT_SCROLL
= wx
.PyEventBinder([ wxEVT_SCROLL_TOP
,
3925 wxEVT_SCROLL_BOTTOM
,
3926 wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEUP
,
3927 wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
,
3928 wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEUP
,
3929 wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
,
3930 wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
,
3931 wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
,
3932 wxEVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
,
3935 EVT_SCROLL_TOP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_TOP
)
3936 EVT_SCROLL_BOTTOM
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_BOTTOM
)
3937 EVT_SCROLL_LINEUP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEUP
)
3938 EVT_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
)
3939 EVT_SCROLL_PAGEUP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEUP
)
3940 EVT_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
)
3941 EVT_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
)
3942 EVT_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
)
3943 EVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
)
3944 EVT_SCROLL_ENDSCROLL
= EVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
3946 # Scrolling from wx.Slider and wx.ScrollBar, with an id
3947 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL
= wx
.PyEventBinder([ wxEVT_SCROLL_TOP
,
3948 wxEVT_SCROLL_BOTTOM
,
3949 wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEUP
,
3950 wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
,
3951 wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEUP
,
3952 wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
,
3953 wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
,
3954 wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
,
3955 wxEVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
,
3958 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_TOP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_TOP
, 1)
3959 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_BOTTOM
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_BOTTOM
, 1)
3960 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_LINEUP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEUP
, 1)
3961 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_LINEDOWN
, 1)
3962 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_PAGEUP
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEUP
, 1)
3963 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_PAGEDOWN
, 1)
3964 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBTRACK
, 1)
3965 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_THUMBRELEASE
, 1)
3966 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_CHANGED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_SCROLL_CHANGED
, 1)
3967 EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_ENDSCROLL
= EVT_COMMAND_SCROLL_CHANGED
3969 EVT_BUTTON
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_BUTTON_CLICKED
, 1)
3970 EVT_CHECKBOX
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_CHECKBOX_CLICKED
, 1)
3971 EVT_CHOICE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_CHOICE_SELECTED
, 1)
3972 EVT_LISTBOX
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_LISTBOX_SELECTED
, 1)
3973 EVT_LISTBOX_DCLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_LISTBOX_DOUBLECLICKED
, 1)
3974 EVT_MENU
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_MENU_SELECTED
, 1)
3975 EVT_MENU_RANGE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_MENU_SELECTED
, 2)
3976 EVT_SLIDER
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_SLIDER_UPDATED
, 1)
3977 EVT_RADIOBOX
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_RADIOBOX_SELECTED
, 1)
3978 EVT_RADIOBUTTON
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_RADIOBUTTON_SELECTED
, 1)
3980 EVT_SCROLLBAR
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_SCROLLBAR_UPDATED
, 1)
3981 EVT_VLBOX
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_VLBOX_SELECTED
, 1)
3982 EVT_COMBOBOX
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_COMBOBOX_SELECTED
, 1)
3983 EVT_TOOL
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_CLICKED
, 1)
3984 EVT_TOOL_RANGE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_CLICKED
, 2)
3985 EVT_TOOL_RCLICKED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_RCLICKED
, 1)
3986 EVT_TOOL_RCLICKED_RANGE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_RCLICKED
, 2)
3987 EVT_TOOL_ENTER
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_TOOL_ENTER
, 1)
3988 EVT_CHECKLISTBOX
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_CHECKLISTBOX_TOGGLED
, 1)
3991 EVT_COMMAND_LEFT_CLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_LEFT_CLICK
, 1)
3992 EVT_COMMAND_LEFT_DCLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_LEFT_DCLICK
, 1)
3993 EVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_CLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_CLICK
, 1)
3994 EVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_DCLICK
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_RIGHT_DCLICK
, 1)
3995 EVT_COMMAND_SET_FOCUS
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_SET_FOCUS
, 1)
3996 EVT_COMMAND_KILL_FOCUS
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_KILL_FOCUS
, 1)
3997 EVT_COMMAND_ENTER
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_COMMAND_ENTER
, 1)
3999 EVT_IDLE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_IDLE
)
4001 EVT_UPDATE_UI
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_UPDATE_UI
, 1)
4002 EVT_UPDATE_UI_RANGE
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_UPDATE_UI
, 2)
4004 EVT_CONTEXT_MENU
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_CONTEXT_MENU
)
4008 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4010 class Event(Object
):
4012 An event is a structure holding information about an event passed to a
4013 callback or member function. wx.Event is an abstract base class for
4016 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
4018 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4019 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_Event
):
4022 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
4025 def SetEventType(*args
, **kwargs
):
4027 SetEventType(self, wxEventType typ)
4029 Sets the specific type of the event.
4031 return _core_
.Event_SetEventType(*args
, **kwargs
)
4033 def GetEventType(*args
, **kwargs
):
4035 GetEventType(self) -> wxEventType
4037 Returns the identifier of the given event type, such as
4038 ``wxEVT_COMMAND_BUTTON_CLICKED``.
4040 return _core_
.Event_GetEventType(*args
, **kwargs
)
4042 def GetEventObject(*args
, **kwargs
):
4044 GetEventObject(self) -> Object
4046 Returns the object (usually a window) associated with the event, if
4049 return _core_
.Event_GetEventObject(*args
, **kwargs
)
4051 def SetEventObject(*args
, **kwargs
):
4053 SetEventObject(self, Object obj)
4055 Sets the originating object, or in other words, obj is normally the
4056 object that is sending the event.
4058 return _core_
.Event_SetEventObject(*args
, **kwargs
)
4060 def GetTimestamp(*args
, **kwargs
):
4061 """GetTimestamp(self) -> long"""
4062 return _core_
.Event_GetTimestamp(*args
, **kwargs
)
4064 def SetTimestamp(*args
, **kwargs
):
4065 """SetTimestamp(self, long ts=0)"""
4066 return _core_
.Event_SetTimestamp(*args
, **kwargs
)
4068 def GetId(*args
, **kwargs
):
4072 Returns the identifier associated with this event, such as a button
4075 return _core_
.Event_GetId(*args
, **kwargs
)
4077 def SetId(*args
, **kwargs
):
4081 Set's the ID for the event. This is usually the ID of the window that
4082 is sending the event, but it can also be a command id from a menu
4085 return _core_
.Event_SetId(*args
, **kwargs
)
4087 def IsCommandEvent(*args
, **kwargs
):
4089 IsCommandEvent(self) -> bool
4091 Returns true if the event is or is derived from `wx.CommandEvent` else
4092 it returns false. Note: Exists only for optimization purposes.
4094 return _core_
.Event_IsCommandEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
4096 def Skip(*args
, **kwargs
):
4098 Skip(self, bool skip=True)
4100 Called by an event handler, it controls whether additional event
4101 handlers bound to this event will be called after the current event
4102 handler returns. Skip(false) (the default setting) will prevent
4103 additional event handlers from being called and control will be
4104 returned to the sender of the event immediately after the current
4105 handler has finished. Skip(True) will cause the event processing
4106 system to continue searching for a handler function for this event.
4109 return _core_
.Event_Skip(*args
, **kwargs
)
4111 def GetSkipped(*args
, **kwargs
):
4113 GetSkipped(self) -> bool
4115 Returns true if the event handler should be skipped, false otherwise.
4118 return _core_
.Event_GetSkipped(*args
, **kwargs
)
4120 def ShouldPropagate(*args
, **kwargs
):
4122 ShouldPropagate(self) -> bool
4124 Test if this event should be propagated to the parent window or not,
4125 i.e. if the propagation level is currently greater than 0.
4127 return _core_
.Event_ShouldPropagate(*args
, **kwargs
)
4129 def StopPropagation(*args
, **kwargs
):
4131 StopPropagation(self) -> int
4133 Stop the event from propagating to its parent window. Returns the old
4134 propagation level value which may be later passed to
4135 `ResumePropagation` to allow propagating the event again.
4137 return _core_
.Event_StopPropagation(*args
, **kwargs
)
4139 def ResumePropagation(*args
, **kwargs
):
4141 ResumePropagation(self, int propagationLevel)
4143 Resume the event propagation by restoring the propagation level. (For
4144 example, you can use the value returned by an earlier call to
4148 return _core_
.Event_ResumePropagation(*args
, **kwargs
)
4150 def Clone(*args
, **kwargs
):
4151 """Clone(self) -> Event"""
4152 return _core_
.Event_Clone(*args
, **kwargs
)
4155 class EventPtr(Event
):
4156 def __init__(self
, this
):
4158 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4159 self
.__class
__ = Event
4160 _core_
.Event_swigregister(EventPtr
)
4162 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4164 class PropagationDisabler(object):
4166 Helper class to temporarily change an event not to propagate. Simply
4167 create an instance of this class and then whe it is destroyed the
4168 propogation of the event will be restored.
4171 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPropagationDisabler instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4172 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4174 __init__(self, Event event) -> PropagationDisabler
4176 Helper class to temporarily change an event not to propagate. Simply
4177 create an instance of this class and then whe it is destroyed the
4178 propogation of the event will be restored.
4180 newobj
= _core_
.new_PropagationDisabler(*args
, **kwargs
)
4181 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4184 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_PropagationDisabler
):
4187 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
4191 class PropagationDisablerPtr(PropagationDisabler
):
4192 def __init__(self
, this
):
4194 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4195 self
.__class
__ = PropagationDisabler
4196 _core_
.PropagationDisabler_swigregister(PropagationDisablerPtr
)
4198 class PropagateOnce(object):
4200 A helper class that will temporarily lower propagation level of an
4201 event. Simply create an instance of this class and then whe it is
4202 destroyed the propogation of the event will be restored.
4205 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPropagateOnce instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4206 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4208 __init__(self, Event event) -> PropagateOnce
4210 A helper class that will temporarily lower propagation level of an
4211 event. Simply create an instance of this class and then whe it is
4212 destroyed the propogation of the event will be restored.
4214 newobj
= _core_
.new_PropagateOnce(*args
, **kwargs
)
4215 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4218 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_PropagateOnce
):
4221 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
4225 class PropagateOncePtr(PropagateOnce
):
4226 def __init__(self
, this
):
4228 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4229 self
.__class
__ = PropagateOnce
4230 _core_
.PropagateOnce_swigregister(PropagateOncePtr
)
4232 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4234 class CommandEvent(Event
):
4236 This event class contains information about command events, which
4237 originate from a variety of simple controls, as well as menus and
4241 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxCommandEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4242 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4244 __init__(self, wxEventType commandType=wxEVT_NULL, int winid=0) -> CommandEvent
4246 This event class contains information about command events, which
4247 originate from a variety of simple controls, as well as menus and
4250 newobj
= _core_
.new_CommandEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
4251 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4254 def GetSelection(*args
, **kwargs
):
4256 GetSelection(self) -> int
4258 Returns item index for a listbox or choice selection event (not valid
4261 return _core_
.CommandEvent_GetSelection(*args
, **kwargs
)
4263 def SetString(*args
, **kwargs
):
4264 """SetString(self, String s)"""
4265 return _core_
.CommandEvent_SetString(*args
, **kwargs
)
4267 def GetString(*args
, **kwargs
):
4269 GetString(self) -> String
4271 Returns item string for a listbox or choice selection event (not valid
4274 return _core_
.CommandEvent_GetString(*args
, **kwargs
)
4276 def IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
):
4278 IsChecked(self) -> bool
4280 This method can be used with checkbox and menu events: for the
4281 checkboxes, the method returns true for a selection event and false
4282 for a deselection one. For the menu events, this method indicates if
4283 the menu item just has become checked or unchecked (and thus only
4284 makes sense for checkable menu items).
4286 return _core_
.CommandEvent_IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
)
4289 def IsSelection(*args
, **kwargs
):
4291 IsSelection(self) -> bool
4293 For a listbox or similar event, returns true if it is a selection,
4294 false if it is a deselection.
4296 return _core_
.CommandEvent_IsSelection(*args
, **kwargs
)
4298 def SetExtraLong(*args
, **kwargs
):
4299 """SetExtraLong(self, long extraLong)"""
4300 return _core_
.CommandEvent_SetExtraLong(*args
, **kwargs
)
4302 def GetExtraLong(*args
, **kwargs
):
4304 GetExtraLong(self) -> long
4306 Returns extra information dependant on the event objects type. If the
4307 event comes from a listbox selection, it is a boolean determining
4308 whether the event was a selection (true) or a deselection (false). A
4309 listbox deselection only occurs for multiple-selection boxes, and in
4310 this case the index and string values are indeterminate and the
4311 listbox must be examined by the application.
4313 return _core_
.CommandEvent_GetExtraLong(*args
, **kwargs
)
4315 def SetInt(*args
, **kwargs
):
4316 """SetInt(self, int i)"""
4317 return _core_
.CommandEvent_SetInt(*args
, **kwargs
)
4319 def GetInt(*args
, **kwargs
):
4321 GetInt(self) -> long
4323 Returns the integer identifier corresponding to a listbox, choice or
4324 radiobox selection (only if the event was a selection, not a
4325 deselection), or a boolean value representing the value of a checkbox.
4327 return _core_
.CommandEvent_GetInt(*args
, **kwargs
)
4329 def Clone(*args
, **kwargs
):
4330 """Clone(self) -> Event"""
4331 return _core_
.CommandEvent_Clone(*args
, **kwargs
)
4334 class CommandEventPtr(CommandEvent
):
4335 def __init__(self
, this
):
4337 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4338 self
.__class
__ = CommandEvent
4339 _core_
.CommandEvent_swigregister(CommandEventPtr
)
4341 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4343 class NotifyEvent(CommandEvent
):
4345 An instance of this class (or one of its derived classes) is sent from
4346 a control when the control's state is being changed and the control
4347 allows that change to be prevented from happening. The event handler
4348 can call `Veto` or `Allow` to tell the control what to do.
4351 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxNotifyEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4352 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4354 __init__(self, wxEventType commandType=wxEVT_NULL, int winid=0) -> NotifyEvent
4356 An instance of this class (or one of its derived classes) is sent from
4357 a control when the control's state is being changed and the control
4358 allows that change to be prevented from happening. The event handler
4359 can call `Veto` or `Allow` to tell the control what to do.
4361 newobj
= _core_
.new_NotifyEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
4362 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4365 def Veto(*args
, **kwargs
):
4369 Prevents the change announced by this event from happening.
4371 It is in general a good idea to notify the user about the reasons for
4372 vetoing the change because otherwise the applications behaviour (which
4373 just refuses to do what the user wants) might be quite surprising.
4375 return _core_
.NotifyEvent_Veto(*args
, **kwargs
)
4377 def Allow(*args
, **kwargs
):
4381 This is the opposite of `Veto`: it explicitly allows the event to be
4382 processed. For most events it is not necessary to call this method as
4383 the events are allowed anyhow but some are forbidden by default (this
4384 will be mentioned in the corresponding event description).
4386 return _core_
.NotifyEvent_Allow(*args
, **kwargs
)
4388 def IsAllowed(*args
, **kwargs
):
4390 IsAllowed(self) -> bool
4392 Returns true if the change is allowed (`Veto` hasn't been called) or
4393 false otherwise (if it was).
4395 return _core_
.NotifyEvent_IsAllowed(*args
, **kwargs
)
4398 class NotifyEventPtr(NotifyEvent
):
4399 def __init__(self
, this
):
4401 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4402 self
.__class
__ = NotifyEvent
4403 _core_
.NotifyEvent_swigregister(NotifyEventPtr
)
4405 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4407 class ScrollEvent(CommandEvent
):
4409 A scroll event holds information about events sent from stand-alone
4410 scrollbars and sliders. Note that scrolled windows do not send
4411 instnaces of this event class, but send the `wx.ScrollWinEvent`
4415 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxScrollEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4416 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4418 __init__(self, wxEventType commandType=wxEVT_NULL, int winid=0, int pos=0,
4419 int orient=0) -> ScrollEvent
4421 newobj
= _core_
.new_ScrollEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
4422 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4425 def GetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
):
4427 GetOrientation(self) -> int
4429 Returns wx.HORIZONTAL or wx.VERTICAL, depending on the orientation of
4432 return _core_
.ScrollEvent_GetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
)
4434 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
4436 GetPosition(self) -> int
4438 Returns the position of the scrollbar.
4440 return _core_
.ScrollEvent_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
4442 def SetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
):
4443 """SetOrientation(self, int orient)"""
4444 return _core_
.ScrollEvent_SetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
)
4446 def SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
4447 """SetPosition(self, int pos)"""
4448 return _core_
.ScrollEvent_SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
4451 class ScrollEventPtr(ScrollEvent
):
4452 def __init__(self
, this
):
4454 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4455 self
.__class
__ = ScrollEvent
4456 _core_
.ScrollEvent_swigregister(ScrollEventPtr
)
4458 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4460 class ScrollWinEvent(Event
):
4462 A wx.ScrollWinEvent holds information about scrolling and is sent from
4466 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxScrollWinEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4467 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4469 __init__(self, wxEventType commandType=wxEVT_NULL, int pos=0, int orient=0) -> ScrollWinEvent
4471 A wx.ScrollWinEvent holds information about scrolling and is sent from
4474 newobj
= _core_
.new_ScrollWinEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
4475 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4478 def GetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
):
4480 GetOrientation(self) -> int
4482 Returns wx.HORIZONTAL or wx.VERTICAL, depending on the orientation of
4485 return _core_
.ScrollWinEvent_GetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
)
4487 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
4489 GetPosition(self) -> int
4491 Returns the position of the scrollbar for the thumb track and release
4492 events. Note that this field can't be used for the other events, you
4493 need to query the window itself for the current position in that case.
4495 return _core_
.ScrollWinEvent_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
4497 def SetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
):
4498 """SetOrientation(self, int orient)"""
4499 return _core_
.ScrollWinEvent_SetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
)
4501 def SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
4502 """SetPosition(self, int pos)"""
4503 return _core_
.ScrollWinEvent_SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
4506 class ScrollWinEventPtr(ScrollWinEvent
):
4507 def __init__(self
, this
):
4509 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4510 self
.__class
__ = ScrollWinEvent
4511 _core_
.ScrollWinEvent_swigregister(ScrollWinEventPtr
)
4513 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4515 MOUSE_BTN_ANY
= _core_
.MOUSE_BTN_ANY
4516 MOUSE_BTN_NONE
= _core_
.MOUSE_BTN_NONE
4517 MOUSE_BTN_LEFT
= _core_
.MOUSE_BTN_LEFT
4518 MOUSE_BTN_MIDDLE
= _core_
.MOUSE_BTN_MIDDLE
4519 MOUSE_BTN_RIGHT
= _core_
.MOUSE_BTN_RIGHT
4520 class MouseEvent(Event
):
4522 This event class contains information about the events generated by
4523 the mouse: they include mouse buttons press and release events and
4526 All mouse events involving the buttons use ``wx.MOUSE_BTN_LEFT`` for
4527 the left mouse button, ``wx.MOUSE_BTN_MIDDLE`` for the middle one and
4528 ``wx.MOUSE_BTN_RIGHT`` for the right one. Note that not all mice have
4529 a middle button so a portable application should avoid relying on the
4532 Note the difference between methods like `LeftDown` and `LeftIsDown`:
4533 the former returns true when the event corresponds to the left mouse
4534 button click while the latter returns true if the left mouse button is
4535 currently being pressed. For example, when the user is dragging the
4536 mouse you can use `LeftIsDown` to test whether the left mouse button
4537 is (still) depressed. Also, by convention, if `LeftDown` returns true,
4538 `LeftIsDown` will also return true in wxWidgets whatever the
4539 underlying GUI behaviour is (which is platform-dependent). The same
4540 applies, of course, to other mouse buttons as well.
4543 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMouseEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4544 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4546 __init__(self, wxEventType mouseType=wxEVT_NULL) -> MouseEvent
4548 Constructs a wx.MouseEvent. Valid event types are:
4550 * wxEVT_ENTER_WINDOW
4551 * wxEVT_LEAVE_WINDOW
4557 * wxEVT_MIDDLE_DCLICK
4560 * wxEVT_RIGHT_DCLICK
4564 newobj
= _core_
.new_MouseEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
4565 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4568 def IsButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
4570 IsButton(self) -> bool
4572 Returns true if the event was a mouse button event (not necessarily a
4573 button down event - that may be tested using `ButtonDown`).
4575 return _core_
.MouseEvent_IsButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
4577 def ButtonDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4579 ButtonDown(self, int but=MOUSE_BTN_ANY) -> bool
4581 If the argument is omitted, this returns true if the event was any
4582 mouse button down event. Otherwise the argument specifies which
4583 button-down event shold be checked for (see `Button` for the possible
4586 return _core_
.MouseEvent_ButtonDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4588 def ButtonDClick(*args
, **kwargs
):
4590 ButtonDClick(self, int but=MOUSE_BTN_ANY) -> bool
4592 If the argument is omitted, this returns true if the event was any
4593 mouse double click event. Otherwise the argument specifies which
4594 double click event to check for (see `Button` for the possible
4597 return _core_
.MouseEvent_ButtonDClick(*args
, **kwargs
)
4599 def ButtonUp(*args
, **kwargs
):
4601 ButtonUp(self, int but=MOUSE_BTN_ANY) -> bool
4603 If the argument is omitted, this returns true if the event was any
4604 mouse button up event. Otherwise the argument specifies which button
4605 up event to check for (see `Button` for the possible values).
4607 return _core_
.MouseEvent_ButtonUp(*args
, **kwargs
)
4609 def Button(*args
, **kwargs
):
4611 Button(self, int button) -> bool
4613 Returns true if the identified mouse button is changing state. Valid
4614 values of button are:
4616 ==================== =====================================
4617 wx.MOUSE_BTN_LEFT check if left button was pressed
4618 wx.MOUSE_BTN_MIDDLE check if middle button was pressed
4619 wx.MOUSE_BTN_RIGHT check if right button was pressed
4620 wx.MOUSE_BTN_ANY check if any button was pressed
4621 ==================== =====================================
4624 return _core_
.MouseEvent_Button(*args
, **kwargs
)
4626 def ButtonIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4627 """ButtonIsDown(self, int but) -> bool"""
4628 return _core_
.MouseEvent_ButtonIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4630 def GetButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
4632 GetButton(self) -> int
4634 Returns the mouse button which generated this event or
4635 wx.MOUSE_BTN_NONE if no button is involved (for mouse move, enter or
4636 leave event, for example). Otherwise wx.MOUSE_BTN_LEFT is returned for
4637 the left button down, up and double click events, wx.MOUSE_BTN_MIDDLE
4638 and wx.MOUSE_BTN_RIGHT for the same events for the middle and the
4639 right buttons respectively.
4641 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
4643 def ControlDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4645 ControlDown(self) -> bool
4647 Returns true if the control key was down at the time of the event.
4649 return _core_
.MouseEvent_ControlDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4651 def MetaDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4653 MetaDown(self) -> bool
4655 Returns true if the Meta key was down at the time of the event.
4657 return _core_
.MouseEvent_MetaDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4659 def AltDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4661 AltDown(self) -> bool
4663 Returns true if the Alt key was down at the time of the event.
4665 return _core_
.MouseEvent_AltDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4667 def ShiftDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4669 ShiftDown(self) -> bool
4671 Returns true if the Shift key was down at the time of the event.
4673 return _core_
.MouseEvent_ShiftDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4675 def CmdDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4677 CmdDown(self) -> bool
4679 "Cmd" is a pseudo key which is the same as Control for PC and Unix
4680 platforms but the special "Apple" (a.k.a as "Command") key on
4681 Macs. It often makes sense to use it instead of, say, `ControlDown`
4682 because Cmd key is used for the same thing under Mac as Ctrl
4683 elsewhere. The Ctrl key still exists, it's just not used for this
4684 purpose. So for non-Mac platforms this is the same as `ControlDown`
4685 and Macs this is the same as `MetaDown`.
4687 return _core_
.MouseEvent_CmdDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4689 def LeftDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4691 LeftDown(self) -> bool
4693 Returns true if the left mouse button state changed to down.
4695 return _core_
.MouseEvent_LeftDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4697 def MiddleDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4699 MiddleDown(self) -> bool
4701 Returns true if the middle mouse button state changed to down.
4703 return _core_
.MouseEvent_MiddleDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4705 def RightDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4707 RightDown(self) -> bool
4709 Returns true if the right mouse button state changed to down.
4711 return _core_
.MouseEvent_RightDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4713 def LeftUp(*args
, **kwargs
):
4715 LeftUp(self) -> bool
4717 Returns true if the left mouse button state changed to up.
4719 return _core_
.MouseEvent_LeftUp(*args
, **kwargs
)
4721 def MiddleUp(*args
, **kwargs
):
4723 MiddleUp(self) -> bool
4725 Returns true if the middle mouse button state changed to up.
4727 return _core_
.MouseEvent_MiddleUp(*args
, **kwargs
)
4729 def RightUp(*args
, **kwargs
):
4731 RightUp(self) -> bool
4733 Returns true if the right mouse button state changed to up.
4735 return _core_
.MouseEvent_RightUp(*args
, **kwargs
)
4737 def LeftDClick(*args
, **kwargs
):
4739 LeftDClick(self) -> bool
4741 Returns true if the event was a left button double click.
4743 return _core_
.MouseEvent_LeftDClick(*args
, **kwargs
)
4745 def MiddleDClick(*args
, **kwargs
):
4747 MiddleDClick(self) -> bool
4749 Returns true if the event was a middle button double click.
4751 return _core_
.MouseEvent_MiddleDClick(*args
, **kwargs
)
4753 def RightDClick(*args
, **kwargs
):
4755 RightDClick(self) -> bool
4757 Returns true if the event was a right button double click.
4759 return _core_
.MouseEvent_RightDClick(*args
, **kwargs
)
4761 def LeftIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4763 LeftIsDown(self) -> bool
4765 Returns true if the left mouse button is currently down, independent
4766 of the current event type.
4768 Please notice that it is not the same as LeftDown which returns true
4769 if the left mouse button was just pressed. Rather, it describes the
4770 state of the mouse button before the event happened.
4772 This event is usually used in the mouse event handlers which process
4773 "move mouse" messages to determine whether the user is (still)
4776 return _core_
.MouseEvent_LeftIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4778 def MiddleIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4780 MiddleIsDown(self) -> bool
4782 Returns true if the middle mouse button is currently down, independent
4783 of the current event type.
4785 return _core_
.MouseEvent_MiddleIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4787 def RightIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
4789 RightIsDown(self) -> bool
4791 Returns true if the right mouse button is currently down, independent
4792 of the current event type.
4794 return _core_
.MouseEvent_RightIsDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
4796 def Dragging(*args
, **kwargs
):
4798 Dragging(self) -> bool
4800 Returns true if this was a dragging event (motion while a button is
4803 return _core_
.MouseEvent_Dragging(*args
, **kwargs
)
4805 def Moving(*args
, **kwargs
):
4807 Moving(self) -> bool
4809 Returns true if this was a motion event and no mouse buttons were
4810 pressed. If any mouse button is held pressed, then this method returns
4811 false and Dragging returns true.
4813 return _core_
.MouseEvent_Moving(*args
, **kwargs
)
4815 def Entering(*args
, **kwargs
):
4817 Entering(self) -> bool
4819 Returns true if the mouse was entering the window.
4821 return _core_
.MouseEvent_Entering(*args
, **kwargs
)
4823 def Leaving(*args
, **kwargs
):
4825 Leaving(self) -> bool
4827 Returns true if the mouse was leaving the window.
4829 return _core_
.MouseEvent_Leaving(*args
, **kwargs
)
4831 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
4833 GetPosition(self) -> Point
4835 Returns the pixel position of the mouse in window coordinates when the
4838 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
4840 def GetPositionTuple(*args
, **kwargs
):
4842 GetPositionTuple() -> (x,y)
4844 Returns the pixel position of the mouse in window coordinates when the
4847 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetPositionTuple(*args
, **kwargs
)
4849 def GetLogicalPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
4851 GetLogicalPosition(self, DC dc) -> Point
4853 Returns the logical mouse position in pixels (i.e. translated
4854 according to the translation set for the DC, which usually indicates
4855 that the window has been scrolled).
4857 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetLogicalPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
4859 def GetX(*args
, **kwargs
):
4863 Returns X coordinate of the physical mouse event position.
4865 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetX(*args
, **kwargs
)
4867 def GetY(*args
, **kwargs
):
4871 Returns Y coordinate of the physical mouse event position.
4873 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetY(*args
, **kwargs
)
4875 def GetWheelRotation(*args
, **kwargs
):
4877 GetWheelRotation(self) -> int
4879 Get wheel rotation, positive or negative indicates direction of
4880 rotation. Current devices all send an event when rotation is equal to
4881 +/-WheelDelta, but this allows for finer resolution devices to be
4882 created in the future. Because of this you shouldn't assume that one
4883 event is equal to 1 line or whatever, but you should be able to either
4884 do partial line scrolling or wait until +/-WheelDelta rotation values
4885 have been accumulated before scrolling.
4887 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetWheelRotation(*args
, **kwargs
)
4889 def GetWheelDelta(*args
, **kwargs
):
4891 GetWheelDelta(self) -> int
4893 Get wheel delta, normally 120. This is the threshold for action to be
4894 taken, and one such action (for example, scrolling one increment)
4895 should occur for each delta.
4897 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetWheelDelta(*args
, **kwargs
)
4899 def GetLinesPerAction(*args
, **kwargs
):
4901 GetLinesPerAction(self) -> int
4903 Returns the configured number of lines (or whatever) to be scrolled
4904 per wheel action. Defaults to three.
4906 return _core_
.MouseEvent_GetLinesPerAction(*args
, **kwargs
)
4908 def IsPageScroll(*args
, **kwargs
):
4910 IsPageScroll(self) -> bool
4912 Returns true if the system has been setup to do page scrolling with
4913 the mouse wheel instead of line scrolling.
4915 return _core_
.MouseEvent_IsPageScroll(*args
, **kwargs
)
4917 m_x
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_x_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_x_set
)
4918 m_y
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_y_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_y_set
)
4919 m_leftDown
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_leftDown_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_leftDown_set
)
4920 m_middleDown
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_middleDown_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_middleDown_set
)
4921 m_rightDown
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_rightDown_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_rightDown_set
)
4922 m_controlDown
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_controlDown_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_controlDown_set
)
4923 m_shiftDown
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_shiftDown_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_shiftDown_set
)
4924 m_altDown
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_altDown_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_altDown_set
)
4925 m_metaDown
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_metaDown_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_metaDown_set
)
4926 m_wheelRotation
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_wheelRotation_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_wheelRotation_set
)
4927 m_wheelDelta
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_wheelDelta_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_wheelDelta_set
)
4928 m_linesPerAction
= property(_core_
.MouseEvent_m_linesPerAction_get
, _core_
.MouseEvent_m_linesPerAction_set
)
4930 class MouseEventPtr(MouseEvent
):
4931 def __init__(self
, this
):
4933 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
4934 self
.__class
__ = MouseEvent
4935 _core_
.MouseEvent_swigregister(MouseEventPtr
)
4937 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
4939 class SetCursorEvent(Event
):
4941 A SetCursorEvent is generated when the mouse cursor is about to be set
4942 as a result of mouse motion. This event gives the application the
4943 chance to perform specific mouse cursor processing based on the
4944 current position of the mouse within the window. Use the `SetCursor`
4945 method to specify the cursor you want to be displayed.
4948 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxSetCursorEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
4949 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
4951 __init__(self, int x=0, int y=0) -> SetCursorEvent
4953 Construct a new `wx.SetCursorEvent`.
4955 newobj
= _core_
.new_SetCursorEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
4956 self
.this
= newobj
.this
4959 def GetX(*args
, **kwargs
):
4963 Returns the X coordinate of the mouse in client coordinates.
4965 return _core_
.SetCursorEvent_GetX(*args
, **kwargs
)
4967 def GetY(*args
, **kwargs
):
4971 Returns the Y coordinate of the mouse in client coordinates.
4973 return _core_
.SetCursorEvent_GetY(*args
, **kwargs
)
4975 def SetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
):
4977 SetCursor(self, Cursor cursor)
4979 Sets the cursor associated with this event.
4981 return _core_
.SetCursorEvent_SetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
)
4983 def GetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
):
4985 GetCursor(self) -> Cursor
4987 Returns a reference to the cursor specified by this event.
4989 return _core_
.SetCursorEvent_GetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
)
4991 def HasCursor(*args
, **kwargs
):
4993 HasCursor(self) -> bool
4995 Returns true if the cursor specified by this event is a valid cursor.
4997 return _core_
.SetCursorEvent_HasCursor(*args
, **kwargs
)
5000 class SetCursorEventPtr(SetCursorEvent
):
5001 def __init__(self
, this
):
5003 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5004 self
.__class
__ = SetCursorEvent
5005 _core_
.SetCursorEvent_swigregister(SetCursorEventPtr
)
5007 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5009 class KeyEvent(Event
):
5011 This event class contains information about keypress and character
5012 events. These events are only sent to the widget that currently has
5015 Notice that there are three different kinds of keyboard events in
5016 wxWidgets: key down and up events and char events. The difference
5017 between the first two is clear - the first corresponds to a key press
5018 and the second to a key release - otherwise they are identical. Just
5019 note that if the key is maintained in a pressed state you will
5020 typically get a lot of (automatically generated) down events but only
5021 one up so it is wrong to assume that there is one up event
5022 corresponding to each down one.
5024 Both key events provide untranslated key codes while the char event
5025 carries the translated one. The untranslated code for alphanumeric
5026 keys is always an upper case value. For the other keys it is one of
5027 WXK_XXX values from the keycodes table. The translated key is, in
5028 general, the character the user expects to appear as the result of the
5029 key combination when typing the text into a text entry zone, for
5032 A few examples to clarify this (all assume that CAPS LOCK is unpressed
5033 and the standard US keyboard): when the 'A' key is pressed, the key
5034 down event key code is equal to ASCII A == 65. But the char event key
5035 code is ASCII a == 97. On the other hand, if you press both SHIFT and
5036 'A' keys simultaneously , the key code in key down event will still be
5037 just 'A' while the char event key code parameter will now be 'A' as
5040 Although in this simple case it is clear that the correct key code
5041 could be found in the key down event handler by checking the value
5042 returned by `ShiftDown`, in general you should use EVT_CHAR for this
5043 as for non alphanumeric keys or non-US keyboard layouts the
5044 translation is keyboard-layout dependent and can only be done properly
5045 by the system itself.
5047 Another kind of translation is done when the control key is pressed:
5048 for example, for CTRL-A key press the key down event still carries the
5049 same key code 'A' as usual but the char event will have key code of 1,
5050 the ASCII value of this key combination.
5052 You may discover how the other keys on your system behave
5053 interactively by running the KeyEvents sample in the wxPython demo and
5054 pressing some keys while the blue box at the top has the keyboard
5057 **Note**: If a key down event is caught and the event handler does not
5058 call event.Skip() then the coresponding char event will not
5059 happen. This is by design and enables the programs that handle both
5060 types of events to be a bit simpler.
5062 **Note for Windows programmers**: The key and char events in wxWidgets
5063 are similar to but slightly different from Windows WM_KEYDOWN and
5064 WM_CHAR events. In particular, Alt-x combination will generate a char
5065 event in wxWidgets (unless it is used as an accelerator).
5067 **Tip**: be sure to call event.Skip() for events that you don't
5068 process in key event function, otherwise menu shortcuts may cease to
5073 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxKeyEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5074 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5076 __init__(self, wxEventType eventType=wxEVT_NULL) -> KeyEvent
5078 Construct a new `wx.KeyEvent`. Valid event types are:
5081 newobj
= _core_
.new_KeyEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5082 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5085 def ControlDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
5087 ControlDown(self) -> bool
5089 Returns ``True`` if the Control key was down at the time of the event.
5091 return _core_
.KeyEvent_ControlDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
5093 def MetaDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
5095 MetaDown(self) -> bool
5097 Returns ``True`` if the Meta key was down at the time of the event.
5099 return _core_
.KeyEvent_MetaDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
5101 def AltDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
5103 AltDown(self) -> bool
5105 Returns ``True`` if the Alt key was down at the time of the event.
5107 return _core_
.KeyEvent_AltDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
5109 def ShiftDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
5111 ShiftDown(self) -> bool
5113 Returns ``True`` if the Shift key was down at the time of the event.
5115 return _core_
.KeyEvent_ShiftDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
5117 def CmdDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
5119 CmdDown(self) -> bool
5121 "Cmd" is a pseudo key which is the same as Control for PC and Unix
5122 platforms but the special "Apple" (a.k.a as "Command") key on
5123 Macs. It makes often sense to use it instead of, say, `ControlDown`
5124 because Cmd key is used for the same thing under Mac as Ctrl
5125 elsewhere. The Ctrl still exists, it's just not used for this
5126 purpose. So for non-Mac platforms this is the same as `ControlDown`
5127 and Macs this is the same as `MetaDown`.
5129 return _core_
.KeyEvent_CmdDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
5131 def HasModifiers(*args
, **kwargs
):
5133 HasModifiers(self) -> bool
5135 Returns true if either CTRL or ALT keys was down at the time of the
5136 key event. Note that this function does not take into account neither
5137 SHIFT nor META key states (the reason for ignoring the latter is that
5138 it is common for NUMLOCK key to be configured as META under X but the
5139 key presses even while NUMLOCK is on should be still processed
5142 return _core_
.KeyEvent_HasModifiers(*args
, **kwargs
)
5144 def GetKeyCode(*args
, **kwargs
):
5146 GetKeyCode(self) -> int
5148 Returns the virtual key code. ASCII events return normal ASCII values,
5149 while non-ASCII events return values such as WXK_LEFT for the left
5150 cursor key. See `wx.KeyEvent` for a full list of the virtual key
5153 Note that in Unicode build, the returned value is meaningful only if
5154 the user entered a character that can be represented in current
5155 locale's default charset. You can obtain the corresponding Unicode
5156 character using `GetUnicodeKey`.
5158 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetKeyCode(*args
, **kwargs
)
5160 KeyCode
= GetKeyCode
5161 def GetUnicodeKey(*args
, **kwargs
):
5163 GetUnicodeKey(self) -> int
5165 Returns the Unicode character corresponding to this key event. This
5166 function is only meaningfule in a Unicode build of wxPython.
5168 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetUnicodeKey(*args
, **kwargs
)
5170 GetUniChar
= GetUnicodeKey
5171 def GetRawKeyCode(*args
, **kwargs
):
5173 GetRawKeyCode(self) -> unsigned int
5175 Returns the raw key code for this event. This is a platform-dependent
5176 scan code which should only be used in advanced
5177 applications. Currently the raw key codes are not supported by all
5180 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetRawKeyCode(*args
, **kwargs
)
5182 def GetRawKeyFlags(*args
, **kwargs
):
5184 GetRawKeyFlags(self) -> unsigned int
5186 Returns the low level key flags for this event. The flags are
5187 platform-dependent and should only be used in advanced applications.
5188 Currently the raw key flags are not supported by all ports.
5190 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetRawKeyFlags(*args
, **kwargs
)
5192 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
5194 GetPosition(self) -> Point
5196 Find the position of the event, if applicable.
5198 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
5200 def GetPositionTuple(*args
, **kwargs
):
5202 GetPositionTuple() -> (x,y)
5204 Find the position of the event, if applicable.
5206 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetPositionTuple(*args
, **kwargs
)
5208 def GetX(*args
, **kwargs
):
5212 Returns the X position (in client coordinates) of the event, if
5215 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetX(*args
, **kwargs
)
5217 def GetY(*args
, **kwargs
):
5221 Returns the Y position (in client coordinates) of the event, if
5224 return _core_
.KeyEvent_GetY(*args
, **kwargs
)
5226 m_x
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_x_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_x_set
)
5227 m_y
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_y_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_y_set
)
5228 m_keyCode
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_keyCode_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_keyCode_set
)
5229 m_controlDown
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_controlDown_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_controlDown_set
)
5230 m_shiftDown
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_shiftDown_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_shiftDown_set
)
5231 m_altDown
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_altDown_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_altDown_set
)
5232 m_metaDown
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_metaDown_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_metaDown_set
)
5233 m_scanCode
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_scanCode_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_scanCode_set
)
5234 m_rawCode
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_rawCode_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_rawCode_set
)
5235 m_rawFlags
= property(_core_
.KeyEvent_m_rawFlags_get
, _core_
.KeyEvent_m_rawFlags_set
)
5237 class KeyEventPtr(KeyEvent
):
5238 def __init__(self
, this
):
5240 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5241 self
.__class
__ = KeyEvent
5242 _core_
.KeyEvent_swigregister(KeyEventPtr
)
5244 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5246 class SizeEvent(Event
):
5248 A size event holds information about size change events. The EVT_SIZE
5249 handler function will be called when the window it is bound to has
5252 Note that the size passed is of the whole window: call
5253 `wx.Window.GetClientSize` for the area which may be used by the
5256 When a window is resized, usually only a small part of the window is
5257 damaged and and that area is all that is in the update region for the
5258 next paint event. However, if your drawing depends on the size of the
5259 window, you may need to clear the DC explicitly and repaint the whole
5260 window. In which case, you may need to call `wx.Window.Refresh` to
5261 invalidate the entire window.
5265 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxSizeEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5266 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5268 __init__(self, Size sz=DefaultSize, int winid=0) -> SizeEvent
5270 Construct a new ``wx.SizeEvent``.
5272 newobj
= _core_
.new_SizeEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5273 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5276 def GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
5278 GetSize(self) -> Size
5280 Returns the entire size of the window generating the size change
5283 return _core_
.SizeEvent_GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
5285 def GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
5286 """GetRect(self) -> Rect"""
5287 return _core_
.SizeEvent_GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
5289 def SetRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
5290 """SetRect(self, Rect rect)"""
5291 return _core_
.SizeEvent_SetRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
5293 def SetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
5294 """SetSize(self, Size size)"""
5295 return _core_
.SizeEvent_SetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
5297 m_size
= property(_core_
.SizeEvent_m_size_get
, _core_
.SizeEvent_m_size_set
)
5298 m_rect
= property(_core_
.SizeEvent_m_rect_get
, _core_
.SizeEvent_m_rect_set
)
5300 class SizeEventPtr(SizeEvent
):
5301 def __init__(self
, this
):
5303 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5304 self
.__class
__ = SizeEvent
5305 _core_
.SizeEvent_swigregister(SizeEventPtr
)
5307 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5309 class MoveEvent(Event
):
5311 This event object is sent for EVT_MOVE event bindings when a window is
5312 moved to a new position.
5315 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMoveEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5316 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5318 __init__(self, Point pos=DefaultPosition, int winid=0) -> MoveEvent
5322 newobj
= _core_
.new_MoveEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5323 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5326 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
5328 GetPosition(self) -> Point
5330 Returns the position of the window generating the move change event.
5332 return _core_
.MoveEvent_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
5334 def GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
5335 """GetRect(self) -> Rect"""
5336 return _core_
.MoveEvent_GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
5338 def SetRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
5339 """SetRect(self, Rect rect)"""
5340 return _core_
.MoveEvent_SetRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
5342 def SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
5343 """SetPosition(self, Point pos)"""
5344 return _core_
.MoveEvent_SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
5346 m_pos
= property(GetPosition
, SetPosition
)
5347 m_rect
= property(GetRect
, SetRect
)
5350 class MoveEventPtr(MoveEvent
):
5351 def __init__(self
, this
):
5353 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5354 self
.__class
__ = MoveEvent
5355 _core_
.MoveEvent_swigregister(MoveEventPtr
)
5357 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5359 class PaintEvent(Event
):
5361 A paint event is sent when a window's contents needs to be repainted.
5362 Note that in an EVT_PAINT handler the application must *always* create
5363 a `wx.PaintDC` object, even if you do not use it. Otherwise MS
5364 Windows assumes that the window has not been painted yet and will send
5365 the event again, causing endless refreshes.
5367 You can optimize painting by retrieving the rectangles that have been
5368 damaged using `wx.Window.GetUpdateRegion` and/or `wx.RegionIterator`,
5369 and only repainting these rectangles. The rectangles are in terms of
5370 the client area, and are unscrolled, so you will need to do some
5371 calculations using the current view position to obtain logical,
5376 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPaintEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5377 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5378 """__init__(self, int Id=0) -> PaintEvent"""
5379 newobj
= _core_
.new_PaintEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5380 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5384 class PaintEventPtr(PaintEvent
):
5385 def __init__(self
, this
):
5387 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5388 self
.__class
__ = PaintEvent
5389 _core_
.PaintEvent_swigregister(PaintEventPtr
)
5391 class NcPaintEvent(Event
):
5392 """Proxy of C++ NcPaintEvent class"""
5394 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxNcPaintEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5395 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5396 """__init__(self, int winid=0) -> NcPaintEvent"""
5397 newobj
= _core_
.new_NcPaintEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5398 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5402 class NcPaintEventPtr(NcPaintEvent
):
5403 def __init__(self
, this
):
5405 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5406 self
.__class
__ = NcPaintEvent
5407 _core_
.NcPaintEvent_swigregister(NcPaintEventPtr
)
5409 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5411 class EraseEvent(Event
):
5413 An erase event is sent whenever the background of a window needs to be
5414 repainted. To intercept this event use the EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND event
5415 binder. On some platforms, such as GTK+, this event is simulated
5416 (simply generated just before the paint event) and may cause flicker.
5418 To paint a custom background use the `GetDC` method and use the returned
5419 device context if it is not ``None``, otherwise create a temporary
5420 `wx.ClientDC` and draw on that.
5424 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxEraseEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5425 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5427 __init__(self, int Id=0, DC dc=None) -> EraseEvent
5431 newobj
= _core_
.new_EraseEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5432 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5435 def GetDC(*args
, **kwargs
):
5439 Returns the device context the event handler should draw upon. If
5440 ``None`` is returned then create a temporary `wx.ClientDC` and use
5443 return _core_
.EraseEvent_GetDC(*args
, **kwargs
)
5446 class EraseEventPtr(EraseEvent
):
5447 def __init__(self
, this
):
5449 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5450 self
.__class
__ = EraseEvent
5451 _core_
.EraseEvent_swigregister(EraseEventPtr
)
5453 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5455 class FocusEvent(Event
):
5457 A focus event is sent when a window's focus changes. The window losing
5458 focus receives an EVT_KILL_FOCUS event while the window gaining it
5459 gets an EVT_SET_FOCUS event.
5461 Notice that the set focus event happens both when the user gives focus
5462 to the window (whether using the mouse or keyboard) and when it is
5463 done from the program itself using `wx.Window.SetFocus`.
5467 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxFocusEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5468 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5470 __init__(self, wxEventType type=wxEVT_NULL, int winid=0) -> FocusEvent
5474 newobj
= _core_
.new_FocusEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5475 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5478 def GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
5480 GetWindow(self) -> Window
5482 Returns the other window associated with this event, that is the
5483 window which had the focus before for the EVT_SET_FOCUS event and the
5484 window which is going to receive focus for the wxEVT_KILL_FOCUS event.
5486 Warning: the window returned may be None!
5488 return _core_
.FocusEvent_GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
5490 def SetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
5491 """SetWindow(self, Window win)"""
5492 return _core_
.FocusEvent_SetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
5495 class FocusEventPtr(FocusEvent
):
5496 def __init__(self
, this
):
5498 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5499 self
.__class
__ = FocusEvent
5500 _core_
.FocusEvent_swigregister(FocusEventPtr
)
5502 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5504 class ChildFocusEvent(CommandEvent
):
5506 wx.ChildFocusEvent notifies the parent that a child has received the
5507 focus. Unlike `wx.FocusEvent` it is propagated up the window
5511 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxChildFocusEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5512 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5514 __init__(self, Window win=None) -> ChildFocusEvent
5518 newobj
= _core_
.new_ChildFocusEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5519 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5522 def GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
5524 GetWindow(self) -> Window
5526 The window which has just received the focus.
5528 return _core_
.ChildFocusEvent_GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
5531 class ChildFocusEventPtr(ChildFocusEvent
):
5532 def __init__(self
, this
):
5534 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5535 self
.__class
__ = ChildFocusEvent
5536 _core_
.ChildFocusEvent_swigregister(ChildFocusEventPtr
)
5538 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5540 class ActivateEvent(Event
):
5542 An activate event is sent when a top-level window or the entire
5543 application is being activated or deactivated.
5545 A top-level window (a dialog or frame) receives an activate event when
5546 is being activated or deactivated. This is indicated visually by the
5547 title bar changing colour, and a subwindow gaining the keyboard focus.
5548 An application is activated or deactivated when one of its frames
5549 becomes activated, or a frame becomes inactivate resulting in all
5550 application frames being inactive.
5552 Please note that usually you should call event.Skip() in your handlers
5553 for these events so the default handlers will still be called, as not
5554 doing so can result in strange effects.
5558 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxActivateEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5559 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5561 __init__(self, wxEventType type=wxEVT_NULL, bool active=True, int Id=0) -> ActivateEvent
5565 newobj
= _core_
.new_ActivateEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5566 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5569 def GetActive(*args
, **kwargs
):
5571 GetActive(self) -> bool
5573 Returns true if the application or window is being activated, false
5576 return _core_
.ActivateEvent_GetActive(*args
, **kwargs
)
5579 class ActivateEventPtr(ActivateEvent
):
5580 def __init__(self
, this
):
5582 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5583 self
.__class
__ = ActivateEvent
5584 _core_
.ActivateEvent_swigregister(ActivateEventPtr
)
5586 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5588 class InitDialogEvent(Event
):
5590 A wx.InitDialogEvent is sent as a dialog is being initialised, or for
5591 any window when `wx.Window.InitDialog` is called. Handlers for this
5592 event can transfer data to the window, or anything else that should be
5593 done before the user begins editing the form. The default handler
5594 calls `wx.Window.TransferDataToWindow`.
5597 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxInitDialogEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5598 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5600 __init__(self, int Id=0) -> InitDialogEvent
5604 newobj
= _core_
.new_InitDialogEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5605 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5609 class InitDialogEventPtr(InitDialogEvent
):
5610 def __init__(self
, this
):
5612 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5613 self
.__class
__ = InitDialogEvent
5614 _core_
.InitDialogEvent_swigregister(InitDialogEventPtr
)
5616 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5618 class MenuEvent(Event
):
5620 This class is used for a variety of menu-related events. Note that
5621 these do not include menu command events, which are handled by sending
5622 `wx.CommandEvent` objects.
5624 The default handler for wx.EVT_MENU_HIGHLIGHT displays menu item help
5625 text in the first field of the status bar.
5628 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMenuEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5629 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5631 __init__(self, wxEventType type=wxEVT_NULL, int winid=0, Menu menu=None) -> MenuEvent
5635 newobj
= _core_
.new_MenuEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5636 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5639 def GetMenuId(*args
, **kwargs
):
5641 GetMenuId(self) -> int
5643 Returns the menu identifier associated with the event. This method
5644 should be only used with the HIGHLIGHT events.
5646 return _core_
.MenuEvent_GetMenuId(*args
, **kwargs
)
5648 def IsPopup(*args
, **kwargs
):
5650 IsPopup(self) -> bool
5652 Returns ``True`` if the menu which is being opened or closed is a
5653 popup menu, ``False`` if it is a normal one. This method should only
5654 be used with the OPEN and CLOSE events.
5656 return _core_
.MenuEvent_IsPopup(*args
, **kwargs
)
5658 def GetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
5660 GetMenu(self) -> Menu
5662 Returns the menu which is being opened or closed. This method should
5663 only be used with the OPEN and CLOSE events.
5665 return _core_
.MenuEvent_GetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
5668 class MenuEventPtr(MenuEvent
):
5669 def __init__(self
, this
):
5671 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5672 self
.__class
__ = MenuEvent
5673 _core_
.MenuEvent_swigregister(MenuEventPtr
)
5675 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5677 class CloseEvent(Event
):
5679 This event class contains information about window and session close
5682 The handler function for EVT_CLOSE is called when the user has tried
5683 to close a a frame or dialog box using the window manager controls or
5684 the system menu. It can also be invoked by the application itself
5685 programmatically, for example by calling the `wx.Window.Close`
5688 You should check whether the application is forcing the deletion of
5689 the window using `CanVeto`. If it returns ``False``, you must destroy
5690 the window using `wx.Window.Destroy`. If the return value is ``True``,
5691 it is up to you whether you respond by destroying the window or not.
5692 For example you may wish to display a message dialog prompting to save
5693 files or to cancel the close.
5695 If you don't destroy the window, you should call `Veto` to let the
5696 calling code know that you did not destroy the window. This allows the
5697 `wx.Window.Close` function to return ``True`` or ``False`` depending
5698 on whether the close instruction was honored or not.
5701 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxCloseEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5702 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5704 __init__(self, wxEventType type=wxEVT_NULL, int winid=0) -> CloseEvent
5708 newobj
= _core_
.new_CloseEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5709 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5712 def SetLoggingOff(*args
, **kwargs
):
5714 SetLoggingOff(self, bool logOff)
5716 Sets the 'logging off' flag.
5718 return _core_
.CloseEvent_SetLoggingOff(*args
, **kwargs
)
5720 def GetLoggingOff(*args
, **kwargs
):
5722 GetLoggingOff(self) -> bool
5724 Returns ``True`` if the user is logging off or ``False`` if the
5725 system is shutting down. This method can only be called for end
5726 session and query end session events, it doesn't make sense for close
5729 return _core_
.CloseEvent_GetLoggingOff(*args
, **kwargs
)
5731 def Veto(*args
, **kwargs
):
5733 Veto(self, bool veto=True)
5735 Call this from your event handler to veto a system shutdown or to
5736 signal to the calling application that a window close did not happen.
5738 You can only veto a shutdown or close if `CanVeto` returns true.
5740 return _core_
.CloseEvent_Veto(*args
, **kwargs
)
5742 def GetVeto(*args
, **kwargs
):
5743 """GetVeto(self) -> bool"""
5744 return _core_
.CloseEvent_GetVeto(*args
, **kwargs
)
5746 def SetCanVeto(*args
, **kwargs
):
5748 SetCanVeto(self, bool canVeto)
5750 Sets the 'can veto' flag.
5752 return _core_
.CloseEvent_SetCanVeto(*args
, **kwargs
)
5754 def CanVeto(*args
, **kwargs
):
5756 CanVeto(self) -> bool
5758 Returns true if you can veto a system shutdown or a window close
5759 event. Vetoing a window close event is not possible if the calling
5760 code wishes to force the application to exit, and so this function
5761 must be called to check this.
5763 return _core_
.CloseEvent_CanVeto(*args
, **kwargs
)
5766 class CloseEventPtr(CloseEvent
):
5767 def __init__(self
, this
):
5769 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5770 self
.__class
__ = CloseEvent
5771 _core_
.CloseEvent_swigregister(CloseEventPtr
)
5773 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5775 class ShowEvent(Event
):
5776 """An EVT_SHOW event is sent when a window is shown or hidden."""
5778 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxShowEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5779 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5781 __init__(self, int winid=0, bool show=False) -> ShowEvent
5783 An EVT_SHOW event is sent when a window is shown or hidden.
5785 newobj
= _core_
.new_ShowEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5786 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5789 def SetShow(*args
, **kwargs
):
5790 """SetShow(self, bool show)"""
5791 return _core_
.ShowEvent_SetShow(*args
, **kwargs
)
5793 def GetShow(*args
, **kwargs
):
5794 """GetShow(self) -> bool"""
5795 return _core_
.ShowEvent_GetShow(*args
, **kwargs
)
5798 class ShowEventPtr(ShowEvent
):
5799 def __init__(self
, this
):
5801 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5802 self
.__class
__ = ShowEvent
5803 _core_
.ShowEvent_swigregister(ShowEventPtr
)
5805 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5807 class IconizeEvent(Event
):
5809 An EVT_ICONIZE event is sent when a frame is iconized (minimized) or
5813 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxIconizeEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5814 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5816 __init__(self, int id=0, bool iconized=True) -> IconizeEvent
5818 An EVT_ICONIZE event is sent when a frame is iconized (minimized) or
5821 newobj
= _core_
.new_IconizeEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5822 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5825 def Iconized(*args
, **kwargs
):
5827 Iconized(self) -> bool
5829 Returns ``True`` if the frame has been iconized, ``False`` if it has
5832 return _core_
.IconizeEvent_Iconized(*args
, **kwargs
)
5835 class IconizeEventPtr(IconizeEvent
):
5836 def __init__(self
, this
):
5838 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5839 self
.__class
__ = IconizeEvent
5840 _core_
.IconizeEvent_swigregister(IconizeEventPtr
)
5842 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5844 class MaximizeEvent(Event
):
5845 """An EVT_MAXIMIZE event is sent when a frame is maximized or restored."""
5847 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMaximizeEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5848 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5850 __init__(self, int id=0) -> MaximizeEvent
5852 An EVT_MAXIMIZE event is sent when a frame is maximized or restored.
5854 newobj
= _core_
.new_MaximizeEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5855 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5859 class MaximizeEventPtr(MaximizeEvent
):
5860 def __init__(self
, this
):
5862 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5863 self
.__class
__ = MaximizeEvent
5864 _core_
.MaximizeEvent_swigregister(MaximizeEventPtr
)
5866 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5868 class DropFilesEvent(Event
):
5870 This class is used for drop files events, that is, when files have
5871 been dropped onto the window. This functionality is only available
5872 under Windows. The window must have previously been enabled for
5873 dropping by calling `wx.Window.DragAcceptFiles`.
5875 Important note: this is a separate implementation to the more general
5876 drag and drop implementation using `wx.FileDropTarget`, and etc. This
5877 implementation uses the older, Windows message-based approach of
5880 Use wx.EVT_DROP_FILES to bind an event handler to receive file drop
5884 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
5886 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxDropFilesEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5887 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
5889 GetPosition(self) -> Point
5891 Returns the position at which the files were dropped.
5893 return _core_
.DropFilesEvent_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
5895 def GetNumberOfFiles(*args
, **kwargs
):
5897 GetNumberOfFiles(self) -> int
5899 Returns the number of files dropped.
5901 return _core_
.DropFilesEvent_GetNumberOfFiles(*args
, **kwargs
)
5903 def GetFiles(*args
, **kwargs
):
5905 GetFiles(self) -> PyObject
5907 Returns a list of the filenames that were dropped.
5909 return _core_
.DropFilesEvent_GetFiles(*args
, **kwargs
)
5912 class DropFilesEventPtr(DropFilesEvent
):
5913 def __init__(self
, this
):
5915 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
5916 self
.__class
__ = DropFilesEvent
5917 _core_
.DropFilesEvent_swigregister(DropFilesEventPtr
)
5919 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
5921 UPDATE_UI_PROCESS_ALL
= _core_
.UPDATE_UI_PROCESS_ALL
5922 UPDATE_UI_PROCESS_SPECIFIED
= _core_
.UPDATE_UI_PROCESS_SPECIFIED
5923 class UpdateUIEvent(CommandEvent
):
5925 This class is used for EVT_UPDATE_UI pseudo-events which are sent by
5926 wxWidgets to give an application the chance to update various user
5929 Without update UI events, an application has to work hard to
5930 check/uncheck, enable/disable, and set the text for elements such as
5931 menu items and toolbar buttons. The code for doing this has to be
5932 mixed up with the code that is invoked when an action is invoked for a
5933 menu item or button.
5935 With update UI events, you define an event handler to look at the
5936 state of the application and change UI elements accordingly. wxWidgets
5937 will call your handler functions in idle time, so you don't have to
5938 worry where to call this code. In addition to being a clearer and more
5939 declarative method, it also means you don't have to worry whether
5940 you're updating a toolbar or menubar identifier. The same handler can
5941 update a menu item and toolbar button, if the ID values are the same.
5943 Instead of directly manipulating the menu or button, you call
5944 functions in the event object, such as `Check`. wxWidgets will
5945 determine whether such a call has been made, and which UI element to
5948 These events will work for popup menus as well as menubars. Just
5949 before a menu is popped up, `wx.Menu.UpdateUI` is called to process
5950 any UI events for the window that owns the menu.
5952 If you find that the overhead of UI update processing is affecting
5953 your application, you can do one or both of the following:
5955 1. Call `wx.UpdateUIEvent.SetMode` with a value of
5956 wx.UPDATE_UI_PROCESS_SPECIFIED, and set the extra style
5957 wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_UPDATE_EVENTS for every window that should
5958 receive update events. No other windows will receive update
5961 2. Call `wx.UpdateUIEvent.SetUpdateInterval` with a millisecond
5962 value to set the delay between updates. You may need to call
5963 `wx.Window.UpdateWindowUI` at critical points, for example when
5964 a dialog is about to be shown, in case the user sees a slight
5965 delay before windows are updated.
5967 Note that although events are sent in idle time, defining a EVT_IDLE
5968 handler for a window does not affect this because the events are sent
5969 from an internal idle handler.
5971 wxWidgets tries to optimize update events on some platforms. On
5972 Windows and GTK+, events for menubar items are only sent when the menu
5973 is about to be shown, and not in idle time.
5977 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxUpdateUIEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
5978 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
5980 __init__(self, int commandId=0) -> UpdateUIEvent
5984 newobj
= _core_
.new_UpdateUIEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
5985 self
.this
= newobj
.this
5988 def GetChecked(*args
, **kwargs
):
5990 GetChecked(self) -> bool
5992 Returns ``True`` if the UI element should be checked.
5994 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetChecked(*args
, **kwargs
)
5996 def GetEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
5998 GetEnabled(self) -> bool
6000 Returns ``True`` if the UI element should be enabled.
6002 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
6004 def GetText(*args
, **kwargs
):
6006 GetText(self) -> String
6008 Returns the text that should be set for the UI element.
6010 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetText(*args
, **kwargs
)
6012 def GetSetText(*args
, **kwargs
):
6014 GetSetText(self) -> bool
6016 Returns ``True`` if the application has called `SetText`. For
6017 wxWidgets internal use only.
6019 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetSetText(*args
, **kwargs
)
6021 def GetSetChecked(*args
, **kwargs
):
6023 GetSetChecked(self) -> bool
6025 Returns ``True`` if the application has called `Check`. For wxWidgets
6028 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetSetChecked(*args
, **kwargs
)
6030 def GetSetEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
6032 GetSetEnabled(self) -> bool
6034 Returns ``True`` if the application has called `Enable`. For wxWidgets
6037 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetSetEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
6039 def Check(*args
, **kwargs
):
6041 Check(self, bool check)
6043 Check or uncheck the UI element.
6045 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_Check(*args
, **kwargs
)
6047 def Enable(*args
, **kwargs
):
6049 Enable(self, bool enable)
6051 Enable or disable the UI element.
6053 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_Enable(*args
, **kwargs
)
6055 def SetText(*args
, **kwargs
):
6057 SetText(self, String text)
6059 Sets the text for this UI element.
6061 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_SetText(*args
, **kwargs
)
6063 def SetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
):
6065 SetUpdateInterval(long updateInterval)
6067 Sets the interval between updates in milliseconds. Set to -1 to
6068 disable updates, or to 0 to update as frequently as possible. The
6071 Use this to reduce the overhead of UI update events if your
6072 application has a lot of windows. If you set the value to -1 or
6073 greater than 0, you may also need to call `wx.Window.UpdateWindowUI`
6074 at appropriate points in your application, such as when a dialog is
6077 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_SetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
)
6079 SetUpdateInterval
= staticmethod(SetUpdateInterval
)
6080 def GetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
):
6082 GetUpdateInterval() -> long
6084 Returns the current interval between updates in milliseconds. -1
6085 disables updates, 0 updates as frequently as possible.
6087 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
)
6089 GetUpdateInterval
= staticmethod(GetUpdateInterval
)
6090 def CanUpdate(*args
, **kwargs
):
6092 CanUpdate(Window win) -> bool
6094 Returns ``True`` if it is appropriate to update (send UI update events
6097 This function looks at the mode used (see `wx.UpdateUIEvent.SetMode`),
6098 the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_UPDATE_EVENTS flag in window, the time update
6099 events were last sent in idle time, and the update interval, to
6100 determine whether events should be sent to this window now. By default
6101 this will always return true because the update mode is initially
6102 wx.UPDATE_UI_PROCESS_ALL and the interval is set to 0; so update
6103 events will be sent as often as possible. You can reduce the frequency
6104 that events are sent by changing the mode and/or setting an update
6108 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_CanUpdate(*args
, **kwargs
)
6110 CanUpdate
= staticmethod(CanUpdate
)
6111 def ResetUpdateTime(*args
, **kwargs
):
6115 Used internally to reset the last-updated time to the current time. It
6116 is assumed that update events are normally sent in idle time, so this
6117 is called at the end of idle processing.
6119 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_ResetUpdateTime(*args
, **kwargs
)
6121 ResetUpdateTime
= staticmethod(ResetUpdateTime
)
6122 def SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6126 Specify how wxWidgets will send update events: to all windows, or only
6127 to those which specify that they will process the events.
6129 The mode may be one of the following values:
6131 ============================= ==========================================
6132 wxUPDATE_UI_PROCESS_ALL Send UI update events to all windows. This
6133 is the default setting.
6134 wxUPDATE_UI_PROCESS_SPECIFIED Send UI update events only to windows that
6135 have the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_UI_UPDATES extra
6137 ============================= ==========================================
6140 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6142 SetMode
= staticmethod(SetMode
)
6143 def GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6147 Returns a value specifying how wxWidgets will send update events: to
6148 all windows, or only to those which specify that they will process the
6151 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6153 GetMode
= staticmethod(GetMode
)
6155 class UpdateUIEventPtr(UpdateUIEvent
):
6156 def __init__(self
, this
):
6158 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6159 self
.__class
__ = UpdateUIEvent
6160 _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_swigregister(UpdateUIEventPtr
)
6162 def UpdateUIEvent_SetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
):
6164 UpdateUIEvent_SetUpdateInterval(long updateInterval)
6166 Sets the interval between updates in milliseconds. Set to -1 to
6167 disable updates, or to 0 to update as frequently as possible. The
6170 Use this to reduce the overhead of UI update events if your
6171 application has a lot of windows. If you set the value to -1 or
6172 greater than 0, you may also need to call `wx.Window.UpdateWindowUI`
6173 at appropriate points in your application, such as when a dialog is
6176 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_SetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
)
6178 def UpdateUIEvent_GetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
):
6180 UpdateUIEvent_GetUpdateInterval() -> long
6182 Returns the current interval between updates in milliseconds. -1
6183 disables updates, 0 updates as frequently as possible.
6185 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetUpdateInterval(*args
, **kwargs
)
6187 def UpdateUIEvent_CanUpdate(*args
, **kwargs
):
6189 UpdateUIEvent_CanUpdate(Window win) -> bool
6191 Returns ``True`` if it is appropriate to update (send UI update events
6194 This function looks at the mode used (see `wx.UpdateUIEvent.SetMode`),
6195 the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_UPDATE_EVENTS flag in window, the time update
6196 events were last sent in idle time, and the update interval, to
6197 determine whether events should be sent to this window now. By default
6198 this will always return true because the update mode is initially
6199 wx.UPDATE_UI_PROCESS_ALL and the interval is set to 0; so update
6200 events will be sent as often as possible. You can reduce the frequency
6201 that events are sent by changing the mode and/or setting an update
6205 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_CanUpdate(*args
, **kwargs
)
6207 def UpdateUIEvent_ResetUpdateTime(*args
, **kwargs
):
6209 UpdateUIEvent_ResetUpdateTime()
6211 Used internally to reset the last-updated time to the current time. It
6212 is assumed that update events are normally sent in idle time, so this
6213 is called at the end of idle processing.
6215 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_ResetUpdateTime(*args
, **kwargs
)
6217 def UpdateUIEvent_SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6219 UpdateUIEvent_SetMode(int mode)
6221 Specify how wxWidgets will send update events: to all windows, or only
6222 to those which specify that they will process the events.
6224 The mode may be one of the following values:
6226 ============================= ==========================================
6227 wxUPDATE_UI_PROCESS_ALL Send UI update events to all windows. This
6228 is the default setting.
6229 wxUPDATE_UI_PROCESS_SPECIFIED Send UI update events only to windows that
6230 have the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_UI_UPDATES extra
6232 ============================= ==========================================
6235 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6237 def UpdateUIEvent_GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6239 UpdateUIEvent_GetMode() -> int
6241 Returns a value specifying how wxWidgets will send update events: to
6242 all windows, or only to those which specify that they will process the
6245 return _core_
.UpdateUIEvent_GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6247 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6249 class SysColourChangedEvent(Event
):
6251 This class is used for EVT_SYS_COLOUR_CHANGED, which are generated
6252 when the user changes the colour settings using the control
6253 panel. This is only applicable under Windows.
6255 The default event handler for this event propagates the event to child
6256 windows, since Windows only sends the events to top-level windows. If
6257 intercepting this event for a top-level window, remember to call
6258 `Skip` so the the base class handler will still be executed, or to
6259 pass the event on to the window's children explicitly.
6263 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxSysColourChangedEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6264 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6266 __init__(self) -> SysColourChangedEvent
6270 newobj
= _core_
.new_SysColourChangedEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6271 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6275 class SysColourChangedEventPtr(SysColourChangedEvent
):
6276 def __init__(self
, this
):
6278 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6279 self
.__class
__ = SysColourChangedEvent
6280 _core_
.SysColourChangedEvent_swigregister(SysColourChangedEventPtr
)
6282 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6284 class MouseCaptureChangedEvent(Event
):
6286 An mouse capture changed event (EVT_MOUSE_CAPTURE_CHANGED) is sent to
6287 a window that loses its mouse capture. This is called even if
6288 `wx.Window.ReleaseMouse` was called by the application code. Handling
6289 this event allows an application to cater for unexpected capture
6290 releases which might otherwise confuse mouse handling code.
6292 This event is implemented under Windows only.
6295 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMouseCaptureChangedEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6296 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6298 __init__(self, int winid=0, Window gainedCapture=None) -> MouseCaptureChangedEvent
6302 newobj
= _core_
.new_MouseCaptureChangedEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6303 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6306 def GetCapturedWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
6308 GetCapturedWindow(self) -> Window
6310 Returns the window that gained the capture, or ``None`` if it was a
6311 non-wxWidgets window.
6313 return _core_
.MouseCaptureChangedEvent_GetCapturedWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
6316 class MouseCaptureChangedEventPtr(MouseCaptureChangedEvent
):
6317 def __init__(self
, this
):
6319 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6320 self
.__class
__ = MouseCaptureChangedEvent
6321 _core_
.MouseCaptureChangedEvent_swigregister(MouseCaptureChangedEventPtr
)
6323 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6325 class DisplayChangedEvent(Event
):
6327 An EVT_DISPLAY_CHANGED event is sent to all windows when the display
6328 resolution has changed.
6330 This event is implemented under Windows only.
6333 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxDisplayChangedEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6334 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6335 """__init__(self) -> DisplayChangedEvent"""
6336 newobj
= _core_
.new_DisplayChangedEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6337 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6341 class DisplayChangedEventPtr(DisplayChangedEvent
):
6342 def __init__(self
, this
):
6344 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6345 self
.__class
__ = DisplayChangedEvent
6346 _core_
.DisplayChangedEvent_swigregister(DisplayChangedEventPtr
)
6348 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6350 class PaletteChangedEvent(Event
):
6352 An EVT_PALETTE_CHANGED event is sent when the system palette has
6353 changed, thereby giving each window a chance to redo their own to
6356 This event is implemented under Windows only.
6359 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPaletteChangedEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6360 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6362 __init__(self, int id=0) -> PaletteChangedEvent
6364 An EVT_PALETTE_CHANGED event is sent when the system palette has
6365 changed, thereby giving each window a chance to redo their own to
6368 This event is implemented under Windows only.
6370 newobj
= _core_
.new_PaletteChangedEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6371 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6374 def SetChangedWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
6375 """SetChangedWindow(self, Window win)"""
6376 return _core_
.PaletteChangedEvent_SetChangedWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
6378 def GetChangedWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
6379 """GetChangedWindow(self) -> Window"""
6380 return _core_
.PaletteChangedEvent_GetChangedWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
6383 class PaletteChangedEventPtr(PaletteChangedEvent
):
6384 def __init__(self
, this
):
6386 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6387 self
.__class
__ = PaletteChangedEvent
6388 _core_
.PaletteChangedEvent_swigregister(PaletteChangedEventPtr
)
6390 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6392 class QueryNewPaletteEvent(Event
):
6394 An EVT_QUERY_NEW_PALETE event indicates the window is getting keyboard
6395 focus and should re-do its palette.
6397 This event is implemented under Windows only.
6400 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxQueryNewPaletteEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6401 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6403 __init__(self, int winid=0) -> QueryNewPaletteEvent
6407 newobj
= _core_
.new_QueryNewPaletteEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6408 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6411 def SetPaletteRealized(*args
, **kwargs
):
6413 SetPaletteRealized(self, bool realized)
6415 App should set this if it changes the palette.
6417 return _core_
.QueryNewPaletteEvent_SetPaletteRealized(*args
, **kwargs
)
6419 def GetPaletteRealized(*args
, **kwargs
):
6420 """GetPaletteRealized(self) -> bool"""
6421 return _core_
.QueryNewPaletteEvent_GetPaletteRealized(*args
, **kwargs
)
6424 class QueryNewPaletteEventPtr(QueryNewPaletteEvent
):
6425 def __init__(self
, this
):
6427 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6428 self
.__class
__ = QueryNewPaletteEvent
6429 _core_
.QueryNewPaletteEvent_swigregister(QueryNewPaletteEventPtr
)
6431 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6433 class NavigationKeyEvent(Event
):
6435 EVT_NAVIGATION_KEY events are used to control moving the focus between
6436 widgets, otherwise known as tab-traversal. You woudl normally not
6437 catch navigation events in applications as there are already
6438 appropriate handlers in `wx.Dialog` and `wx.Panel`, but you may find
6439 it useful to send navigation events in certain situations to change
6440 the focus in certain ways, although it's probably easier to just call
6441 `wx.Window.Navigate`.
6444 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxNavigationKeyEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6445 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6446 """__init__(self) -> NavigationKeyEvent"""
6447 newobj
= _core_
.new_NavigationKeyEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6448 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6451 def GetDirection(*args
, **kwargs
):
6453 GetDirection(self) -> bool
6455 Returns ``True`` if the direction is forward, ``False`` otherwise.
6457 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_GetDirection(*args
, **kwargs
)
6459 def SetDirection(*args
, **kwargs
):
6461 SetDirection(self, bool forward)
6463 Specify the direction that the navigation should take. Usually the
6464 difference between using Tab and Shift-Tab.
6466 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_SetDirection(*args
, **kwargs
)
6468 def IsWindowChange(*args
, **kwargs
):
6470 IsWindowChange(self) -> bool
6472 Returns ``True`` if window change is allowed.
6474 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_IsWindowChange(*args
, **kwargs
)
6476 def SetWindowChange(*args
, **kwargs
):
6478 SetWindowChange(self, bool ischange)
6480 Specify if the navigation should be able to change parent windows.
6481 For example, changing notebook pages, etc. This is usually implemented
6482 by using Control-Tab.
6484 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_SetWindowChange(*args
, **kwargs
)
6486 def IsFromTab(*args
, **kwargs
):
6488 IsFromTab(self) -> bool
6490 Returns ``True`` if the navigation event is originated from the Tab
6493 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_IsFromTab(*args
, **kwargs
)
6495 def SetFromTab(*args
, **kwargs
):
6497 SetFromTab(self, bool bIs)
6499 Set to true under MSW if the event was generated using the tab key.
6500 This is required for proper navogation over radio buttons.
6502 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_SetFromTab(*args
, **kwargs
)
6504 def SetFlags(*args
, **kwargs
):
6506 SetFlags(self, long flags)
6508 Set the navigation flags to a combination of the following:
6510 * wx.NavigationKeyEvent.IsBackward
6511 * wx.NavigationKeyEvent.IsForward
6512 * wx.NavigationKeyEvent.WinChange
6513 * wx.NavigationKeyEvent.FromTab
6516 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_SetFlags(*args
, **kwargs
)
6518 def GetCurrentFocus(*args
, **kwargs
):
6520 GetCurrentFocus(self) -> Window
6522 Returns the child window which currenty has the focus. May be
6525 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_GetCurrentFocus(*args
, **kwargs
)
6527 def SetCurrentFocus(*args
, **kwargs
):
6529 SetCurrentFocus(self, Window win)
6531 Set the window that has the focus.
6533 return _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_SetCurrentFocus(*args
, **kwargs
)
6535 IsBackward
= _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_IsBackward
6536 IsForward
= _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_IsForward
6537 WinChange
= _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_WinChange
6538 FromTab
= _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_FromTab
6540 class NavigationKeyEventPtr(NavigationKeyEvent
):
6541 def __init__(self
, this
):
6543 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6544 self
.__class
__ = NavigationKeyEvent
6545 _core_
.NavigationKeyEvent_swigregister(NavigationKeyEventPtr
)
6547 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6549 class WindowCreateEvent(CommandEvent
):
6551 The EVT_WINDOW_CREATE event is sent as soon as the window object (the
6552 underlying GUI object) exists.
6555 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxWindowCreateEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6556 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6558 __init__(self, Window win=None) -> WindowCreateEvent
6560 The EVT_WINDOW_CREATE event is sent as soon as the window object (the
6561 underlying GUI object) exists.
6563 newobj
= _core_
.new_WindowCreateEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6564 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6567 def GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
6569 GetWindow(self) -> Window
6571 Returns the window that this event refers to.
6573 return _core_
.WindowCreateEvent_GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
6576 class WindowCreateEventPtr(WindowCreateEvent
):
6577 def __init__(self
, this
):
6579 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6580 self
.__class
__ = WindowCreateEvent
6581 _core_
.WindowCreateEvent_swigregister(WindowCreateEventPtr
)
6583 class WindowDestroyEvent(CommandEvent
):
6585 The EVT_WINDOW_DESTROY event is sent from the `wx.Window` destructor
6586 when the GUI window is destroyed.
6588 When a class derived from `wx.Window` is destroyed its destructor will
6589 have already run by the time this event is sent. Therefore this event
6590 will not usually be received at all by the window itself. Since it is
6591 received after the destructor has run, an object should not try to
6592 handle its own wx.WindowDestroyEvent, but it can be used to get
6593 notification of the destruction of another window.
6596 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxWindowDestroyEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6597 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6599 __init__(self, Window win=None) -> WindowDestroyEvent
6601 The EVT_WINDOW_DESTROY event is sent from the `wx.Window` destructor
6602 when the GUI window is destroyed.
6604 When a class derived from `wx.Window` is destroyed its destructor will
6605 have already run by the time this event is sent. Therefore this event
6606 will not usually be received at all by the window itself. Since it is
6607 received after the destructor has run, an object should not try to
6608 handle its own wx.WindowDestroyEvent, but it can be used to get
6609 notification of the destruction of another window.
6611 newobj
= _core_
.new_WindowDestroyEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6612 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6615 def GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
6617 GetWindow(self) -> Window
6619 Returns the window that this event refers to.
6621 return _core_
.WindowDestroyEvent_GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
6624 class WindowDestroyEventPtr(WindowDestroyEvent
):
6625 def __init__(self
, this
):
6627 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6628 self
.__class
__ = WindowDestroyEvent
6629 _core_
.WindowDestroyEvent_swigregister(WindowDestroyEventPtr
)
6631 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6633 class ContextMenuEvent(CommandEvent
):
6635 This class is used for context menu events (EVT_CONTECT_MENU,) sent to
6636 give the application a chance to show a context (popup) menu.
6639 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxContextMenuEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6640 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6642 __init__(self, wxEventType type=wxEVT_NULL, int winid=0, Point pt=DefaultPosition) -> ContextMenuEvent
6646 newobj
= _core_
.new_ContextMenuEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6647 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6650 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
6652 GetPosition(self) -> Point
6654 Returns the position (in screen coordinants) at which the menu should
6657 return _core_
.ContextMenuEvent_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
6659 def SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
6661 SetPosition(self, Point pos)
6663 Sets the position at which the menu should be shown.
6665 return _core_
.ContextMenuEvent_SetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
6668 class ContextMenuEventPtr(ContextMenuEvent
):
6669 def __init__(self
, this
):
6671 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6672 self
.__class
__ = ContextMenuEvent
6673 _core_
.ContextMenuEvent_swigregister(ContextMenuEventPtr
)
6675 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6677 IDLE_PROCESS_ALL
= _core_
.IDLE_PROCESS_ALL
6678 IDLE_PROCESS_SPECIFIED
= _core_
.IDLE_PROCESS_SPECIFIED
6679 class IdleEvent(Event
):
6681 This class is used for EVT_IDLE events, which are generated and sent
6682 when the application *becomes* idle. In other words, the when the
6683 event queue becomes empty then idle events are sent to all windows (by
6684 default) and as long as none of them call `RequestMore` then there are
6685 no more idle events until after the system event queue has some normal
6686 events and then becomes empty again.
6688 By default, idle events are sent to all windows. If this is causing a
6689 significant overhead in your application, you can call
6690 `wx.IdleEvent.SetMode` with the value wx.IDLE_PROCESS_SPECIFIED, and
6691 set the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE extra window style for every window
6692 which should receive idle events. Then idle events will only be sent
6693 to those windows and not to any others.
6696 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxIdleEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6697 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6699 __init__(self) -> IdleEvent
6703 newobj
= _core_
.new_IdleEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6704 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6707 def RequestMore(*args
, **kwargs
):
6709 RequestMore(self, bool needMore=True)
6711 Tells wxWidgets that more processing is required. This function can be
6712 called by an EVT_IDLE handler for a window to indicate that the
6713 application should forward the EVT_IDLE event once more to the
6714 application windows. If no window calls this function during its
6715 EVT_IDLE handler, then the application will remain in a passive event
6716 loop until a new event is posted to the application by the windowing
6719 return _core_
.IdleEvent_RequestMore(*args
, **kwargs
)
6721 def MoreRequested(*args
, **kwargs
):
6723 MoreRequested(self) -> bool
6725 Returns ``True`` if the OnIdle function processing this event
6726 requested more processing time.
6728 return _core_
.IdleEvent_MoreRequested(*args
, **kwargs
)
6730 def SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6734 Static method for specifying how wxWidgets will send idle events: to
6735 all windows, or only to those which specify that they will process the
6738 The mode can be one of the following values:
6740 ========================= ========================================
6741 wx.IDLE_PROCESS_ALL Send idle events to all windows
6742 wx.IDLE_PROCESS_SPECIFIED Send idle events only to windows that have
6743 the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE extra style
6745 ========================= ========================================
6748 return _core_
.IdleEvent_SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6750 SetMode
= staticmethod(SetMode
)
6751 def GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6755 Static method returning a value specifying how wxWidgets will send
6756 idle events: to all windows, or only to those which specify that they
6757 will process the events.
6759 return _core_
.IdleEvent_GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6761 GetMode
= staticmethod(GetMode
)
6762 def CanSend(*args
, **kwargs
):
6764 CanSend(Window win) -> bool
6766 Returns ``True`` if it is appropriate to send idle events to this
6769 This function looks at the mode used (see `wx.IdleEvent.SetMode`), and
6770 the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE style in window to determine whether idle
6771 events should be sent to this window now. By default this will always
6772 return ``True`` because the update mode is initially
6773 wx.IDLE_PROCESS_ALL. You can change the mode to only send idle events
6774 to windows with the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE extra window style set.
6776 return _core_
.IdleEvent_CanSend(*args
, **kwargs
)
6778 CanSend
= staticmethod(CanSend
)
6780 class IdleEventPtr(IdleEvent
):
6781 def __init__(self
, this
):
6783 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6784 self
.__class
__ = IdleEvent
6785 _core_
.IdleEvent_swigregister(IdleEventPtr
)
6787 def IdleEvent_SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6789 IdleEvent_SetMode(int mode)
6791 Static method for specifying how wxWidgets will send idle events: to
6792 all windows, or only to those which specify that they will process the
6795 The mode can be one of the following values:
6797 ========================= ========================================
6798 wx.IDLE_PROCESS_ALL Send idle events to all windows
6799 wx.IDLE_PROCESS_SPECIFIED Send idle events only to windows that have
6800 the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE extra style
6802 ========================= ========================================
6805 return _core_
.IdleEvent_SetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6807 def IdleEvent_GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
6809 IdleEvent_GetMode() -> int
6811 Static method returning a value specifying how wxWidgets will send
6812 idle events: to all windows, or only to those which specify that they
6813 will process the events.
6815 return _core_
.IdleEvent_GetMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
6817 def IdleEvent_CanSend(*args
, **kwargs
):
6819 IdleEvent_CanSend(Window win) -> bool
6821 Returns ``True`` if it is appropriate to send idle events to this
6824 This function looks at the mode used (see `wx.IdleEvent.SetMode`), and
6825 the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE style in window to determine whether idle
6826 events should be sent to this window now. By default this will always
6827 return ``True`` because the update mode is initially
6828 wx.IDLE_PROCESS_ALL. You can change the mode to only send idle events
6829 to windows with the wx.WS_EX_PROCESS_IDLE extra window style set.
6831 return _core_
.IdleEvent_CanSend(*args
, **kwargs
)
6833 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6835 class PyEvent(Event
):
6837 wx.PyEvent can be used as a base class for implementing custom event
6838 types in Python. You should derived from this class instead of
6839 `wx.Event` because this class is Python-aware and is able to transport
6840 its Python bits safely through the wxWidgets event system and have
6841 them still be there when the event handler is invoked.
6843 :see: `wx.PyCommandEvent`
6847 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPyEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6848 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6849 """__init__(self, int winid=0, wxEventType eventType=wxEVT_NULL) -> PyEvent"""
6850 newobj
= _core_
.new_PyEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6851 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6856 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_PyEvent
):
6859 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
6862 def _SetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
):
6863 """_SetSelf(self, PyObject self)"""
6864 return _core_
.PyEvent__SetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
)
6866 def _GetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
):
6867 """_GetSelf(self) -> PyObject"""
6868 return _core_
.PyEvent__GetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
)
6871 class PyEventPtr(PyEvent
):
6872 def __init__(self
, this
):
6874 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6875 self
.__class
__ = PyEvent
6876 _core_
.PyEvent_swigregister(PyEventPtr
)
6878 class PyCommandEvent(CommandEvent
):
6880 wx.PyCommandEvent can be used as a base class for implementing custom
6881 event types in Python, where the event shoudl travel up to parent
6882 windows looking for a handler. You should derived from this class
6883 instead of `wx.CommandEvent` because this class is Python-aware and is
6884 able to transport its Python bits safely through the wxWidgets event
6885 system and have them still be there when the event handler is invoked.
6891 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPyCommandEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6892 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6893 """__init__(self, wxEventType eventType=wxEVT_NULL, int id=0) -> PyCommandEvent"""
6894 newobj
= _core_
.new_PyCommandEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6895 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6900 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_PyCommandEvent
):
6903 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
6906 def _SetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
):
6907 """_SetSelf(self, PyObject self)"""
6908 return _core_
.PyCommandEvent__SetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
)
6910 def _GetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
):
6911 """_GetSelf(self) -> PyObject"""
6912 return _core_
.PyCommandEvent__GetSelf(*args
, **kwargs
)
6915 class PyCommandEventPtr(PyCommandEvent
):
6916 def __init__(self
, this
):
6918 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6919 self
.__class
__ = PyCommandEvent
6920 _core_
.PyCommandEvent_swigregister(PyCommandEventPtr
)
6922 class DateEvent(CommandEvent
):
6924 This event class holds information about a date change event and is
6925 used together with `wx.DatePickerCtrl`. It also serves as a base class
6926 for `wx.calendar.CalendarEvent`. Bind these event types with
6930 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxDateEvent instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6931 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6932 """__init__(self, Window win, DateTime dt, wxEventType type) -> DateEvent"""
6933 newobj
= _core_
.new_DateEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
6934 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6937 def GetDate(*args
, **kwargs
):
6939 GetDate(self) -> DateTime
6943 return _core_
.DateEvent_GetDate(*args
, **kwargs
)
6945 def SetDate(*args
, **kwargs
):
6947 SetDate(self, DateTime date)
6949 Sets the date carried by the event, normally only used by the library
6952 return _core_
.DateEvent_SetDate(*args
, **kwargs
)
6955 class DateEventPtr(DateEvent
):
6956 def __init__(self
, this
):
6958 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
6959 self
.__class
__ = DateEvent
6960 _core_
.DateEvent_swigregister(DateEventPtr
)
6962 wxEVT_DATE_CHANGED
= _core_
.wxEVT_DATE_CHANGED
6963 EVT_DATE_CHANGED
= wx
.PyEventBinder( wxEVT_DATE_CHANGED
, 1 )
6965 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
6967 PYAPP_ASSERT_SUPPRESS
= _core_
.PYAPP_ASSERT_SUPPRESS
6968 PYAPP_ASSERT_EXCEPTION
= _core_
.PYAPP_ASSERT_EXCEPTION
6969 PYAPP_ASSERT_DIALOG
= _core_
.PYAPP_ASSERT_DIALOG
6970 PYAPP_ASSERT_LOG
= _core_
.PYAPP_ASSERT_LOG
6971 PRINT_WINDOWS
= _core_
.PRINT_WINDOWS
6972 PRINT_POSTSCRIPT
= _core_
.PRINT_POSTSCRIPT
6973 class PyApp(EvtHandler
):
6975 The ``wx.PyApp`` class is an *implementation detail*, please use the
6976 `wx.App` class (or some other derived class) instead.
6979 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPyApp instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
6980 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
6982 __init__(self) -> PyApp
6984 Create a new application object, starting the bootstrap process.
6986 newobj
= _core_
.new_PyApp(*args
, **kwargs
)
6987 self
.this
= newobj
.this
6990 self
._setCallbackInfo
(self
, PyApp
, False)
6991 self
._setOORInfo
(self
, False)
6993 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_PyApp
):
6996 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
6999 def _setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
):
7000 """_setCallbackInfo(self, PyObject self, PyObject _class, bool incref)"""
7001 return _core_
.PyApp__setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
)
7003 def GetAppName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7005 GetAppName(self) -> String
7007 Get the application name.
7009 return _core_
.PyApp_GetAppName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7011 def SetAppName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7013 SetAppName(self, String name)
7015 Set the application name. This value may be used automatically by
7016 `wx.Config` and such.
7018 return _core_
.PyApp_SetAppName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7020 def GetClassName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7022 GetClassName(self) -> String
7024 Get the application's class name.
7026 return _core_
.PyApp_GetClassName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7028 def SetClassName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7030 SetClassName(self, String name)
7032 Set the application's class name. This value may be used for
7033 X-resources if applicable for the platform
7035 return _core_
.PyApp_SetClassName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7037 def GetVendorName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7039 GetVendorName(self) -> String
7041 Get the application's vendor name.
7043 return _core_
.PyApp_GetVendorName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7045 def SetVendorName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7047 SetVendorName(self, String name)
7049 Set the application's vendor name. This value may be used
7050 automatically by `wx.Config` and such.
7052 return _core_
.PyApp_SetVendorName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7054 def GetTraits(*args
, **kwargs
):
7056 GetTraits(self) -> wxAppTraits
7058 Return (and create if necessary) the app traits object to which we
7059 delegate for everything which either should be configurable by the
7060 user (then he can change the default behaviour simply by overriding
7061 CreateTraits() and returning his own traits object) or which is
7062 GUI/console dependent as then wx.AppTraits allows us to abstract the
7063 differences behind the common facade.
7065 :todo: Add support for overriding CreateAppTraits in wxPython.
7067 return _core_
.PyApp_GetTraits(*args
, **kwargs
)
7069 def ProcessPendingEvents(*args
, **kwargs
):
7071 ProcessPendingEvents(self)
7073 Process all events in the Pending Events list -- it is necessary to
7074 call this function to process posted events. This normally happens
7075 during each event loop iteration.
7077 return _core_
.PyApp_ProcessPendingEvents(*args
, **kwargs
)
7079 def Yield(*args
, **kwargs
):
7081 Yield(self, bool onlyIfNeeded=False) -> bool
7083 Process all currently pending events right now, instead of waiting
7084 until return to the event loop. It is an error to call ``Yield``
7085 recursively unless the value of ``onlyIfNeeded`` is True.
7087 :warning: This function is dangerous as it can lead to unexpected
7088 reentrancies (i.e. when called from an event handler it may
7089 result in calling the same event handler again), use with
7090 extreme care or, better, don't use at all!
7092 :see: `wx.Yield`, `wx.YieldIfNeeded`, `wx.SafeYield`
7095 return _core_
.PyApp_Yield(*args
, **kwargs
)
7097 def WakeUpIdle(*args
, **kwargs
):
7101 Make sure that idle events are sent again.
7102 :see: `wx.WakeUpIdle`
7104 return _core_
.PyApp_WakeUpIdle(*args
, **kwargs
)
7106 def IsMainLoopRunning(*args
, **kwargs
):
7108 IsMainLoopRunning() -> bool
7110 Returns True if we're running the main loop, i.e. if the events can
7111 currently be dispatched.
7113 return _core_
.PyApp_IsMainLoopRunning(*args
, **kwargs
)
7115 IsMainLoopRunning
= staticmethod(IsMainLoopRunning
)
7116 def MainLoop(*args
, **kwargs
):
7118 MainLoop(self) -> int
7120 Execute the main GUI loop, the function doesn't normally return until
7121 all top level windows have been closed and destroyed.
7123 return _core_
.PyApp_MainLoop(*args
, **kwargs
)
7125 def Exit(*args
, **kwargs
):
7129 Exit the main loop thus terminating the application.
7132 return _core_
.PyApp_Exit(*args
, **kwargs
)
7134 def ExitMainLoop(*args
, **kwargs
):
7138 Exit the main GUI loop during the next iteration of the main
7139 loop, (i.e. it does not stop the program immediately!)
7141 return _core_
.PyApp_ExitMainLoop(*args
, **kwargs
)
7143 def Pending(*args
, **kwargs
):
7145 Pending(self) -> bool
7147 Returns True if there are unprocessed events in the event queue.
7149 return _core_
.PyApp_Pending(*args
, **kwargs
)
7151 def Dispatch(*args
, **kwargs
):
7153 Dispatch(self) -> bool
7155 Process the first event in the event queue (blocks until an event
7156 appears if there are none currently)
7158 return _core_
.PyApp_Dispatch(*args
, **kwargs
)
7160 def ProcessIdle(*args
, **kwargs
):
7162 ProcessIdle(self) -> bool
7164 Called from the MainLoop when the application becomes idle (there are
7165 no pending events) and sends a `wx.IdleEvent` to all interested
7166 parties. Returns True if more idle events are needed, False if not.
7168 return _core_
.PyApp_ProcessIdle(*args
, **kwargs
)
7170 def SendIdleEvents(*args
, **kwargs
):
7172 SendIdleEvents(self, Window win, IdleEvent event) -> bool
7174 Send idle event to window and all subwindows. Returns True if more
7175 idle time is requested.
7177 return _core_
.PyApp_SendIdleEvents(*args
, **kwargs
)
7179 def IsActive(*args
, **kwargs
):
7181 IsActive(self) -> bool
7183 Return True if our app has focus.
7185 return _core_
.PyApp_IsActive(*args
, **kwargs
)
7187 def SetTopWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
7189 SetTopWindow(self, Window win)
7191 Set the *main* top level window
7193 return _core_
.PyApp_SetTopWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
7195 def GetTopWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
7197 GetTopWindow(self) -> Window
7199 Return the *main* top level window (if it hadn't been set previously
7200 with SetTopWindow(), will return just some top level window and, if
7201 there not any, will return None)
7203 return _core_
.PyApp_GetTopWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
7205 def SetExitOnFrameDelete(*args
, **kwargs
):
7207 SetExitOnFrameDelete(self, bool flag)
7209 Control the exit behaviour: by default, the program will exit the main
7210 loop (and so, usually, terminate) when the last top-level program
7211 window is deleted. Beware that if you disable this behaviour (with
7212 SetExitOnFrameDelete(False)), you'll have to call ExitMainLoop()
7213 explicitly from somewhere.
7215 return _core_
.PyApp_SetExitOnFrameDelete(*args
, **kwargs
)
7217 def GetExitOnFrameDelete(*args
, **kwargs
):
7219 GetExitOnFrameDelete(self) -> bool
7221 Get the current exit behaviour setting.
7223 return _core_
.PyApp_GetExitOnFrameDelete(*args
, **kwargs
)
7225 def SetUseBestVisual(*args
, **kwargs
):
7227 SetUseBestVisual(self, bool flag)
7229 Set whether the app should try to use the best available visual on
7230 systems where more than one is available, (Sun, SGI, XFree86 4, etc.)
7232 return _core_
.PyApp_SetUseBestVisual(*args
, **kwargs
)
7234 def GetUseBestVisual(*args
, **kwargs
):
7236 GetUseBestVisual(self) -> bool
7238 Get current UseBestVisual setting.
7240 return _core_
.PyApp_GetUseBestVisual(*args
, **kwargs
)
7242 def SetPrintMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
7243 """SetPrintMode(self, int mode)"""
7244 return _core_
.PyApp_SetPrintMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
7246 def GetPrintMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
7247 """GetPrintMode(self) -> int"""
7248 return _core_
.PyApp_GetPrintMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
7250 def SetAssertMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
7252 SetAssertMode(self, int mode)
7254 Set the OnAssert behaviour for debug and hybrid builds.
7256 return _core_
.PyApp_SetAssertMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
7258 def GetAssertMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
7260 GetAssertMode(self) -> int
7262 Get the current OnAssert behaviour setting.
7264 return _core_
.PyApp_GetAssertMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
7266 def GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
):
7267 """GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts() -> bool"""
7268 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
)
7270 GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
= staticmethod(GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
)
7271 def GetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7272 """GetMacAboutMenuItemId() -> long"""
7273 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7275 GetMacAboutMenuItemId
= staticmethod(GetMacAboutMenuItemId
)
7276 def GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7277 """GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId() -> long"""
7278 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7280 GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
= staticmethod(GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
)
7281 def GetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7282 """GetMacExitMenuItemId() -> long"""
7283 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7285 GetMacExitMenuItemId
= staticmethod(GetMacExitMenuItemId
)
7286 def GetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7287 """GetMacHelpMenuTitleName() -> String"""
7288 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7290 GetMacHelpMenuTitleName
= staticmethod(GetMacHelpMenuTitleName
)
7291 def SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
):
7292 """SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(bool val)"""
7293 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
)
7295 SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
= staticmethod(SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
)
7296 def SetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7297 """SetMacAboutMenuItemId(long val)"""
7298 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7300 SetMacAboutMenuItemId
= staticmethod(SetMacAboutMenuItemId
)
7301 def SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7302 """SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(long val)"""
7303 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7305 SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
= staticmethod(SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
)
7306 def SetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7307 """SetMacExitMenuItemId(long val)"""
7308 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7310 SetMacExitMenuItemId
= staticmethod(SetMacExitMenuItemId
)
7311 def SetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7312 """SetMacHelpMenuTitleName(String val)"""
7313 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7315 SetMacHelpMenuTitleName
= staticmethod(SetMacHelpMenuTitleName
)
7316 def _BootstrapApp(*args
, **kwargs
):
7320 For internal use only
7322 return _core_
.PyApp__BootstrapApp(*args
, **kwargs
)
7324 def GetComCtl32Version(*args
, **kwargs
):
7326 GetComCtl32Version() -> int
7328 Returns 400, 470, 471, etc. for comctl32.dll 4.00, 4.70, 4.71 or 0 if
7329 it wasn't found at all. Raises an exception on non-Windows platforms.
7331 return _core_
.PyApp_GetComCtl32Version(*args
, **kwargs
)
7333 GetComCtl32Version
= staticmethod(GetComCtl32Version
)
7335 class PyAppPtr(PyApp
):
7336 def __init__(self
, this
):
7338 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
7339 self
.__class
__ = PyApp
7340 _core_
.PyApp_swigregister(PyAppPtr
)
7342 def PyApp_IsMainLoopRunning(*args
, **kwargs
):
7344 PyApp_IsMainLoopRunning() -> bool
7346 Returns True if we're running the main loop, i.e. if the events can
7347 currently be dispatched.
7349 return _core_
.PyApp_IsMainLoopRunning(*args
, **kwargs
)
7351 def PyApp_GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
):
7352 """PyApp_GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts() -> bool"""
7353 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
)
7355 def PyApp_GetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7356 """PyApp_GetMacAboutMenuItemId() -> long"""
7357 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7359 def PyApp_GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7360 """PyApp_GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId() -> long"""
7361 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7363 def PyApp_GetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7364 """PyApp_GetMacExitMenuItemId() -> long"""
7365 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7367 def PyApp_GetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7368 """PyApp_GetMacHelpMenuTitleName() -> String"""
7369 return _core_
.PyApp_GetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7371 def PyApp_SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
):
7372 """PyApp_SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(bool val)"""
7373 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts(*args
, **kwargs
)
7375 def PyApp_SetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7376 """PyApp_SetMacAboutMenuItemId(long val)"""
7377 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacAboutMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7379 def PyApp_SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7380 """PyApp_SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(long val)"""
7381 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7383 def PyApp_SetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
):
7384 """PyApp_SetMacExitMenuItemId(long val)"""
7385 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacExitMenuItemId(*args
, **kwargs
)
7387 def PyApp_SetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
):
7388 """PyApp_SetMacHelpMenuTitleName(String val)"""
7389 return _core_
.PyApp_SetMacHelpMenuTitleName(*args
, **kwargs
)
7391 def PyApp_GetComCtl32Version(*args
, **kwargs
):
7393 PyApp_GetComCtl32Version() -> int
7395 Returns 400, 470, 471, etc. for comctl32.dll 4.00, 4.70, 4.71 or 0 if
7396 it wasn't found at all. Raises an exception on non-Windows platforms.
7398 return _core_
.PyApp_GetComCtl32Version(*args
, **kwargs
)
7400 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
7403 def Exit(*args
, **kwargs
):
7407 Force an exit of the application. Convenience for wx.GetApp().Exit()
7409 return _core_
.Exit(*args
, **kwargs
)
7411 def Yield(*args
, **kwargs
):
7415 Yield to other apps/messages. Convenience for wx.GetApp().Yield()
7417 return _core_
.Yield(*args
, **kwargs
)
7419 def YieldIfNeeded(*args
, **kwargs
):
7421 YieldIfNeeded() -> bool
7423 Yield to other apps/messages. Convenience for wx.GetApp().Yield(True)
7425 return _core_
.YieldIfNeeded(*args
, **kwargs
)
7427 def SafeYield(*args
, **kwargs
):
7429 SafeYield(Window win=None, bool onlyIfNeeded=False) -> bool
7431 This function is similar to `wx.Yield`, except that it disables the
7432 user input to all program windows before calling `wx.Yield` and
7433 re-enables it again afterwards. If ``win`` is not None, this window
7434 will remain enabled, allowing the implementation of some limited user
7437 :Returns: the result of the call to `wx.Yield`.
7439 return _core_
.SafeYield(*args
, **kwargs
)
7441 def WakeUpIdle(*args
, **kwargs
):
7445 Cause the message queue to become empty again, so idle events will be
7448 return _core_
.WakeUpIdle(*args
, **kwargs
)
7450 def PostEvent(*args
, **kwargs
):
7452 PostEvent(EvtHandler dest, Event event)
7454 Send an event to a window or other wx.EvtHandler to be processed
7457 return _core_
.PostEvent(*args
, **kwargs
)
7459 def App_CleanUp(*args
, **kwargs
):
7463 For internal use only, it is used to cleanup after wxWidgets when
7466 return _core_
.App_CleanUp(*args
, **kwargs
)
7468 def GetApp(*args
, **kwargs
):
7472 Return a reference to the current wx.App object.
7474 return _core_
.GetApp(*args
, **kwargs
)
7476 def SetDefaultPyEncoding(*args
, **kwargs
):
7478 SetDefaultPyEncoding(string encoding)
7480 Sets the encoding that wxPython will use when it needs to convert a
7481 Python string or unicode object to or from a wxString.
7483 The default encoding is the value of ``locale.getdefaultlocale()[1]``
7484 but please be aware that the default encoding within the same locale
7485 may be slightly different on different platforms. For example, please
7486 see http://www.alanwood.net/demos/charsetdiffs.html for differences
7487 between the common latin/roman encodings.
7489 return _core_
.SetDefaultPyEncoding(*args
, **kwargs
)
7491 def GetDefaultPyEncoding(*args
, **kwargs
):
7493 GetDefaultPyEncoding() -> string
7495 Gets the current encoding that wxPython will use when it needs to
7496 convert a Python string or unicode object to or from a wxString.
7498 return _core_
.GetDefaultPyEncoding(*args
, **kwargs
)
7499 #----------------------------------------------------------------------
7501 class PyOnDemandOutputWindow
:
7503 A class that can be used for redirecting Python's stdout and
7504 stderr streams. It will do nothing until something is wrriten to
7505 the stream at which point it will create a Frame with a text area
7506 and write the text there.
7508 def __init__(self
, title
= "wxPython: stdout/stderr"):
7511 self
.pos
= wx
.DefaultPosition
7512 self
.size
= (450, 300)
7515 def SetParent(self
, parent
):
7516 """Set the window to be used as the popup Frame's parent."""
7517 self
.parent
= parent
7520 def CreateOutputWindow(self
, st
):
7521 self
.frame
= wx
.Frame(self
.parent
, -1, self
.title
, self
.pos
, self
.size
,
7522 style
=wx
.DEFAULT_FRAME_STYLE
)
7523 self
.text
= wx
.TextCtrl(self
.frame
, -1, "",
7524 style
=wx
.TE_MULTILINE|wx
.TE_READONLY
)
7525 self
.text
.AppendText(st
)
7526 self
.frame
.Show(True)
7527 EVT_CLOSE(self
.frame
, self
.OnCloseWindow
)
7530 def OnCloseWindow(self
, event
):
7531 if self
.frame
is not None:
7532 self
.frame
.Destroy()
7537 # These methods provide the file-like output behaviour.
7538 def write(self
, text
):
7540 Create the output window if needed and write the string to it.
7541 If not called in the context of the gui thread then uses
7542 CallAfter to do the work there.
7544 if self
.frame
is None:
7545 if not wx
.Thread_IsMain():
7546 wx
.CallAfter(self
.CreateOutputWindow
, text
)
7548 self
.CreateOutputWindow(text
)
7550 if not wx
.Thread_IsMain():
7551 wx
.CallAfter(self
.text
.AppendText
, text
)
7553 self
.text
.AppendText(text
)
7557 if self
.frame
is not None:
7558 wx
.CallAfter(self
.frame
.Close
)
7566 #----------------------------------------------------------------------
7568 _defRedirect
= (wx
.Platform
== '__WXMSW__' or wx
.Platform
== '__WXMAC__')
7570 class App(wx
.PyApp
):
7572 The ``wx.App`` class represents the application and is used to:
7574 * bootstrap the wxPython system and initialize the underlying
7576 * set and get application-wide properties
7577 * implement the windowing system main message or event loop,
7578 and to dispatch events to window instances
7581 Every application must have a ``wx.App`` instance, and all
7582 creation of UI objects should be delayed until after the
7583 ``wx.App`` object has been created in order to ensure that the gui
7584 platform and wxWidgets have been fully initialized.
7586 Normally you would derive from this class and implement an
7587 ``OnInit`` method that creates a frame and then calls
7588 ``self.SetTopWindow(frame)``.
7590 :see: `wx.PySimpleApp` for a simpler app class that can be used
7594 outputWindowClass
= PyOnDemandOutputWindow
7596 def __init__(self
, redirect
=_defRedirect
, filename
=None,
7597 useBestVisual
=False, clearSigInt
=True):
7599 Construct a ``wx.App`` object.
7601 :param redirect: Should ``sys.stdout`` and ``sys.stderr`` be
7602 redirected? Defaults to True on Windows and Mac, False
7603 otherwise. If `filename` is None then output will be
7604 redirected to a window that pops up as needed. (You can
7605 control what kind of window is created for the output by
7606 resetting the class variable ``outputWindowClass`` to a
7607 class of your choosing.)
7609 :param filename: The name of a file to redirect output to, if
7612 :param useBestVisual: Should the app try to use the best
7613 available visual provided by the system (only relevant on
7614 systems that have more than one visual.) This parameter
7615 must be used instead of calling `SetUseBestVisual` later
7616 on because it must be set before the underlying GUI
7617 toolkit is initialized.
7619 :param clearSigInt: Should SIGINT be cleared? This allows the
7620 app to terminate upon a Ctrl-C in the console like other
7623 :note: You should override OnInit to do applicaition
7624 initialization to ensure that the system, toolkit and
7625 wxWidgets are fully initialized.
7627 wx
.PyApp
.__init
__(self
)
7629 if wx
.Platform
== "__WXMAC__":
7632 if not MacOS
.WMAvailable():
7634 This program needs access to the screen. Please run with 'pythonw',
7635 not 'python', and only when you are logged in on the main display of
7643 # This has to be done before OnInit
7644 self
.SetUseBestVisual(useBestVisual
)
7646 # Set the default handler for SIGINT. This fixes a problem
7647 # where if Ctrl-C is pressed in the console that started this
7648 # app then it will not appear to do anything, (not even send
7649 # KeyboardInterrupt???) but will later segfault on exit. By
7650 # setting the default handler then the app will exit, as
7651 # expected (depending on platform.)
7655 signal
.signal(signal
.SIGINT
, signal
.SIG_DFL
)
7659 # Save and redirect the stdio to a window?
7660 self
.stdioWin
= None
7661 self
.saveStdio
= (_sys
.stdout
, _sys
.stderr
)
7663 self
.RedirectStdio(filename
)
7665 # Use Python's install prefix as the default
7666 wx
.StandardPaths
.Get().SetInstallPrefix(_sys
.prefix
)
7668 # This finishes the initialization of wxWindows and then calls
7669 # the OnInit that should be present in the derived class
7670 self
._BootstrapApp
()
7673 def __del__(self
, destroy
=wx
.PyApp
.__del
__):
7674 self
.RestoreStdio() # Just in case the MainLoop was overridden
7678 wx
.PyApp
.Destroy(self
)
7681 def SetTopWindow(self
, frame
):
7682 """Set the \"main\" top level window"""
7684 self
.stdioWin
.SetParent(frame
)
7685 wx
.PyApp
.SetTopWindow(self
, frame
)
7689 """Execute the main GUI event loop"""
7690 wx
.PyApp
.MainLoop(self
)
7694 def RedirectStdio(self
, filename
=None):
7695 """Redirect sys.stdout and sys.stderr to a file or a popup window."""
7697 _sys
.stdout
= _sys
.stderr
= open(filename
, 'a')
7699 self
.stdioWin
= self
.outputWindowClass()
7700 _sys
.stdout
= _sys
.stderr
= self
.stdioWin
7703 def RestoreStdio(self
):
7705 _sys
.stdout
, _sys
.stderr
= self
.saveStdio
7710 def SetOutputWindowAttributes(self
, title
=None, pos
=None, size
=None):
7712 Set the title, position and/or size of the output window if
7713 the stdio has been redirected. This should be called before
7714 any output would cause the output window to be created.
7717 if title
is not None:
7718 self
.stdioWin
.title
= title
7720 self
.stdioWin
.pos
= pos
7721 if size
is not None:
7722 self
.stdioWin
.size
= size
7727 # change from wx.PyApp_XX to wx.App_XX
7728 App_GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
= _core_
.PyApp_GetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
7729 App_GetMacAboutMenuItemId
= _core_
.PyApp_GetMacAboutMenuItemId
7730 App_GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
= _core_
.PyApp_GetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
7731 App_GetMacExitMenuItemId
= _core_
.PyApp_GetMacExitMenuItemId
7732 App_GetMacHelpMenuTitleName
= _core_
.PyApp_GetMacHelpMenuTitleName
7733 App_SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
= _core_
.PyApp_SetMacSupportPCMenuShortcuts
7734 App_SetMacAboutMenuItemId
= _core_
.PyApp_SetMacAboutMenuItemId
7735 App_SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
= _core_
.PyApp_SetMacPreferencesMenuItemId
7736 App_SetMacExitMenuItemId
= _core_
.PyApp_SetMacExitMenuItemId
7737 App_SetMacHelpMenuTitleName
= _core_
.PyApp_SetMacHelpMenuTitleName
7738 App_GetComCtl32Version
= _core_
.PyApp_GetComCtl32Version
7740 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
7742 class PySimpleApp(wx
.App
):
7744 A simple application class. You can just create one of these and
7745 then then make your top level windows later, and not have to worry
7746 about OnInit. For example::
7748 app = wx.PySimpleApp()
7749 frame = wx.Frame(None, title='Hello World')
7756 def __init__(self
, redirect
=False, filename
=None,
7757 useBestVisual
=False, clearSigInt
=True):
7759 :see: `wx.App.__init__`
7761 wx
.App
.__init
__(self
, redirect
, filename
, useBestVisual
, clearSigInt
)
7768 # Is anybody using this one?
7769 class PyWidgetTester(wx
.App
):
7770 def __init__(self
, size
= (250, 100)):
7772 wx
.App
.__init
__(self
, 0)
7775 self
.frame
= wx
.Frame(None, -1, "Widget Tester", pos
=(0,0), size
=self
.size
)
7776 self
.SetTopWindow(self
.frame
)
7779 def SetWidget(self
, widgetClass
, *args
, **kwargs
):
7780 w
= widgetClass(self
.frame
, *args
, **kwargs
)
7781 self
.frame
.Show(True)
7783 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
7784 # DO NOT hold any other references to this object. This is how we
7785 # know when to cleanup system resources that wxWidgets is holding. When
7786 # the sys module is unloaded, the refcount on sys.__wxPythonCleanup
7787 # goes to zero and it calls the wx.App_CleanUp function.
7789 class __wxPyCleanup
:
7791 self
.cleanup
= _core_
.App_CleanUp
7795 _sys
.__wxPythonCleanup
= __wxPyCleanup()
7797 ## # another possible solution, but it gets called too early...
7799 ## atexit.register(_core_.wxApp_CleanUp)
7802 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
7804 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
7806 class EventLoop(object):
7807 """Proxy of C++ EventLoop class"""
7809 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxEventLoop instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
7810 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
7811 """__init__(self) -> EventLoop"""
7812 newobj
= _core_
.new_EventLoop(*args
, **kwargs
)
7813 self
.this
= newobj
.this
7816 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_EventLoop
):
7819 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
7822 def Run(*args
, **kwargs
):
7823 """Run(self) -> int"""
7824 return _core_
.EventLoop_Run(*args
, **kwargs
)
7826 def Exit(*args
, **kwargs
):
7827 """Exit(self, int rc=0)"""
7828 return _core_
.EventLoop_Exit(*args
, **kwargs
)
7830 def Pending(*args
, **kwargs
):
7831 """Pending(self) -> bool"""
7832 return _core_
.EventLoop_Pending(*args
, **kwargs
)
7834 def Dispatch(*args
, **kwargs
):
7835 """Dispatch(self) -> bool"""
7836 return _core_
.EventLoop_Dispatch(*args
, **kwargs
)
7838 def IsRunning(*args
, **kwargs
):
7839 """IsRunning(self) -> bool"""
7840 return _core_
.EventLoop_IsRunning(*args
, **kwargs
)
7842 def GetActive(*args
, **kwargs
):
7843 """GetActive() -> EventLoop"""
7844 return _core_
.EventLoop_GetActive(*args
, **kwargs
)
7846 GetActive
= staticmethod(GetActive
)
7847 def SetActive(*args
, **kwargs
):
7848 """SetActive(EventLoop loop)"""
7849 return _core_
.EventLoop_SetActive(*args
, **kwargs
)
7851 SetActive
= staticmethod(SetActive
)
7853 class EventLoopPtr(EventLoop
):
7854 def __init__(self
, this
):
7856 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
7857 self
.__class
__ = EventLoop
7858 _core_
.EventLoop_swigregister(EventLoopPtr
)
7860 def EventLoop_GetActive(*args
, **kwargs
):
7861 """EventLoop_GetActive() -> EventLoop"""
7862 return _core_
.EventLoop_GetActive(*args
, **kwargs
)
7864 def EventLoop_SetActive(*args
, **kwargs
):
7865 """EventLoop_SetActive(EventLoop loop)"""
7866 return _core_
.EventLoop_SetActive(*args
, **kwargs
)
7868 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
7870 class AcceleratorEntry(object):
7872 A class used to define items in an `wx.AcceleratorTable`. wxPython
7873 programs can choose to use wx.AcceleratorEntry objects, but using a
7874 list of 3-tuple of integers (flags, keyCode, cmdID) usually works just
7875 as well. See `__init__` for of the tuple values.
7877 :see: `wx.AcceleratorTable`
7880 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxAcceleratorEntry instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
7881 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
7883 __init__(self, int flags=0, int keyCode=0, int cmdID=0) -> AcceleratorEntry
7885 Construct a wx.AcceleratorEntry.
7887 newobj
= _core_
.new_AcceleratorEntry(*args
, **kwargs
)
7888 self
.this
= newobj
.this
7891 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_AcceleratorEntry
):
7894 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
7897 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
7899 Set(self, int flags, int keyCode, int cmd)
7901 (Re)set the attributes of a wx.AcceleratorEntry.
7904 return _core_
.AcceleratorEntry_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
7906 def GetFlags(*args
, **kwargs
):
7908 GetFlags(self) -> int
7910 Get the AcceleratorEntry's flags.
7912 return _core_
.AcceleratorEntry_GetFlags(*args
, **kwargs
)
7914 def GetKeyCode(*args
, **kwargs
):
7916 GetKeyCode(self) -> int
7918 Get the AcceleratorEntry's keycode.
7920 return _core_
.AcceleratorEntry_GetKeyCode(*args
, **kwargs
)
7922 def GetCommand(*args
, **kwargs
):
7924 GetCommand(self) -> int
7926 Get the AcceleratorEntry's command ID.
7928 return _core_
.AcceleratorEntry_GetCommand(*args
, **kwargs
)
7931 class AcceleratorEntryPtr(AcceleratorEntry
):
7932 def __init__(self
, this
):
7934 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
7935 self
.__class
__ = AcceleratorEntry
7936 _core_
.AcceleratorEntry_swigregister(AcceleratorEntryPtr
)
7938 class AcceleratorTable(Object
):
7940 An accelerator table allows the application to specify a table of
7941 keyboard shortcuts for menus or other commands. On Windows, menu or
7942 button commands are supported; on GTK, only menu commands are
7946 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxAcceleratorTable instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
7947 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
7949 __init__(entries) -> AcceleratorTable
7951 Construct an AcceleratorTable from a list of `wx.AcceleratorEntry`
7952 items or or of 3-tuples (flags, keyCode, cmdID)
7954 :see: `wx.AcceleratorEntry`
7956 newobj
= _core_
.new_AcceleratorTable(*args
, **kwargs
)
7957 self
.this
= newobj
.this
7960 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_AcceleratorTable
):
7963 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
7966 def Ok(*args
, **kwargs
):
7967 """Ok(self) -> bool"""
7968 return _core_
.AcceleratorTable_Ok(*args
, **kwargs
)
7971 class AcceleratorTablePtr(AcceleratorTable
):
7972 def __init__(self
, this
):
7974 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
7975 self
.__class
__ = AcceleratorTable
7976 _core_
.AcceleratorTable_swigregister(AcceleratorTablePtr
)
7979 def GetAccelFromString(*args
, **kwargs
):
7980 """GetAccelFromString(String label) -> AcceleratorEntry"""
7981 return _core_
.GetAccelFromString(*args
, **kwargs
)
7982 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
7984 class VisualAttributes(object):
7985 """struct containing all the visual attributes of a control"""
7987 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxVisualAttributes instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
7988 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
7990 __init__(self) -> VisualAttributes
7992 struct containing all the visual attributes of a control
7994 newobj
= _core_
.new_VisualAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
)
7995 self
.this
= newobj
.this
7998 def __del__(self
, destroy
=_core_
.delete_VisualAttributes
):
8001 if self
.thisown
: destroy(self
)
8004 font
= property(_core_
.VisualAttributes_font_get
, _core_
.VisualAttributes_font_set
)
8005 colFg
= property(_core_
.VisualAttributes_colFg_get
, _core_
.VisualAttributes_colFg_set
)
8006 colBg
= property(_core_
.VisualAttributes_colBg_get
, _core_
.VisualAttributes_colBg_set
)
8008 class VisualAttributesPtr(VisualAttributes
):
8009 def __init__(self
, this
):
8011 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
8012 self
.__class
__ = VisualAttributes
8013 _core_
.VisualAttributes_swigregister(VisualAttributesPtr
)
8014 NullAcceleratorTable
= cvar
.NullAcceleratorTable
8015 PanelNameStr
= cvar
.PanelNameStr
8017 WINDOW_VARIANT_NORMAL
= _core_
.WINDOW_VARIANT_NORMAL
8018 WINDOW_VARIANT_SMALL
= _core_
.WINDOW_VARIANT_SMALL
8019 WINDOW_VARIANT_MINI
= _core_
.WINDOW_VARIANT_MINI
8020 WINDOW_VARIANT_LARGE
= _core_
.WINDOW_VARIANT_LARGE
8021 WINDOW_VARIANT_MAX
= _core_
.WINDOW_VARIANT_MAX
8022 class Window(EvtHandler
):
8024 wx.Window is the base class for all windows and represents any visible
8025 object on the screen. All controls, top level windows and so on are
8026 wx.Windows. Sizers and device contexts are not however, as they don't
8027 appear on screen themselves.
8031 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxWindow instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
8032 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
8034 __init__(self, Window parent, int id=-1, Point pos=DefaultPosition,
8035 Size size=DefaultSize, long style=0, String name=PanelNameStr) -> Window
8037 Construct and show a generic Window.
8039 newobj
= _core_
.new_Window(*args
, **kwargs
)
8040 self
.this
= newobj
.this
8043 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
8045 def Create(*args
, **kwargs
):
8047 Create(self, Window parent, int id=-1, Point pos=DefaultPosition,
8048 Size size=DefaultSize, long style=0, String name=PanelNameStr) -> bool
8050 Create the GUI part of the Window for 2-phase creation mode.
8052 return _core_
.Window_Create(*args
, **kwargs
)
8054 def Close(*args
, **kwargs
):
8056 Close(self, bool force=False) -> bool
8058 This function simply generates a EVT_CLOSE event whose handler usually
8059 tries to close the window. It doesn't close the window itself,
8060 however. If force is False (the default) then the window's close
8061 handler will be allowed to veto the destruction of the window.
8063 return _core_
.Window_Close(*args
, **kwargs
)
8065 def Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
):
8067 Destroy(self) -> bool
8069 Destroys the window safely. Frames and dialogs are not destroyed
8070 immediately when this function is called -- they are added to a list
8071 of windows to be deleted on idle time, when all the window's events
8072 have been processed. This prevents problems with events being sent to
8073 non-existent windows.
8075 Returns True if the window has either been successfully deleted, or it
8076 has been added to the list of windows pending real deletion.
8078 return _core_
.Window_Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
)
8080 def DestroyChildren(*args
, **kwargs
):
8082 DestroyChildren(self) -> bool
8084 Destroys all children of a window. Called automatically by the
8087 return _core_
.Window_DestroyChildren(*args
, **kwargs
)
8089 def IsBeingDeleted(*args
, **kwargs
):
8091 IsBeingDeleted(self) -> bool
8093 Is the window in the process of being deleted?
8095 return _core_
.Window_IsBeingDeleted(*args
, **kwargs
)
8097 def SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
8099 SetLabel(self, String label)
8101 Set the text which the window shows in its label if applicable.
8103 return _core_
.Window_SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
8105 def GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
8107 GetLabel(self) -> String
8109 Generic way of getting a label from any window, for identification
8110 purposes. The interpretation of this function differs from class to
8111 class. For frames and dialogs, the value returned is the title. For
8112 buttons or static text controls, it is the button text. This function
8113 can be useful for meta-programs such as testing tools or special-needs
8114 access programs)which need to identify windows by name.
8116 return _core_
.Window_GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
8118 def SetName(*args
, **kwargs
):
8120 SetName(self, String name)
8122 Sets the window's name. The window name is used for ressource setting
8123 in X, it is not the same as the window title/label
8125 return _core_
.Window_SetName(*args
, **kwargs
)
8127 def GetName(*args
, **kwargs
):
8129 GetName(self) -> String
8131 Returns the windows name. This name is not guaranteed to be unique;
8132 it is up to the programmer to supply an appropriate name in the window
8133 constructor or via wx.Window.SetName.
8135 return _core_
.Window_GetName(*args
, **kwargs
)
8137 def SetWindowVariant(*args
, **kwargs
):
8139 SetWindowVariant(self, int variant)
8141 Sets the variant of the window/font size to use for this window, if
8142 the platform supports variants, for example, wxMac.
8144 return _core_
.Window_SetWindowVariant(*args
, **kwargs
)
8146 def GetWindowVariant(*args
, **kwargs
):
8147 """GetWindowVariant(self) -> int"""
8148 return _core_
.Window_GetWindowVariant(*args
, **kwargs
)
8150 def SetId(*args
, **kwargs
):
8152 SetId(self, int winid)
8154 Sets the identifier of the window. Each window has an integer
8155 identifier. If the application has not provided one, an identifier
8156 will be generated. Normally, the identifier should be provided on
8157 creation and should not be modified subsequently.
8159 return _core_
.Window_SetId(*args
, **kwargs
)
8161 def GetId(*args
, **kwargs
):
8165 Returns the identifier of the window. Each window has an integer
8166 identifier. If the application has not provided one (or the default Id
8167 -1 is used) then an unique identifier with a negative value will be
8170 return _core_
.Window_GetId(*args
, **kwargs
)
8172 def NewControlId(*args
, **kwargs
):
8174 NewControlId() -> int
8176 Generate a control id for the controls which were not given one.
8178 return _core_
.Window_NewControlId(*args
, **kwargs
)
8180 NewControlId
= staticmethod(NewControlId
)
8181 def NextControlId(*args
, **kwargs
):
8183 NextControlId(int winid) -> int
8185 Get the id of the control following the one with the given
8188 return _core_
.Window_NextControlId(*args
, **kwargs
)
8190 NextControlId
= staticmethod(NextControlId
)
8191 def PrevControlId(*args
, **kwargs
):
8193 PrevControlId(int winid) -> int
8195 Get the id of the control preceding the one with the given
8198 return _core_
.Window_PrevControlId(*args
, **kwargs
)
8200 PrevControlId
= staticmethod(PrevControlId
)
8201 def SetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8203 SetSize(self, Size size)
8205 Sets the size of the window in pixels.
8207 return _core_
.Window_SetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8209 def SetDimensions(*args
, **kwargs
):
8211 SetDimensions(self, int x, int y, int width, int height, int sizeFlags=SIZE_AUTO)
8213 Sets the position and size of the window in pixels. The sizeFlags
8214 parameter indicates the interpretation of the other params if they are
8217 ======================== ======================================
8218 wx.SIZE_AUTO A -1 indicates that a class-specific
8219 default should be used.
8220 wx.SIZE_USE_EXISTING Axisting dimensions should be used if
8221 -1 values are supplied.
8222 wxSIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE Allow dimensions of -1 and less to be
8223 interpreted as real dimensions, not
8225 ======================== ======================================
8228 return _core_
.Window_SetDimensions(*args
, **kwargs
)
8230 def SetRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
8232 SetRect(self, Rect rect, int sizeFlags=SIZE_AUTO)
8234 Sets the position and size of the window in pixels using a wx.Rect.
8236 return _core_
.Window_SetRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
8238 def SetSizeWH(*args
, **kwargs
):
8240 SetSizeWH(self, int width, int height)
8242 Sets the size of the window in pixels.
8244 return _core_
.Window_SetSizeWH(*args
, **kwargs
)
8246 def Move(*args
, **kwargs
):
8248 Move(self, Point pt, int flags=SIZE_USE_EXISTING)
8250 Moves the window to the given position.
8252 return _core_
.Window_Move(*args
, **kwargs
)
8255 def MoveXY(*args
, **kwargs
):
8257 MoveXY(self, int x, int y, int flags=SIZE_USE_EXISTING)
8259 Moves the window to the given position.
8261 return _core_
.Window_MoveXY(*args
, **kwargs
)
8263 def SetBestFittingSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8265 SetBestFittingSize(self, Size size=DefaultSize)
8267 A 'Smart' SetSize that will fill in default size components with the
8268 window's *best size* values. Also set's the minsize for use with sizers.
8270 return _core_
.Window_SetBestFittingSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8272 def Raise(*args
, **kwargs
):
8276 Raises the window to the top of the window hierarchy. In current
8277 version of wxWidgets this works both for manage and child windows.
8279 return _core_
.Window_Raise(*args
, **kwargs
)
8281 def Lower(*args
, **kwargs
):
8285 Lowers the window to the bottom of the window hierarchy. In current
8286 version of wxWidgets this works both for manage and child windows.
8288 return _core_
.Window_Lower(*args
, **kwargs
)
8290 def SetClientSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8292 SetClientSize(self, Size size)
8294 This sets the size of the window client area in pixels. Using this
8295 function to size a window tends to be more device-independent than
8296 wx.Window.SetSize, since the application need not worry about what
8297 dimensions the border or title bar have when trying to fit the window
8298 around panel items, for example.
8300 return _core_
.Window_SetClientSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8302 def SetClientSizeWH(*args
, **kwargs
):
8304 SetClientSizeWH(self, int width, int height)
8306 This sets the size of the window client area in pixels. Using this
8307 function to size a window tends to be more device-independent than
8308 wx.Window.SetSize, since the application need not worry about what
8309 dimensions the border or title bar have when trying to fit the window
8310 around panel items, for example.
8312 return _core_
.Window_SetClientSizeWH(*args
, **kwargs
)
8314 def SetClientRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
8316 SetClientRect(self, Rect rect)
8318 This sets the size of the window client area in pixels. Using this
8319 function to size a window tends to be more device-independent than
8320 wx.Window.SetSize, since the application need not worry about what
8321 dimensions the border or title bar have when trying to fit the window
8322 around panel items, for example.
8324 return _core_
.Window_SetClientRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
8326 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
8328 GetPosition(self) -> Point
8330 Get the window's position.
8332 return _core_
.Window_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
8334 def GetPositionTuple(*args
, **kwargs
):
8336 GetPositionTuple() -> (x,y)
8338 Get the window's position.
8340 return _core_
.Window_GetPositionTuple(*args
, **kwargs
)
8342 def GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8344 GetSize(self) -> Size
8346 Get the window size.
8348 return _core_
.Window_GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8350 def GetSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
):
8352 GetSizeTuple() -> (width, height)
8354 Get the window size.
8356 return _core_
.Window_GetSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
)
8358 def GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
8360 GetRect(self) -> Rect
8362 Returns the size and position of the window as a wx.Rect object.
8364 return _core_
.Window_GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
8366 def GetClientSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8368 GetClientSize(self) -> Size
8370 This gets the size of the window's 'client area' in pixels. The client
8371 area is the area which may be drawn on by the programmer, excluding
8372 title bar, border, scrollbars, etc.
8374 return _core_
.Window_GetClientSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8376 def GetClientSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
):
8378 GetClientSizeTuple() -> (width, height)
8380 This gets the size of the window's 'client area' in pixels. The client
8381 area is the area which may be drawn on by the programmer, excluding
8382 title bar, border, scrollbars, etc.
8384 return _core_
.Window_GetClientSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
)
8386 def GetClientAreaOrigin(*args
, **kwargs
):
8388 GetClientAreaOrigin(self) -> Point
8390 Get the origin of the client area of the window relative to the
8391 window's top left corner (the client area may be shifted because of
8392 the borders, scrollbars, other decorations...)
8394 return _core_
.Window_GetClientAreaOrigin(*args
, **kwargs
)
8396 def GetClientRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
8398 GetClientRect(self) -> Rect
8400 Get the client area position and size as a `wx.Rect` object.
8402 return _core_
.Window_GetClientRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
8404 def GetBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8406 GetBestSize(self) -> Size
8408 This function returns the best acceptable minimal size for the
8409 window, if applicable. For example, for a static text control, it will
8410 be the minimal size such that the control label is not truncated. For
8411 windows containing subwindows (suzh aswx.Panel), the size returned by
8412 this function will be the same as the size the window would have had
8415 return _core_
.Window_GetBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8417 def GetBestSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
):
8419 GetBestSizeTuple() -> (width, height)
8421 This function returns the best acceptable minimal size for the
8422 window, if applicable. For example, for a static text control, it will
8423 be the minimal size such that the control label is not truncated. For
8424 windows containing subwindows (suzh aswx.Panel), the size returned by
8425 this function will be the same as the size the window would have had
8428 return _core_
.Window_GetBestSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
)
8430 def InvalidateBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8432 InvalidateBestSize(self)
8434 Reset the cached best size value so it will be recalculated the next
8437 return _core_
.Window_InvalidateBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8439 def CacheBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8441 CacheBestSize(self, Size size)
8443 Cache the best size so it doesn't need to be calculated again, (at least until
8444 some properties of the window change.)
8446 return _core_
.Window_CacheBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8448 def GetBestFittingSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8450 GetBestFittingSize(self) -> Size
8452 This function will merge the window's best size into the window's
8453 minimum size, giving priority to the min size components, and returns
8457 return _core_
.Window_GetBestFittingSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8459 def GetAdjustedBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8461 GetAdjustedBestSize(self) -> Size
8463 This method is similar to GetBestSize, except in one
8464 thing. GetBestSize should return the minimum untruncated size of the
8465 window, while this method will return the largest of BestSize and any
8466 user specified minimum size. ie. it is the minimum size the window
8467 should currently be drawn at, not the minimal size it can possibly
8470 return _core_
.Window_GetAdjustedBestSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8472 def Center(*args
, **kwargs
):
8474 Center(self, int direction=BOTH)
8476 Centers the window. The parameter specifies the direction for
8477 cetering, and may be wx.HORIZONTAL, wx.VERTICAL or wx.BOTH. It may
8478 also include wx.CENTER_ON_SCREEN flag if you want to center the window
8479 on the entire screen and not on its parent window. If it is a
8480 top-level window and has no parent then it will always be centered
8481 relative to the screen.
8483 return _core_
.Window_Center(*args
, **kwargs
)
8486 def CenterOnScreen(*args
, **kwargs
):
8488 CenterOnScreen(self, int dir=BOTH)
8490 Center on screen (only works for top level windows)
8492 return _core_
.Window_CenterOnScreen(*args
, **kwargs
)
8494 CentreOnScreen
= CenterOnScreen
8495 def CenterOnParent(*args
, **kwargs
):
8497 CenterOnParent(self, int dir=BOTH)
8499 Center with respect to the the parent window
8501 return _core_
.Window_CenterOnParent(*args
, **kwargs
)
8503 CentreOnParent
= CenterOnParent
8504 def Fit(*args
, **kwargs
):
8508 Sizes the window so that it fits around its subwindows. This function
8509 won't do anything if there are no subwindows and will only really work
8510 correctly if sizers are used for the subwindows layout. Also, if the
8511 window has exactly one subwindow it is better (faster and the result
8512 is more precise as Fit adds some margin to account for fuzziness of
8513 its calculations) to call window.SetClientSize(child.GetSize())
8514 instead of calling Fit.
8516 return _core_
.Window_Fit(*args
, **kwargs
)
8518 def FitInside(*args
, **kwargs
):
8522 Similar to Fit, but sizes the interior (virtual) size of a
8523 window. Mainly useful with scrolled windows to reset scrollbars after
8524 sizing changes that do not trigger a size event, and/or scrolled
8525 windows without an interior sizer. This function similarly won't do
8526 anything if there are no subwindows.
8528 return _core_
.Window_FitInside(*args
, **kwargs
)
8530 def SetSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
):
8532 SetSizeHints(self, int minW, int minH, int maxW=-1, int maxH=-1, int incW=-1,
8535 Allows specification of minimum and maximum window sizes, and window
8536 size increments. If a pair of values is not set (or set to -1), the
8537 default values will be used. If this function is called, the user
8538 will not be able to size the window outside the given bounds (if it is
8539 a top-level window.) Sizers will also inspect the minimum window size
8540 and will use that value if set when calculating layout.
8542 The resizing increments are only significant under Motif or Xt.
8544 return _core_
.Window_SetSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
)
8546 def SetSizeHintsSz(*args
, **kwargs
):
8548 SetSizeHintsSz(self, Size minSize, Size maxSize=DefaultSize, Size incSize=DefaultSize)
8550 Allows specification of minimum and maximum window sizes, and window
8551 size increments. If a pair of values is not set (or set to -1), the
8552 default values will be used. If this function is called, the user
8553 will not be able to size the window outside the given bounds (if it is
8554 a top-level window.) Sizers will also inspect the minimum window size
8555 and will use that value if set when calculating layout.
8557 The resizing increments are only significant under Motif or Xt.
8559 return _core_
.Window_SetSizeHintsSz(*args
, **kwargs
)
8561 def SetVirtualSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
):
8563 SetVirtualSizeHints(self, int minW, int minH, int maxW=-1, int maxH=-1)
8565 Allows specification of minimum and maximum virtual window sizes. If a
8566 pair of values is not set (or set to -1), the default values will be
8567 used. If this function is called, the user will not be able to size
8568 the virtual area of the window outside the given bounds.
8570 return _core_
.Window_SetVirtualSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
)
8572 def SetVirtualSizeHintsSz(*args
, **kwargs
):
8574 SetVirtualSizeHintsSz(self, Size minSize, Size maxSize=DefaultSize)
8576 Allows specification of minimum and maximum virtual window sizes. If a
8577 pair of values is not set (or set to -1), the default values will be
8578 used. If this function is called, the user will not be able to size
8579 the virtual area of the window outside the given bounds.
8581 return _core_
.Window_SetVirtualSizeHintsSz(*args
, **kwargs
)
8583 def GetMaxSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8584 """GetMaxSize(self) -> Size"""
8585 return _core_
.Window_GetMaxSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8587 def GetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8588 """GetMinSize(self) -> Size"""
8589 return _core_
.Window_GetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8591 def SetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8593 SetMinSize(self, Size minSize)
8595 A more convenient method than `SetSizeHints` for setting just the
8598 return _core_
.Window_SetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8600 def SetMaxSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8602 SetMaxSize(self, Size maxSize)
8604 A more convenient method than `SetSizeHints` for setting just the
8607 return _core_
.Window_SetMaxSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8609 def GetMinWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
8610 """GetMinWidth(self) -> int"""
8611 return _core_
.Window_GetMinWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
8613 def GetMinHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
8614 """GetMinHeight(self) -> int"""
8615 return _core_
.Window_GetMinHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
8617 def GetMaxWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
8618 """GetMaxWidth(self) -> int"""
8619 return _core_
.Window_GetMaxWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
8621 def GetMaxHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
8622 """GetMaxHeight(self) -> int"""
8623 return _core_
.Window_GetMaxHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
8625 def SetVirtualSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8627 SetVirtualSize(self, Size size)
8629 Set the the virtual size of a window in pixels. For most windows this
8630 is just the client area of the window, but for some like scrolled
8631 windows it is more or less independent of the screen window size.
8633 return _core_
.Window_SetVirtualSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8635 def SetVirtualSizeWH(*args
, **kwargs
):
8637 SetVirtualSizeWH(self, int w, int h)
8639 Set the the virtual size of a window in pixels. For most windows this
8640 is just the client area of the window, but for some like scrolled
8641 windows it is more or less independent of the screen window size.
8643 return _core_
.Window_SetVirtualSizeWH(*args
, **kwargs
)
8645 def GetVirtualSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8647 GetVirtualSize(self) -> Size
8649 Get the the virtual size of the window in pixels. For most windows
8650 this is just the client area of the window, but for some like scrolled
8651 windows it is more or less independent of the screen window size.
8653 return _core_
.Window_GetVirtualSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8655 def GetVirtualSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
):
8657 GetVirtualSizeTuple() -> (width, height)
8659 Get the the virtual size of the window in pixels. For most windows
8660 this is just the client area of the window, but for some like scrolled
8661 windows it is more or less independent of the screen window size.
8663 return _core_
.Window_GetVirtualSizeTuple(*args
, **kwargs
)
8665 def GetBestVirtualSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
8667 GetBestVirtualSize(self) -> Size
8669 Return the largest of ClientSize and BestSize (as determined by a
8670 sizer, interior children, or other means)
8672 return _core_
.Window_GetBestVirtualSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
8674 def Show(*args
, **kwargs
):
8676 Show(self, bool show=True) -> bool
8678 Shows or hides the window. You may need to call Raise for a top level
8679 window if you want to bring it to top, although this is not needed if
8680 Show is called immediately after the frame creation. Returns True if
8681 the window has been shown or hidden or False if nothing was done
8682 because it already was in the requested state.
8684 return _core_
.Window_Show(*args
, **kwargs
)
8686 def Hide(*args
, **kwargs
):
8690 Equivalent to calling Show(False).
8692 return _core_
.Window_Hide(*args
, **kwargs
)
8694 def Enable(*args
, **kwargs
):
8696 Enable(self, bool enable=True) -> bool
8698 Enable or disable the window for user input. Note that when a parent
8699 window is disabled, all of its children are disabled as well and they
8700 are reenabled again when the parent is. Returns true if the window
8701 has been enabled or disabled, false if nothing was done, i.e. if the
8702 window had already been in the specified state.
8704 return _core_
.Window_Enable(*args
, **kwargs
)
8706 def Disable(*args
, **kwargs
):
8708 Disable(self) -> bool
8710 Disables the window, same as Enable(false).
8712 return _core_
.Window_Disable(*args
, **kwargs
)
8714 def IsShown(*args
, **kwargs
):
8716 IsShown(self) -> bool
8718 Returns true if the window is shown, false if it has been hidden.
8720 return _core_
.Window_IsShown(*args
, **kwargs
)
8722 def IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
8724 IsEnabled(self) -> bool
8726 Returns true if the window is enabled for input, false otherwise.
8728 return _core_
.Window_IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
8730 def SetWindowStyleFlag(*args
, **kwargs
):
8732 SetWindowStyleFlag(self, long style)
8734 Sets the style of the window. Please note that some styles cannot be
8735 changed after the window creation and that Refresh() might need to be
8736 called after changing the others for the change to take place
8739 return _core_
.Window_SetWindowStyleFlag(*args
, **kwargs
)
8741 def GetWindowStyleFlag(*args
, **kwargs
):
8743 GetWindowStyleFlag(self) -> long
8745 Gets the window style that was passed to the constructor or Create
8748 return _core_
.Window_GetWindowStyleFlag(*args
, **kwargs
)
8750 SetWindowStyle
= SetWindowStyleFlag
; GetWindowStyle
= GetWindowStyleFlag
8751 def HasFlag(*args
, **kwargs
):
8753 HasFlag(self, int flag) -> bool
8755 Test if the given style is set for this window.
8757 return _core_
.Window_HasFlag(*args
, **kwargs
)
8759 def IsRetained(*args
, **kwargs
):
8761 IsRetained(self) -> bool
8763 Returns true if the window is retained, false otherwise. Retained
8764 windows are only available on X platforms.
8766 return _core_
.Window_IsRetained(*args
, **kwargs
)
8768 def SetExtraStyle(*args
, **kwargs
):
8770 SetExtraStyle(self, long exStyle)
8772 Sets the extra style bits for the window. Extra styles are the less
8773 often used style bits which can't be set with the constructor or with
8774 SetWindowStyleFlag()
8776 return _core_
.Window_SetExtraStyle(*args
, **kwargs
)
8778 def GetExtraStyle(*args
, **kwargs
):
8780 GetExtraStyle(self) -> long
8782 Returns the extra style bits for the window.
8784 return _core_
.Window_GetExtraStyle(*args
, **kwargs
)
8786 def MakeModal(*args
, **kwargs
):
8788 MakeModal(self, bool modal=True)
8790 Disables all other windows in the application so that the user can
8791 only interact with this window. Passing False will reverse this
8794 return _core_
.Window_MakeModal(*args
, **kwargs
)
8796 def SetThemeEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
8798 SetThemeEnabled(self, bool enableTheme)
8800 This function tells a window if it should use the system's "theme"
8801 code to draw the windows' background instead if its own background
8802 drawing code. This will only have an effect on platforms that support
8803 the notion of themes in user defined windows. One such platform is
8804 GTK+ where windows can have (very colourful) backgrounds defined by a
8805 user's selected theme.
8807 Dialogs, notebook pages and the status bar have this flag set to true
8808 by default so that the default look and feel is simulated best.
8810 return _core_
.Window_SetThemeEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
8812 def GetThemeEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
8814 GetThemeEnabled(self) -> bool
8816 Return the themeEnabled flag.
8818 return _core_
.Window_GetThemeEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
8820 def SetFocus(*args
, **kwargs
):
8824 Set's the focus to this window, allowing it to receive keyboard input.
8826 return _core_
.Window_SetFocus(*args
, **kwargs
)
8828 def SetFocusFromKbd(*args
, **kwargs
):
8830 SetFocusFromKbd(self)
8832 Set focus to this window as the result of a keyboard action. Normally
8833 only called internally.
8835 return _core_
.Window_SetFocusFromKbd(*args
, **kwargs
)
8837 def FindFocus(*args
, **kwargs
):
8839 FindFocus() -> Window
8841 Returns the window or control that currently has the keyboard focus,
8844 return _core_
.Window_FindFocus(*args
, **kwargs
)
8846 FindFocus
= staticmethod(FindFocus
)
8847 def AcceptsFocus(*args
, **kwargs
):
8849 AcceptsFocus(self) -> bool
8851 Can this window have focus?
8853 return _core_
.Window_AcceptsFocus(*args
, **kwargs
)
8855 def AcceptsFocusFromKeyboard(*args
, **kwargs
):
8857 AcceptsFocusFromKeyboard(self) -> bool
8859 Can this window be given focus by keyboard navigation? if not, the
8860 only way to give it focus (provided it accepts it at all) is to click
8863 return _core_
.Window_AcceptsFocusFromKeyboard(*args
, **kwargs
)
8865 def GetDefaultItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
8867 GetDefaultItem(self) -> Window
8869 Get the default child of this parent, i.e. the one which is activated
8870 by pressing <Enter> such as the OK button on a wx.Dialog.
8872 return _core_
.Window_GetDefaultItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
8874 def SetDefaultItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
8876 SetDefaultItem(self, Window child) -> Window
8878 Set this child as default, return the old default.
8880 return _core_
.Window_SetDefaultItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
8882 def SetTmpDefaultItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
8884 SetTmpDefaultItem(self, Window win)
8886 Set this child as temporary default
8888 return _core_
.Window_SetTmpDefaultItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
8890 def Navigate(*args
, **kwargs
):
8892 Navigate(self, int flags=NavigationKeyEvent.IsForward) -> bool
8894 Does keyboard navigation from this window to another, by sending a
8895 `wx.NavigationKeyEvent`.
8897 return _core_
.Window_Navigate(*args
, **kwargs
)
8899 def MoveAfterInTabOrder(*args
, **kwargs
):
8901 MoveAfterInTabOrder(self, Window win)
8903 Moves this window in the tab navigation order after the specified
8904 sibling window. This means that when the user presses the TAB key on
8905 that other window, the focus switches to this window.
8907 The default tab order is the same as creation order. This function
8908 and `MoveBeforeInTabOrder` allow to change it after creating all the
8912 return _core_
.Window_MoveAfterInTabOrder(*args
, **kwargs
)
8914 def MoveBeforeInTabOrder(*args
, **kwargs
):
8916 MoveBeforeInTabOrder(self, Window win)
8918 Same as `MoveAfterInTabOrder` except that it inserts this window just
8919 before win instead of putting it right after it.
8921 return _core_
.Window_MoveBeforeInTabOrder(*args
, **kwargs
)
8923 def GetChildren(*args
, **kwargs
):
8925 GetChildren(self) -> PyObject
8927 Returns a list of the window's children. NOTE: Currently this is a
8928 copy of the child window list maintained by the window, so the return
8929 value of this function is only valid as long as the window's children
8932 return _core_
.Window_GetChildren(*args
, **kwargs
)
8934 def GetParent(*args
, **kwargs
):
8936 GetParent(self) -> Window
8938 Returns the parent window of this window, or None if there isn't one.
8940 return _core_
.Window_GetParent(*args
, **kwargs
)
8942 def GetGrandParent(*args
, **kwargs
):
8944 GetGrandParent(self) -> Window
8946 Returns the parent of the parent of this window, or None if there
8949 return _core_
.Window_GetGrandParent(*args
, **kwargs
)
8951 def IsTopLevel(*args
, **kwargs
):
8953 IsTopLevel(self) -> bool
8955 Returns true if the given window is a top-level one. Currently all
8956 frames and dialogs are always considered to be top-level windows (even
8957 if they have a parent window).
8959 return _core_
.Window_IsTopLevel(*args
, **kwargs
)
8961 def Reparent(*args
, **kwargs
):
8963 Reparent(self, Window newParent) -> bool
8965 Reparents the window, i.e the window will be removed from its current
8966 parent window (e.g. a non-standard toolbar in a wxFrame) and then
8967 re-inserted into another. Available on Windows and GTK. Returns True
8968 if the parent was changed, False otherwise (error or newParent ==
8971 return _core_
.Window_Reparent(*args
, **kwargs
)
8973 def AddChild(*args
, **kwargs
):
8975 AddChild(self, Window child)
8977 Adds a child window. This is called automatically by window creation
8978 functions so should not be required by the application programmer.
8980 return _core_
.Window_AddChild(*args
, **kwargs
)
8982 def RemoveChild(*args
, **kwargs
):
8984 RemoveChild(self, Window child)
8986 Removes a child window. This is called automatically by window
8987 deletion functions so should not be required by the application
8990 return _core_
.Window_RemoveChild(*args
, **kwargs
)
8992 def FindWindowById(*args
, **kwargs
):
8994 FindWindowById(self, long winid) -> Window
8996 Find a chld of this window by window ID
8998 return _core_
.Window_FindWindowById(*args
, **kwargs
)
9000 def FindWindowByName(*args
, **kwargs
):
9002 FindWindowByName(self, String name) -> Window
9004 Find a child of this window by name
9006 return _core_
.Window_FindWindowByName(*args
, **kwargs
)
9008 def GetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
9010 GetEventHandler(self) -> EvtHandler
9012 Returns the event handler for this window. By default, the window is
9013 its own event handler.
9015 return _core_
.Window_GetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
9017 def SetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
9019 SetEventHandler(self, EvtHandler handler)
9021 Sets the event handler for this window. An event handler is an object
9022 that is capable of processing the events sent to a window. By default,
9023 the window is its own event handler, but an application may wish to
9024 substitute another, for example to allow central implementation of
9025 event-handling for a variety of different window classes.
9027 It is usually better to use `wx.Window.PushEventHandler` since this sets
9028 up a chain of event handlers, where an event not handled by one event
9029 handler is handed to the next one in the chain.
9031 return _core_
.Window_SetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
9033 def PushEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
9035 PushEventHandler(self, EvtHandler handler)
9037 Pushes this event handler onto the event handler stack for the window.
9038 An event handler is an object that is capable of processing the events
9039 sent to a window. By default, the window is its own event handler, but
9040 an application may wish to substitute another, for example to allow
9041 central implementation of event-handling for a variety of different
9044 wx.Window.PushEventHandler allows an application to set up a chain of
9045 event handlers, where an event not handled by one event handler is
9046 handed to the next one in the chain. Use `wx.Window.PopEventHandler` to
9047 remove the event handler.
9049 return _core_
.Window_PushEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
9051 def PopEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
9053 PopEventHandler(self, bool deleteHandler=False) -> EvtHandler
9055 Removes and returns the top-most event handler on the event handler
9056 stack. If deleteHandler is True then the wx.EvtHandler object will be
9057 destroyed after it is popped.
9059 return _core_
.Window_PopEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
9061 def RemoveEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
9063 RemoveEventHandler(self, EvtHandler handler) -> bool
9065 Find the given handler in the event handler chain and remove (but not
9066 delete) it from the event handler chain, return True if it was found
9067 and False otherwise (this also results in an assert failure so this
9068 function should only be called when the handler is supposed to be
9071 return _core_
.Window_RemoveEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
9073 def SetValidator(*args
, **kwargs
):
9075 SetValidator(self, Validator validator)
9077 Deletes the current validator (if any) and sets the window validator,
9078 having called wx.Validator.Clone to create a new validator of this
9081 return _core_
.Window_SetValidator(*args
, **kwargs
)
9083 def GetValidator(*args
, **kwargs
):
9085 GetValidator(self) -> Validator
9087 Returns a pointer to the current validator for the window, or None if
9090 return _core_
.Window_GetValidator(*args
, **kwargs
)
9092 def Validate(*args
, **kwargs
):
9094 Validate(self) -> bool
9096 Validates the current values of the child controls using their
9097 validators. If the window has wx.WS_EX_VALIDATE_RECURSIVELY extra
9098 style flag set, the method will also call Validate() of all child
9099 windows. Returns false if any of the validations failed.
9101 return _core_
.Window_Validate(*args
, **kwargs
)
9103 def TransferDataToWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
9105 TransferDataToWindow(self) -> bool
9107 Transfers values to child controls from data areas specified by their
9108 validators. If the window has wx.WS_EX_VALIDATE_RECURSIVELY extra
9109 style flag set, the method will also call TransferDataToWindow() of
9112 return _core_
.Window_TransferDataToWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
9114 def TransferDataFromWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
9116 TransferDataFromWindow(self) -> bool
9118 Transfers values from child controls to data areas specified by their
9119 validators. Returns false if a transfer failed. If the window has
9120 wx.WS_EX_VALIDATE_RECURSIVELY extra style flag set, the method will
9121 also call TransferDataFromWindow() of all child windows.
9123 return _core_
.Window_TransferDataFromWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
9125 def InitDialog(*args
, **kwargs
):
9129 Sends an EVT_INIT_DIALOG event, whose handler usually transfers data
9130 to the dialog via validators.
9132 return _core_
.Window_InitDialog(*args
, **kwargs
)
9134 def SetAcceleratorTable(*args
, **kwargs
):
9136 SetAcceleratorTable(self, AcceleratorTable accel)
9138 Sets the accelerator table for this window.
9140 return _core_
.Window_SetAcceleratorTable(*args
, **kwargs
)
9142 def GetAcceleratorTable(*args
, **kwargs
):
9144 GetAcceleratorTable(self) -> AcceleratorTable
9146 Gets the accelerator table for this window.
9148 return _core_
.Window_GetAcceleratorTable(*args
, **kwargs
)
9150 def RegisterHotKey(*args
, **kwargs
):
9152 RegisterHotKey(self, int hotkeyId, int modifiers, int keycode) -> bool
9154 Registers a system wide hotkey. Every time the user presses the hotkey
9155 registered here, this window will receive a hotkey event. It will
9156 receive the event even if the application is in the background and
9157 does not have the input focus because the user is working with some
9158 other application. To bind an event handler function to this hotkey
9159 use EVT_HOTKEY with an id equal to hotkeyId. Returns True if the
9160 hotkey was registered successfully.
9162 return _core_
.Window_RegisterHotKey(*args
, **kwargs
)
9164 def UnregisterHotKey(*args
, **kwargs
):
9166 UnregisterHotKey(self, int hotkeyId) -> bool
9168 Unregisters a system wide hotkey.
9170 return _core_
.Window_UnregisterHotKey(*args
, **kwargs
)
9172 def ConvertDialogPointToPixels(*args
, **kwargs
):
9174 ConvertDialogPointToPixels(self, Point pt) -> Point
9176 Converts a point or size from dialog units to pixels. Dialog units
9177 are used for maintaining a dialog's proportions even if the font
9178 changes. For the x dimension, the dialog units are multiplied by the
9179 average character width and then divided by 4. For the y dimension,
9180 the dialog units are multiplied by the average character height and
9183 return _core_
.Window_ConvertDialogPointToPixels(*args
, **kwargs
)
9185 def ConvertDialogSizeToPixels(*args
, **kwargs
):
9187 ConvertDialogSizeToPixels(self, Size sz) -> Size
9189 Converts a point or size from dialog units to pixels. Dialog units
9190 are used for maintaining a dialog's proportions even if the font
9191 changes. For the x dimension, the dialog units are multiplied by the
9192 average character width and then divided by 4. For the y dimension,
9193 the dialog units are multiplied by the average character height and
9196 return _core_
.Window_ConvertDialogSizeToPixels(*args
, **kwargs
)
9198 def DLG_PNT(*args
, **kwargs
):
9200 DLG_PNT(self, Point pt) -> Point
9202 Converts a point or size from dialog units to pixels. Dialog units
9203 are used for maintaining a dialog's proportions even if the font
9204 changes. For the x dimension, the dialog units are multiplied by the
9205 average character width and then divided by 4. For the y dimension,
9206 the dialog units are multiplied by the average character height and
9209 return _core_
.Window_DLG_PNT(*args
, **kwargs
)
9211 def DLG_SZE(*args
, **kwargs
):
9213 DLG_SZE(self, Size sz) -> Size
9215 Converts a point or size from dialog units to pixels. Dialog units
9216 are used for maintaining a dialog's proportions even if the font
9217 changes. For the x dimension, the dialog units are multiplied by the
9218 average character width and then divided by 4. For the y dimension,
9219 the dialog units are multiplied by the average character height and
9222 return _core_
.Window_DLG_SZE(*args
, **kwargs
)
9224 def ConvertPixelPointToDialog(*args
, **kwargs
):
9225 """ConvertPixelPointToDialog(self, Point pt) -> Point"""
9226 return _core_
.Window_ConvertPixelPointToDialog(*args
, **kwargs
)
9228 def ConvertPixelSizeToDialog(*args
, **kwargs
):
9229 """ConvertPixelSizeToDialog(self, Size sz) -> Size"""
9230 return _core_
.Window_ConvertPixelSizeToDialog(*args
, **kwargs
)
9232 def WarpPointer(*args
, **kwargs
):
9234 WarpPointer(self, int x, int y)
9236 Moves the pointer to the given position on the window.
9238 NOTE: This function is not supported under Mac because Apple Human
9239 Interface Guidelines forbid moving the mouse cursor programmatically.
9241 return _core_
.Window_WarpPointer(*args
, **kwargs
)
9243 def CaptureMouse(*args
, **kwargs
):
9247 Directs all mouse input to this window. Call wx.Window.ReleaseMouse to
9248 release the capture.
9250 Note that wxWindows maintains the stack of windows having captured the
9251 mouse and when the mouse is released the capture returns to the window
9252 which had had captured it previously and it is only really released if
9253 there were no previous window. In particular, this means that you must
9254 release the mouse as many times as you capture it.
9256 return _core_
.Window_CaptureMouse(*args
, **kwargs
)
9258 def ReleaseMouse(*args
, **kwargs
):
9262 Releases mouse input captured with wx.Window.CaptureMouse.
9264 return _core_
.Window_ReleaseMouse(*args
, **kwargs
)
9266 def GetCapture(*args
, **kwargs
):
9268 GetCapture() -> Window
9270 Returns the window which currently captures the mouse or None
9272 return _core_
.Window_GetCapture(*args
, **kwargs
)
9274 GetCapture
= staticmethod(GetCapture
)
9275 def HasCapture(*args
, **kwargs
):
9277 HasCapture(self) -> bool
9279 Returns true if this window has the current mouse capture.
9281 return _core_
.Window_HasCapture(*args
, **kwargs
)
9283 def Refresh(*args
, **kwargs
):
9285 Refresh(self, bool eraseBackground=True, Rect rect=None)
9287 Mark the specified rectangle (or the whole window) as "dirty" so it
9288 will be repainted. Causes an EVT_PAINT event to be generated and sent
9291 return _core_
.Window_Refresh(*args
, **kwargs
)
9293 def RefreshRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
9295 RefreshRect(self, Rect rect, bool eraseBackground=True)
9297 Redraws the contents of the given rectangle: the area inside it will
9298 be repainted. This is the same as Refresh but has a nicer syntax.
9300 return _core_
.Window_RefreshRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
9302 def Update(*args
, **kwargs
):
9306 Calling this method immediately repaints the invalidated area of the
9307 window instead of waiting for the EVT_PAINT event to happen, (normally
9308 this would usually only happen when the flow of control returns to the
9309 event loop.) Notice that this function doesn't refresh the window and
9310 does nothing if the window has been already repainted. Use Refresh
9311 first if you want to immediately redraw the window (or some portion of
9312 it) unconditionally.
9314 return _core_
.Window_Update(*args
, **kwargs
)
9316 def ClearBackground(*args
, **kwargs
):
9318 ClearBackground(self)
9320 Clears the window by filling it with the current background
9321 colour. Does not cause an erase background event to be generated.
9323 return _core_
.Window_ClearBackground(*args
, **kwargs
)
9325 def Freeze(*args
, **kwargs
):
9329 Freezes the window or, in other words, prevents any updates from
9330 taking place on screen, the window is not redrawn at all. Thaw must be
9331 called to reenable window redrawing. Calls to Freeze/Thaw may be
9332 nested, with the actual Thaw being delayed until all the nesting has
9335 This method is useful for visual appearance optimization (for example,
9336 it is a good idea to use it before inserting large amount of text into
9337 a wxTextCtrl under wxGTK) but is not implemented on all platforms nor
9338 for all controls so it is mostly just a hint to wxWindows and not a
9339 mandatory directive.
9341 return _core_
.Window_Freeze(*args
, **kwargs
)
9343 def Thaw(*args
, **kwargs
):
9347 Reenables window updating after a previous call to Freeze. Calls to
9348 Freeze/Thaw may be nested, so Thaw must be called the same number of
9349 times that Freeze was before the window will be updated.
9351 return _core_
.Window_Thaw(*args
, **kwargs
)
9353 def PrepareDC(*args
, **kwargs
):
9355 PrepareDC(self, DC dc)
9357 Call this function to prepare the device context for drawing a
9358 scrolled image. It sets the device origin according to the current
9361 return _core_
.Window_PrepareDC(*args
, **kwargs
)
9363 def GetUpdateRegion(*args
, **kwargs
):
9365 GetUpdateRegion(self) -> Region
9367 Returns the region specifying which parts of the window have been
9368 damaged. Should only be called within an EVT_PAINT handler.
9370 return _core_
.Window_GetUpdateRegion(*args
, **kwargs
)
9372 def GetUpdateClientRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
9374 GetUpdateClientRect(self) -> Rect
9376 Get the update rectangle region bounding box in client coords.
9378 return _core_
.Window_GetUpdateClientRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
9380 def IsExposed(*args
, **kwargs
):
9382 IsExposed(self, int x, int y, int w=1, int h=1) -> bool
9384 Returns true if the given point or rectangle area has been exposed
9385 since the last repaint. Call this in an paint event handler to
9386 optimize redrawing by only redrawing those areas, which have been
9389 return _core_
.Window_IsExposed(*args
, **kwargs
)
9391 def IsExposedPoint(*args
, **kwargs
):
9393 IsExposedPoint(self, Point pt) -> bool
9395 Returns true if the given point or rectangle area has been exposed
9396 since the last repaint. Call this in an paint event handler to
9397 optimize redrawing by only redrawing those areas, which have been
9400 return _core_
.Window_IsExposedPoint(*args
, **kwargs
)
9402 def IsExposedRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
9404 IsExposedRect(self, Rect rect) -> bool
9406 Returns true if the given point or rectangle area has been exposed
9407 since the last repaint. Call this in an paint event handler to
9408 optimize redrawing by only redrawing those areas, which have been
9411 return _core_
.Window_IsExposedRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
9413 def GetDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
):
9415 GetDefaultAttributes(self) -> VisualAttributes
9417 Get the default attributes for an instance of this class. This is
9418 useful if you want to use the same font or colour in your own control
9419 as in a standard control -- which is a much better idea than hard
9420 coding specific colours or fonts which might look completely out of
9421 place on the user's system, especially if it uses themes.
9423 return _core_
.Window_GetDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
)
9425 def GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
):
9427 GetClassDefaultAttributes(int variant=WINDOW_VARIANT_NORMAL) -> VisualAttributes
9429 Get the default attributes for this class. This is useful if you want
9430 to use the same font or colour in your own control as in a standard
9431 control -- which is a much better idea than hard coding specific
9432 colours or fonts which might look completely out of place on the
9433 user's system, especially if it uses themes.
9435 The variant parameter is only relevant under Mac currently and is
9436 ignore under other platforms. Under Mac, it will change the size of
9437 the returned font. See `wx.Window.SetWindowVariant` for more about
9440 return _core_
.Window_GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
)
9442 GetClassDefaultAttributes
= staticmethod(GetClassDefaultAttributes
)
9443 def SetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
9445 SetBackgroundColour(self, Colour colour) -> bool
9447 Sets the background colour of the window. Returns True if the colour
9448 was changed. The background colour is usually painted by the default
9449 EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND event handler function under Windows and
9450 automatically under GTK. Using `wx.NullColour` will reset the window
9451 to the default background colour.
9453 Note that setting the background colour may not cause an immediate
9454 refresh, so you may wish to call `ClearBackground` or `Refresh` after
9455 calling this function.
9457 Using this function will disable attempts to use themes for this
9458 window, if the system supports them. Use with care since usually the
9459 themes represent the appearance chosen by the user to be used for all
9460 applications on the system.
9462 return _core_
.Window_SetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
9464 def SetOwnBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
9465 """SetOwnBackgroundColour(self, Colour colour)"""
9466 return _core_
.Window_SetOwnBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
9468 def SetForegroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
9470 SetForegroundColour(self, Colour colour) -> bool
9472 Sets the foreground colour of the window. Returns True is the colour
9473 was changed. The interpretation of foreground colour is dependent on
9474 the window class; it may be the text colour or other colour, or it may
9477 return _core_
.Window_SetForegroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
9479 def SetOwnForegroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
9480 """SetOwnForegroundColour(self, Colour colour)"""
9481 return _core_
.Window_SetOwnForegroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
9483 def GetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
9485 GetBackgroundColour(self) -> Colour
9487 Returns the background colour of the window.
9489 return _core_
.Window_GetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
9491 def GetForegroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
9493 GetForegroundColour(self) -> Colour
9495 Returns the foreground colour of the window. The interpretation of
9496 foreground colour is dependent on the window class; it may be the text
9497 colour or other colour, or it may not be used at all.
9499 return _core_
.Window_GetForegroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
9501 def InheritsBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
9502 """InheritsBackgroundColour(self) -> bool"""
9503 return _core_
.Window_InheritsBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
9505 def UseBgCol(*args
, **kwargs
):
9506 """UseBgCol(self) -> bool"""
9507 return _core_
.Window_UseBgCol(*args
, **kwargs
)
9509 def SetBackgroundStyle(*args
, **kwargs
):
9511 SetBackgroundStyle(self, int style) -> bool
9513 Returns the background style of the window. The background style
9514 indicates how the background of the window is drawn.
9516 ====================== ========================================
9517 wx.BG_STYLE_SYSTEM The background colour or pattern should
9518 be determined by the system
9519 wx.BG_STYLE_COLOUR The background should be a solid colour
9520 wx.BG_STYLE_CUSTOM The background will be implemented by the
9522 ====================== ========================================
9524 On GTK+, use of wx.BG_STYLE_CUSTOM allows the flicker-free drawing of
9525 a custom background, such as a tiled bitmap. Currently the style has
9526 no effect on other platforms.
9528 :see: `GetBackgroundStyle`, `SetBackgroundColour`
9530 return _core_
.Window_SetBackgroundStyle(*args
, **kwargs
)
9532 def GetBackgroundStyle(*args
, **kwargs
):
9534 GetBackgroundStyle(self) -> int
9536 Returns the background style of the window.
9538 :see: `SetBackgroundStyle`
9540 return _core_
.Window_GetBackgroundStyle(*args
, **kwargs
)
9542 def HasTransparentBackground(*args
, **kwargs
):
9544 HasTransparentBackground(self) -> bool
9546 Returns True if this window's background is transparent (as, for
9547 example, for `wx.StaticText`) and should show the parent window's
9550 This method is mostly used internally by the library itself and you
9551 normally shouldn't have to call it. You may, however, have to override
9552 it in your custom control classes to ensure that background is painted
9555 return _core_
.Window_HasTransparentBackground(*args
, **kwargs
)
9557 def SetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
):
9559 SetCursor(self, Cursor cursor) -> bool
9561 Sets the window's cursor. Notice that the window cursor also sets it
9562 for the children of the window implicitly.
9564 The cursor may be wx.NullCursor in which case the window cursor will
9565 be reset back to default.
9567 return _core_
.Window_SetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
)
9569 def GetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
):
9571 GetCursor(self) -> Cursor
9573 Return the cursor associated with this window.
9575 return _core_
.Window_GetCursor(*args
, **kwargs
)
9577 def SetFont(*args
, **kwargs
):
9579 SetFont(self, Font font) -> bool
9581 Sets the font for this window.
9583 return _core_
.Window_SetFont(*args
, **kwargs
)
9585 def SetOwnFont(*args
, **kwargs
):
9586 """SetOwnFont(self, Font font)"""
9587 return _core_
.Window_SetOwnFont(*args
, **kwargs
)
9589 def GetFont(*args
, **kwargs
):
9591 GetFont(self) -> Font
9593 Returns the default font used for this window.
9595 return _core_
.Window_GetFont(*args
, **kwargs
)
9597 def SetCaret(*args
, **kwargs
):
9599 SetCaret(self, Caret caret)
9601 Sets the caret associated with the window.
9603 return _core_
.Window_SetCaret(*args
, **kwargs
)
9605 def GetCaret(*args
, **kwargs
):
9607 GetCaret(self) -> Caret
9609 Returns the caret associated with the window.
9611 return _core_
.Window_GetCaret(*args
, **kwargs
)
9613 def GetCharHeight(*args
, **kwargs
):
9615 GetCharHeight(self) -> int
9617 Get the (average) character size for the current font.
9619 return _core_
.Window_GetCharHeight(*args
, **kwargs
)
9621 def GetCharWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
9623 GetCharWidth(self) -> int
9625 Get the (average) character size for the current font.
9627 return _core_
.Window_GetCharWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
9629 def GetTextExtent(*args
, **kwargs
):
9631 GetTextExtent(String string) -> (width, height)
9633 Get the width and height of the text using the current font.
9635 return _core_
.Window_GetTextExtent(*args
, **kwargs
)
9637 def GetFullTextExtent(*args
, **kwargs
):
9639 GetFullTextExtent(String string, Font font=None) ->
9640 (width, height, descent, externalLeading)
9642 Get the width, height, decent and leading of the text using the
9643 current or specified font.
9645 return _core_
.Window_GetFullTextExtent(*args
, **kwargs
)
9647 def ClientToScreenXY(*args
, **kwargs
):
9649 ClientToScreenXY(int x, int y) -> (x,y)
9651 Converts to screen coordinates from coordinates relative to this window.
9653 return _core_
.Window_ClientToScreenXY(*args
, **kwargs
)
9655 def ScreenToClientXY(*args
, **kwargs
):
9657 ScreenToClientXY(int x, int y) -> (x,y)
9659 Converts from screen to client window coordinates.
9661 return _core_
.Window_ScreenToClientXY(*args
, **kwargs
)
9663 def ClientToScreen(*args
, **kwargs
):
9665 ClientToScreen(self, Point pt) -> Point
9667 Converts to screen coordinates from coordinates relative to this window.
9669 return _core_
.Window_ClientToScreen(*args
, **kwargs
)
9671 def ScreenToClient(*args
, **kwargs
):
9673 ScreenToClient(self, Point pt) -> Point
9675 Converts from screen to client window coordinates.
9677 return _core_
.Window_ScreenToClient(*args
, **kwargs
)
9679 def HitTestXY(*args
, **kwargs
):
9681 HitTestXY(self, int x, int y) -> int
9683 Test where the given (in client coords) point lies
9685 return _core_
.Window_HitTestXY(*args
, **kwargs
)
9687 def HitTest(*args
, **kwargs
):
9689 HitTest(self, Point pt) -> int
9691 Test where the given (in client coords) point lies
9693 return _core_
.Window_HitTest(*args
, **kwargs
)
9695 def GetBorder(*args
):
9697 GetBorder(self, long flags) -> int
9698 GetBorder(self) -> int
9700 Get border for the flags of this window
9702 return _core_
.Window_GetBorder(*args
)
9704 def UpdateWindowUI(*args
, **kwargs
):
9706 UpdateWindowUI(self, long flags=UPDATE_UI_NONE)
9708 This function sends EVT_UPDATE_UI events to the window. The particular
9709 implementation depends on the window; for example a wx.ToolBar will
9710 send an update UI event for each toolbar button, and a wx.Frame will
9711 send an update UI event for each menubar menu item. You can call this
9712 function from your application to ensure that your UI is up-to-date at
9713 a particular point in time (as far as your EVT_UPDATE_UI handlers are
9714 concerned). This may be necessary if you have called
9715 `wx.UpdateUIEvent.SetMode` or `wx.UpdateUIEvent.SetUpdateInterval` to
9716 limit the overhead that wxWindows incurs by sending update UI events
9719 return _core_
.Window_UpdateWindowUI(*args
, **kwargs
)
9721 def PopupMenuXY(*args
, **kwargs
):
9723 PopupMenuXY(self, Menu menu, int x=-1, int y=-1) -> bool
9725 Pops up the given menu at the specified coordinates, relative to this window,
9726 and returns control when the user has dismissed the menu. If a menu item is
9727 selected, the corresponding menu event is generated and will be processed as
9728 usual. If the default position is given then the current position of the
9729 mouse cursor will be used.
9731 return _core_
.Window_PopupMenuXY(*args
, **kwargs
)
9733 def PopupMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
9735 PopupMenu(self, Menu menu, Point pos=DefaultPosition) -> bool
9737 Pops up the given menu at the specified coordinates, relative to this window,
9738 and returns control when the user has dismissed the menu. If a menu item is
9739 selected, the corresponding menu event is generated and will be processed as
9740 usual. If the default position is given then the current position of the
9741 mouse cursor will be used.
9743 return _core_
.Window_PopupMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
9745 def GetHandle(*args
, **kwargs
):
9747 GetHandle(self) -> long
9749 Returns the platform-specific handle (as a long integer) of the
9750 physical window. Currently on wxMac it returns the handle of the
9751 toplevel parent of the window.
9753 return _core_
.Window_GetHandle(*args
, **kwargs
)
9755 def AssociateHandle(*args
, **kwargs
):
9757 AssociateHandle(self, long handle)
9759 Associate the window with a new native handle
9761 return _core_
.Window_AssociateHandle(*args
, **kwargs
)
9763 def DissociateHandle(*args
, **kwargs
):
9765 DissociateHandle(self)
9767 Dissociate the current native handle from the window
9769 return _core_
.Window_DissociateHandle(*args
, **kwargs
)
9771 def OnPaint(*args
, **kwargs
):
9772 """OnPaint(self, PaintEvent event)"""
9773 return _core_
.Window_OnPaint(*args
, **kwargs
)
9775 def HasScrollbar(*args
, **kwargs
):
9777 HasScrollbar(self, int orient) -> bool
9779 Does the window have the scrollbar for this orientation?
9781 return _core_
.Window_HasScrollbar(*args
, **kwargs
)
9783 def SetScrollbar(*args
, **kwargs
):
9785 SetScrollbar(self, int orientation, int position, int thumbSize, int range,
9788 Sets the scrollbar properties of a built-in scrollbar.
9790 return _core_
.Window_SetScrollbar(*args
, **kwargs
)
9792 def SetScrollPos(*args
, **kwargs
):
9794 SetScrollPos(self, int orientation, int pos, bool refresh=True)
9796 Sets the position of one of the built-in scrollbars.
9798 return _core_
.Window_SetScrollPos(*args
, **kwargs
)
9800 def GetScrollPos(*args
, **kwargs
):
9802 GetScrollPos(self, int orientation) -> int
9804 Returns the built-in scrollbar position.
9806 return _core_
.Window_GetScrollPos(*args
, **kwargs
)
9808 def GetScrollThumb(*args
, **kwargs
):
9810 GetScrollThumb(self, int orientation) -> int
9812 Returns the built-in scrollbar thumb size.
9814 return _core_
.Window_GetScrollThumb(*args
, **kwargs
)
9816 def GetScrollRange(*args
, **kwargs
):
9818 GetScrollRange(self, int orientation) -> int
9820 Returns the built-in scrollbar range.
9822 return _core_
.Window_GetScrollRange(*args
, **kwargs
)
9824 def ScrollWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
9826 ScrollWindow(self, int dx, int dy, Rect rect=None)
9828 Physically scrolls the pixels in the window and move child windows
9829 accordingly. Use this function to optimise your scrolling
9830 implementations, to minimise the area that must be redrawn. Note that
9831 it is rarely required to call this function from a user program.
9833 return _core_
.Window_ScrollWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
9835 def ScrollLines(*args
, **kwargs
):
9837 ScrollLines(self, int lines) -> bool
9839 If the platform and window class supports it, scrolls the window by
9840 the given number of lines down, if lines is positive, or up if lines
9841 is negative. Returns True if the window was scrolled, False if it was
9842 already on top/bottom and nothing was done.
9844 return _core_
.Window_ScrollLines(*args
, **kwargs
)
9846 def ScrollPages(*args
, **kwargs
):
9848 ScrollPages(self, int pages) -> bool
9850 If the platform and window class supports it, scrolls the window by
9851 the given number of pages down, if pages is positive, or up if pages
9852 is negative. Returns True if the window was scrolled, False if it was
9853 already on top/bottom and nothing was done.
9855 return _core_
.Window_ScrollPages(*args
, **kwargs
)
9857 def LineUp(*args
, **kwargs
):
9859 LineUp(self) -> bool
9861 This is just a wrapper for ScrollLines(-1).
9863 return _core_
.Window_LineUp(*args
, **kwargs
)
9865 def LineDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
9867 LineDown(self) -> bool
9869 This is just a wrapper for ScrollLines(1).
9871 return _core_
.Window_LineDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
9873 def PageUp(*args
, **kwargs
):
9875 PageUp(self) -> bool
9877 This is just a wrapper for ScrollPages(-1).
9879 return _core_
.Window_PageUp(*args
, **kwargs
)
9881 def PageDown(*args
, **kwargs
):
9883 PageDown(self) -> bool
9885 This is just a wrapper for ScrollPages(1).
9887 return _core_
.Window_PageDown(*args
, **kwargs
)
9889 def SetHelpText(*args
, **kwargs
):
9891 SetHelpText(self, String text)
9893 Sets the help text to be used as context-sensitive help for this
9894 window. Note that the text is actually stored by the current
9895 wxHelpProvider implementation, and not in the window object itself.
9897 return _core_
.Window_SetHelpText(*args
, **kwargs
)
9899 def SetHelpTextForId(*args
, **kwargs
):
9901 SetHelpTextForId(self, String text)
9903 Associate this help text with all windows with the same id as this
9906 return _core_
.Window_SetHelpTextForId(*args
, **kwargs
)
9908 def GetHelpText(*args
, **kwargs
):
9910 GetHelpText(self) -> String
9912 Gets the help text to be used as context-sensitive help for this
9913 window. Note that the text is actually stored by the current
9914 wxHelpProvider implementation, and not in the window object itself.
9916 return _core_
.Window_GetHelpText(*args
, **kwargs
)
9918 def SetToolTipString(*args
, **kwargs
):
9920 SetToolTipString(self, String tip)
9922 Attach a tooltip to the window.
9924 return _core_
.Window_SetToolTipString(*args
, **kwargs
)
9926 def SetToolTip(*args
, **kwargs
):
9928 SetToolTip(self, ToolTip tip)
9930 Attach a tooltip to the window.
9932 return _core_
.Window_SetToolTip(*args
, **kwargs
)
9934 def GetToolTip(*args
, **kwargs
):
9936 GetToolTip(self) -> ToolTip
9938 get the associated tooltip or None if none
9940 return _core_
.Window_GetToolTip(*args
, **kwargs
)
9942 def SetDropTarget(*args
, **kwargs
):
9944 SetDropTarget(self, DropTarget dropTarget)
9946 Associates a drop target with this window. If the window already has
9947 a drop target, it is deleted.
9949 return _core_
.Window_SetDropTarget(*args
, **kwargs
)
9951 def GetDropTarget(*args
, **kwargs
):
9953 GetDropTarget(self) -> DropTarget
9955 Returns the associated drop target, which may be None.
9957 return _core_
.Window_GetDropTarget(*args
, **kwargs
)
9959 def DragAcceptFiles(*args
, **kwargs
):
9961 DragAcceptFiles(self, bool accept)
9963 Enables or disables eligibility for drop file events, EVT_DROP_FILES.
9964 Only functional on Windows.
9966 return _core_
.Window_DragAcceptFiles(*args
, **kwargs
)
9968 def SetConstraints(*args
, **kwargs
):
9970 SetConstraints(self, LayoutConstraints constraints)
9972 Sets the window to have the given layout constraints. If an existing
9973 layout constraints object is already owned by the window, it will be
9974 deleted. Pass None to disassociate and delete the window's current
9977 You must call SetAutoLayout to tell a window to use the constraints
9978 automatically in its default EVT_SIZE handler; otherwise, you must
9979 handle EVT_SIZE yourself and call Layout() explicitly. When setting
9980 both a wx.LayoutConstraints and a wx.Sizer, only the sizer will have
9983 return _core_
.Window_SetConstraints(*args
, **kwargs
)
9985 def GetConstraints(*args
, **kwargs
):
9987 GetConstraints(self) -> LayoutConstraints
9989 Returns a pointer to the window's layout constraints, or None if there
9992 return _core_
.Window_GetConstraints(*args
, **kwargs
)
9994 def SetAutoLayout(*args
, **kwargs
):
9996 SetAutoLayout(self, bool autoLayout)
9998 Determines whether the Layout function will be called automatically
9999 when the window is resized. It is called implicitly by SetSizer but
10000 if you use SetConstraints you should call it manually or otherwise the
10001 window layout won't be correctly updated when its size changes.
10003 return _core_
.Window_SetAutoLayout(*args
, **kwargs
)
10005 def GetAutoLayout(*args
, **kwargs
):
10007 GetAutoLayout(self) -> bool
10009 Returns the current autoLayout setting
10011 return _core_
.Window_GetAutoLayout(*args
, **kwargs
)
10013 def Layout(*args
, **kwargs
):
10015 Layout(self) -> bool
10017 Invokes the constraint-based layout algorithm or the sizer-based
10018 algorithm for this window. See SetAutoLayout: when auto layout is on,
10019 this function gets called automatically by the default EVT_SIZE
10020 handler when the window is resized.
10022 return _core_
.Window_Layout(*args
, **kwargs
)
10024 def SetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
10026 SetSizer(self, Sizer sizer, bool deleteOld=True)
10028 Sets the window to have the given layout sizer. The window will then
10029 own the object, and will take care of its deletion. If an existing
10030 layout sizer object is already owned by the window, it will be deleted
10031 if the deleteOld parameter is true. Note that this function will also
10032 call SetAutoLayout implicitly with a True parameter if the sizer is
10033 non-None, and False otherwise.
10035 return _core_
.Window_SetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
10037 def SetSizerAndFit(*args
, **kwargs
):
10039 SetSizerAndFit(self, Sizer sizer, bool deleteOld=True)
10041 The same as SetSizer, except it also sets the size hints for the
10042 window based on the sizer's minimum size.
10044 return _core_
.Window_SetSizerAndFit(*args
, **kwargs
)
10046 def GetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
10048 GetSizer(self) -> Sizer
10050 Return the sizer associated with the window by a previous call to
10051 SetSizer or None if there isn't one.
10053 return _core_
.Window_GetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
10055 def SetContainingSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
10057 SetContainingSizer(self, Sizer sizer)
10059 This normally does not need to be called by application code. It is
10060 called internally when a window is added to a sizer, and is used so
10061 the window can remove itself from the sizer when it is destroyed.
10063 return _core_
.Window_SetContainingSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
10065 def GetContainingSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
10067 GetContainingSizer(self) -> Sizer
10069 Return the sizer that this window is a member of, if any, otherwise None.
10071 return _core_
.Window_GetContainingSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
10073 def InheritAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
):
10075 InheritAttributes(self)
10077 This function is (or should be, in case of custom controls) called
10078 during window creation to intelligently set up the window visual
10079 attributes, that is the font and the foreground and background
10082 By 'intelligently' the following is meant: by default, all windows use
10083 their own default attributes. However if some of the parent's
10084 attributes are explicitly changed (that is, using SetFont and not
10085 SetOwnFont) and if the corresponding attribute hadn't been
10086 explicitly set for this window itself, then this window takes the same
10087 value as used by the parent. In addition, if the window overrides
10088 ShouldInheritColours to return false, the colours will not be changed
10089 no matter what and only the font might.
10091 This rather complicated logic is necessary in order to accommodate the
10092 different usage scenarios. The most common one is when all default
10093 attributes are used and in this case, nothing should be inherited as
10094 in modern GUIs different controls use different fonts (and colours)
10095 than their siblings so they can't inherit the same value from the
10096 parent. However it was also deemed desirable to allow to simply change
10097 the attributes of all children at once by just changing the font or
10098 colour of their common parent, hence in this case we do inherit the
10099 parents attributes.
10102 return _core_
.Window_InheritAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
)
10104 def ShouldInheritColours(*args
, **kwargs
):
10106 ShouldInheritColours(self) -> bool
10108 Return true from here to allow the colours of this window to be
10109 changed by InheritAttributes, returning false forbids inheriting them
10110 from the parent window.
10112 The base class version returns false, but this method is overridden in
10113 wxControl where it returns true.
10115 return _core_
.Window_ShouldInheritColours(*args
, **kwargs
)
10117 def PostCreate(self
, pre
):
10119 Phase 3 of the 2-phase create <wink!>
10120 Call this method after precreating the window with the 2-phase create method.
10122 self
.this
= pre
.this
10123 self
.thisown
= pre
.thisown
10125 if hasattr(self
, '_setOORInfo'):
10126 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
10127 if hasattr(self
, '_setCallbackInfo'):
10128 self
._setCallbackInfo
(self
, self
.__class
__)
10131 class WindowPtr(Window
):
10132 def __init__(self
, this
):
10134 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
10135 self
.__class
__ = Window
10136 _core_
.Window_swigregister(WindowPtr
)
10138 def PreWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
10140 PreWindow() -> Window
10142 Precreate a Window for 2-phase creation.
10144 val
= _core_
.new_PreWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
10148 def Window_NewControlId(*args
, **kwargs
):
10150 Window_NewControlId() -> int
10152 Generate a control id for the controls which were not given one.
10154 return _core_
.Window_NewControlId(*args
, **kwargs
)
10156 def Window_NextControlId(*args
, **kwargs
):
10158 Window_NextControlId(int winid) -> int
10160 Get the id of the control following the one with the given
10163 return _core_
.Window_NextControlId(*args
, **kwargs
)
10165 def Window_PrevControlId(*args
, **kwargs
):
10167 Window_PrevControlId(int winid) -> int
10169 Get the id of the control preceding the one with the given
10172 return _core_
.Window_PrevControlId(*args
, **kwargs
)
10174 def Window_FindFocus(*args
, **kwargs
):
10176 Window_FindFocus() -> Window
10178 Returns the window or control that currently has the keyboard focus,
10181 return _core_
.Window_FindFocus(*args
, **kwargs
)
10183 def Window_GetCapture(*args
, **kwargs
):
10185 Window_GetCapture() -> Window
10187 Returns the window which currently captures the mouse or None
10189 return _core_
.Window_GetCapture(*args
, **kwargs
)
10191 def Window_GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
):
10193 Window_GetClassDefaultAttributes(int variant=WINDOW_VARIANT_NORMAL) -> VisualAttributes
10195 Get the default attributes for this class. This is useful if you want
10196 to use the same font or colour in your own control as in a standard
10197 control -- which is a much better idea than hard coding specific
10198 colours or fonts which might look completely out of place on the
10199 user's system, especially if it uses themes.
10201 The variant parameter is only relevant under Mac currently and is
10202 ignore under other platforms. Under Mac, it will change the size of
10203 the returned font. See `wx.Window.SetWindowVariant` for more about
10206 return _core_
.Window_GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
)
10208 def DLG_PNT(win
, point_or_x
, y
=None):
10210 Convenience function for converting a Point or (x,y) in
10211 dialog units to pixel units.
10214 return win
.ConvertDialogPointToPixels(point_or_x
)
10216 return win
.ConvertDialogPointToPixels(wx
.Point(point_or_x
, y
))
10218 def DLG_SZE(win
, size_width
, height
=None):
10220 Convenience function for converting a Size or (w,h) in
10221 dialog units to pixel units.
10224 return win
.ConvertDialogSizeToPixels(size_width
)
10226 return win
.ConvertDialogSizeToPixels(wx
.Size(size_width
, height
))
10229 def FindWindowById(*args
, **kwargs
):
10231 FindWindowById(long id, Window parent=None) -> Window
10233 Find the first window in the application with the given id. If parent
10234 is None, the search will start from all top-level frames and dialog
10235 boxes; if non-None, the search will be limited to the given window
10236 hierarchy. The search is recursive in both cases.
10238 return _core_
.FindWindowById(*args
, **kwargs
)
10240 def FindWindowByName(*args
, **kwargs
):
10242 FindWindowByName(String name, Window parent=None) -> Window
10244 Find a window by its name (as given in a window constructor or Create
10245 function call). If parent is None, the search will start from all
10246 top-level frames and dialog boxes; if non-None, the search will be
10247 limited to the given window hierarchy. The search is recursive in both
10250 If no window with such name is found, wx.FindWindowByLabel is called.
10252 return _core_
.FindWindowByName(*args
, **kwargs
)
10254 def FindWindowByLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10256 FindWindowByLabel(String label, Window parent=None) -> Window
10258 Find a window by its label. Depending on the type of window, the label
10259 may be a window title or panel item label. If parent is None, the
10260 search will start from all top-level frames and dialog boxes; if
10261 non-None, the search will be limited to the given window
10262 hierarchy. The search is recursive in both cases.
10264 return _core_
.FindWindowByLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10266 def Window_FromHWND(*args
, **kwargs
):
10267 """Window_FromHWND(Window parent, unsigned long _hWnd) -> Window"""
10268 return _core_
.Window_FromHWND(*args
, **kwargs
)
10270 def GetTopLevelWindows(*args
, **kwargs
):
10272 GetTopLevelWindows() -> PyObject
10274 Returns a list of the the application's top-level windows, (frames,
10275 dialogs, etc.) NOTE: Currently this is a copy of the list maintained
10276 by wxWidgets, and so it is only valid as long as no top-level windows
10277 are closed or new top-level windows are created.
10280 return _core_
.GetTopLevelWindows(*args
, **kwargs
)
10281 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
10283 class Validator(EvtHandler
):
10284 """Proxy of C++ Validator class"""
10285 def __repr__(self
):
10286 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxValidator instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
10287 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
10288 """__init__(self) -> Validator"""
10289 newobj
= _core_
.new_Validator(*args
, **kwargs
)
10290 self
.this
= newobj
.this
10293 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
10295 def Clone(*args
, **kwargs
):
10296 """Clone(self) -> Validator"""
10297 return _core_
.Validator_Clone(*args
, **kwargs
)
10299 def Validate(*args
, **kwargs
):
10300 """Validate(self, Window parent) -> bool"""
10301 return _core_
.Validator_Validate(*args
, **kwargs
)
10303 def TransferToWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
10304 """TransferToWindow(self) -> bool"""
10305 return _core_
.Validator_TransferToWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
10307 def TransferFromWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
10308 """TransferFromWindow(self) -> bool"""
10309 return _core_
.Validator_TransferFromWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
10311 def GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
10312 """GetWindow(self) -> Window"""
10313 return _core_
.Validator_GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
10315 def SetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
10316 """SetWindow(self, Window window)"""
10317 return _core_
.Validator_SetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
10319 def IsSilent(*args
, **kwargs
):
10320 """IsSilent() -> bool"""
10321 return _core_
.Validator_IsSilent(*args
, **kwargs
)
10323 IsSilent
= staticmethod(IsSilent
)
10324 def SetBellOnError(*args
, **kwargs
):
10325 """SetBellOnError(int doIt=True)"""
10326 return _core_
.Validator_SetBellOnError(*args
, **kwargs
)
10328 SetBellOnError
= staticmethod(SetBellOnError
)
10330 class ValidatorPtr(Validator
):
10331 def __init__(self
, this
):
10333 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
10334 self
.__class
__ = Validator
10335 _core_
.Validator_swigregister(ValidatorPtr
)
10337 def Validator_IsSilent(*args
, **kwargs
):
10338 """Validator_IsSilent() -> bool"""
10339 return _core_
.Validator_IsSilent(*args
, **kwargs
)
10341 def Validator_SetBellOnError(*args
, **kwargs
):
10342 """Validator_SetBellOnError(int doIt=True)"""
10343 return _core_
.Validator_SetBellOnError(*args
, **kwargs
)
10345 class PyValidator(Validator
):
10346 """Proxy of C++ PyValidator class"""
10347 def __repr__(self
):
10348 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPyValidator instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
10349 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
10350 """__init__(self) -> PyValidator"""
10351 newobj
= _core_
.new_PyValidator(*args
, **kwargs
)
10352 self
.this
= newobj
.this
10356 self
._setCallbackInfo
(self
, PyValidator
, 1)
10357 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
10359 def _setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
):
10360 """_setCallbackInfo(self, PyObject self, PyObject _class, int incref=True)"""
10361 return _core_
.PyValidator__setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
)
10364 class PyValidatorPtr(PyValidator
):
10365 def __init__(self
, this
):
10367 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
10368 self
.__class
__ = PyValidator
10369 _core_
.PyValidator_swigregister(PyValidatorPtr
)
10371 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
10373 class Menu(EvtHandler
):
10374 """Proxy of C++ Menu class"""
10375 def __repr__(self
):
10376 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMenu instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
10377 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
10378 """__init__(self, String title=EmptyString, long style=0) -> Menu"""
10379 newobj
= _core_
.new_Menu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10380 self
.this
= newobj
.this
10383 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
10385 def Append(*args
, **kwargs
):
10386 """Append(self, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString, int kind=ITEM_NORMAL) -> MenuItem"""
10387 return _core_
.Menu_Append(*args
, **kwargs
)
10389 def AppendSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
):
10390 """AppendSeparator(self) -> MenuItem"""
10391 return _core_
.Menu_AppendSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
)
10393 def AppendCheckItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10394 """AppendCheckItem(self, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10395 return _core_
.Menu_AppendCheckItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10397 def AppendRadioItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10398 """AppendRadioItem(self, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10399 return _core_
.Menu_AppendRadioItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10401 def AppendMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10402 """AppendMenu(self, int id, String text, Menu submenu, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10403 return _core_
.Menu_AppendMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10405 def AppendItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10406 """AppendItem(self, MenuItem item) -> MenuItem"""
10407 return _core_
.Menu_AppendItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10409 def Break(*args
, **kwargs
):
10411 return _core_
.Menu_Break(*args
, **kwargs
)
10413 def InsertItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10414 """InsertItem(self, size_t pos, MenuItem item) -> MenuItem"""
10415 return _core_
.Menu_InsertItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10417 def Insert(*args
, **kwargs
):
10419 Insert(self, size_t pos, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString,
10420 int kind=ITEM_NORMAL) -> MenuItem
10422 return _core_
.Menu_Insert(*args
, **kwargs
)
10424 def InsertSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
):
10425 """InsertSeparator(self, size_t pos) -> MenuItem"""
10426 return _core_
.Menu_InsertSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
)
10428 def InsertCheckItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10429 """InsertCheckItem(self, size_t pos, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10430 return _core_
.Menu_InsertCheckItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10432 def InsertRadioItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10433 """InsertRadioItem(self, size_t pos, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10434 return _core_
.Menu_InsertRadioItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10436 def InsertMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10437 """InsertMenu(self, size_t pos, int id, String text, Menu submenu, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10438 return _core_
.Menu_InsertMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10440 def PrependItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10441 """PrependItem(self, MenuItem item) -> MenuItem"""
10442 return _core_
.Menu_PrependItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10444 def Prepend(*args
, **kwargs
):
10445 """Prepend(self, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString, int kind=ITEM_NORMAL) -> MenuItem"""
10446 return _core_
.Menu_Prepend(*args
, **kwargs
)
10448 def PrependSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
):
10449 """PrependSeparator(self) -> MenuItem"""
10450 return _core_
.Menu_PrependSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
)
10452 def PrependCheckItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10453 """PrependCheckItem(self, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10454 return _core_
.Menu_PrependCheckItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10456 def PrependRadioItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10457 """PrependRadioItem(self, int id, String text, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10458 return _core_
.Menu_PrependRadioItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10460 def PrependMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10461 """PrependMenu(self, int id, String text, Menu submenu, String help=EmptyString) -> MenuItem"""
10462 return _core_
.Menu_PrependMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10464 def Remove(*args
, **kwargs
):
10465 """Remove(self, int id) -> MenuItem"""
10466 return _core_
.Menu_Remove(*args
, **kwargs
)
10468 def RemoveItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10469 """RemoveItem(self, MenuItem item) -> MenuItem"""
10470 return _core_
.Menu_RemoveItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10472 def Delete(*args
, **kwargs
):
10473 """Delete(self, int id) -> bool"""
10474 return _core_
.Menu_Delete(*args
, **kwargs
)
10476 def DeleteItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10477 """DeleteItem(self, MenuItem item) -> bool"""
10478 return _core_
.Menu_DeleteItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10480 def Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
):
10484 Deletes the C++ object this Python object is a proxy for.
10486 return _core_
.Menu_Destroy(*args
, **kwargs
)
10488 def DestroyId(*args
, **kwargs
):
10490 DestroyId(self, int id) -> bool
10492 Deletes the C++ object this Python object is a proxy for.
10494 return _core_
.Menu_DestroyId(*args
, **kwargs
)
10496 def DestroyItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10498 DestroyItem(self, MenuItem item) -> bool
10500 Deletes the C++ object this Python object is a proxy for.
10502 return _core_
.Menu_DestroyItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10504 def GetMenuItemCount(*args
, **kwargs
):
10505 """GetMenuItemCount(self) -> size_t"""
10506 return _core_
.Menu_GetMenuItemCount(*args
, **kwargs
)
10508 def GetMenuItems(*args
, **kwargs
):
10509 """GetMenuItems(self) -> PyObject"""
10510 return _core_
.Menu_GetMenuItems(*args
, **kwargs
)
10512 def FindItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10513 """FindItem(self, String item) -> int"""
10514 return _core_
.Menu_FindItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10516 def FindItemById(*args
, **kwargs
):
10517 """FindItemById(self, int id) -> MenuItem"""
10518 return _core_
.Menu_FindItemById(*args
, **kwargs
)
10520 def FindItemByPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
10521 """FindItemByPosition(self, size_t position) -> MenuItem"""
10522 return _core_
.Menu_FindItemByPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
10524 def Enable(*args
, **kwargs
):
10525 """Enable(self, int id, bool enable)"""
10526 return _core_
.Menu_Enable(*args
, **kwargs
)
10528 def IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
10529 """IsEnabled(self, int id) -> bool"""
10530 return _core_
.Menu_IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
10532 def Check(*args
, **kwargs
):
10533 """Check(self, int id, bool check)"""
10534 return _core_
.Menu_Check(*args
, **kwargs
)
10536 def IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
):
10537 """IsChecked(self, int id) -> bool"""
10538 return _core_
.Menu_IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
)
10540 def SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10541 """SetLabel(self, int id, String label)"""
10542 return _core_
.Menu_SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10544 def GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10545 """GetLabel(self, int id) -> String"""
10546 return _core_
.Menu_GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10548 def SetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
):
10549 """SetHelpString(self, int id, String helpString)"""
10550 return _core_
.Menu_SetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
)
10552 def GetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
):
10553 """GetHelpString(self, int id) -> String"""
10554 return _core_
.Menu_GetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
)
10556 def SetTitle(*args
, **kwargs
):
10557 """SetTitle(self, String title)"""
10558 return _core_
.Menu_SetTitle(*args
, **kwargs
)
10560 def GetTitle(*args
, **kwargs
):
10561 """GetTitle(self) -> String"""
10562 return _core_
.Menu_GetTitle(*args
, **kwargs
)
10564 def SetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
10565 """SetEventHandler(self, EvtHandler handler)"""
10566 return _core_
.Menu_SetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
10568 def GetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
):
10569 """GetEventHandler(self) -> EvtHandler"""
10570 return _core_
.Menu_GetEventHandler(*args
, **kwargs
)
10572 def SetInvokingWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
10573 """SetInvokingWindow(self, Window win)"""
10574 return _core_
.Menu_SetInvokingWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
10576 def GetInvokingWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
10577 """GetInvokingWindow(self) -> Window"""
10578 return _core_
.Menu_GetInvokingWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
10580 def GetStyle(*args
, **kwargs
):
10581 """GetStyle(self) -> long"""
10582 return _core_
.Menu_GetStyle(*args
, **kwargs
)
10584 def UpdateUI(*args
, **kwargs
):
10585 """UpdateUI(self, EvtHandler source=None)"""
10586 return _core_
.Menu_UpdateUI(*args
, **kwargs
)
10588 def GetMenuBar(*args
, **kwargs
):
10589 """GetMenuBar(self) -> MenuBar"""
10590 return _core_
.Menu_GetMenuBar(*args
, **kwargs
)
10592 def Attach(*args
, **kwargs
):
10593 """Attach(self, wxMenuBarBase menubar)"""
10594 return _core_
.Menu_Attach(*args
, **kwargs
)
10596 def Detach(*args
, **kwargs
):
10598 return _core_
.Menu_Detach(*args
, **kwargs
)
10600 def IsAttached(*args
, **kwargs
):
10601 """IsAttached(self) -> bool"""
10602 return _core_
.Menu_IsAttached(*args
, **kwargs
)
10604 def SetParent(*args
, **kwargs
):
10605 """SetParent(self, Menu parent)"""
10606 return _core_
.Menu_SetParent(*args
, **kwargs
)
10608 def GetParent(*args
, **kwargs
):
10609 """GetParent(self) -> Menu"""
10610 return _core_
.Menu_GetParent(*args
, **kwargs
)
10613 class MenuPtr(Menu
):
10614 def __init__(self
, this
):
10616 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
10617 self
.__class
__ = Menu
10618 _core_
.Menu_swigregister(MenuPtr
)
10619 DefaultValidator
= cvar
.DefaultValidator
10621 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
10623 class MenuBar(Window
):
10624 """Proxy of C++ MenuBar class"""
10625 def __repr__(self
):
10626 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMenuBar instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
10627 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
10628 """__init__(self, long style=0) -> MenuBar"""
10629 newobj
= _core_
.new_MenuBar(*args
, **kwargs
)
10630 self
.this
= newobj
.this
10633 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
10635 def Append(*args
, **kwargs
):
10636 """Append(self, Menu menu, String title) -> bool"""
10637 return _core_
.MenuBar_Append(*args
, **kwargs
)
10639 def Insert(*args
, **kwargs
):
10640 """Insert(self, size_t pos, Menu menu, String title) -> bool"""
10641 return _core_
.MenuBar_Insert(*args
, **kwargs
)
10643 def GetMenuCount(*args
, **kwargs
):
10644 """GetMenuCount(self) -> size_t"""
10645 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetMenuCount(*args
, **kwargs
)
10647 def GetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10648 """GetMenu(self, size_t pos) -> Menu"""
10649 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10651 def Replace(*args
, **kwargs
):
10652 """Replace(self, size_t pos, Menu menu, String title) -> Menu"""
10653 return _core_
.MenuBar_Replace(*args
, **kwargs
)
10655 def Remove(*args
, **kwargs
):
10656 """Remove(self, size_t pos) -> Menu"""
10657 return _core_
.MenuBar_Remove(*args
, **kwargs
)
10659 def EnableTop(*args
, **kwargs
):
10660 """EnableTop(self, size_t pos, bool enable)"""
10661 return _core_
.MenuBar_EnableTop(*args
, **kwargs
)
10663 def IsEnabledTop(*args
, **kwargs
):
10664 """IsEnabledTop(self, size_t pos) -> bool"""
10665 return _core_
.MenuBar_IsEnabledTop(*args
, **kwargs
)
10667 def SetLabelTop(*args
, **kwargs
):
10668 """SetLabelTop(self, size_t pos, String label)"""
10669 return _core_
.MenuBar_SetLabelTop(*args
, **kwargs
)
10671 def GetLabelTop(*args
, **kwargs
):
10672 """GetLabelTop(self, size_t pos) -> String"""
10673 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetLabelTop(*args
, **kwargs
)
10675 def FindMenuItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
10676 """FindMenuItem(self, String menu, String item) -> int"""
10677 return _core_
.MenuBar_FindMenuItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10679 def FindItemById(*args
, **kwargs
):
10680 """FindItemById(self, int id) -> MenuItem"""
10681 return _core_
.MenuBar_FindItemById(*args
, **kwargs
)
10683 def FindMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10684 """FindMenu(self, String title) -> int"""
10685 return _core_
.MenuBar_FindMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10687 def Enable(*args
, **kwargs
):
10688 """Enable(self, int id, bool enable)"""
10689 return _core_
.MenuBar_Enable(*args
, **kwargs
)
10691 def Check(*args
, **kwargs
):
10692 """Check(self, int id, bool check)"""
10693 return _core_
.MenuBar_Check(*args
, **kwargs
)
10695 def IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
):
10696 """IsChecked(self, int id) -> bool"""
10697 return _core_
.MenuBar_IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
)
10699 def IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
10700 """IsEnabled(self, int id) -> bool"""
10701 return _core_
.MenuBar_IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
10703 def SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10704 """SetLabel(self, int id, String label)"""
10705 return _core_
.MenuBar_SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10707 def GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10708 """GetLabel(self, int id) -> String"""
10709 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10711 def SetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
):
10712 """SetHelpString(self, int id, String helpString)"""
10713 return _core_
.MenuBar_SetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
)
10715 def GetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
):
10716 """GetHelpString(self, int id) -> String"""
10717 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetHelpString(*args
, **kwargs
)
10719 def GetFrame(*args
, **kwargs
):
10720 """GetFrame(self) -> wxFrame"""
10721 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetFrame(*args
, **kwargs
)
10723 def IsAttached(*args
, **kwargs
):
10724 """IsAttached(self) -> bool"""
10725 return _core_
.MenuBar_IsAttached(*args
, **kwargs
)
10727 def Attach(*args
, **kwargs
):
10728 """Attach(self, wxFrame frame)"""
10729 return _core_
.MenuBar_Attach(*args
, **kwargs
)
10731 def Detach(*args
, **kwargs
):
10733 return _core_
.MenuBar_Detach(*args
, **kwargs
)
10735 def SetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10736 """SetAutoWindowMenu(bool enable)"""
10737 return _core_
.MenuBar_SetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10739 SetAutoWindowMenu
= staticmethod(SetAutoWindowMenu
)
10740 def GetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10741 """GetAutoWindowMenu() -> bool"""
10742 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10744 GetAutoWindowMenu
= staticmethod(GetAutoWindowMenu
)
10746 class MenuBarPtr(MenuBar
):
10747 def __init__(self
, this
):
10749 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
10750 self
.__class
__ = MenuBar
10751 _core_
.MenuBar_swigregister(MenuBarPtr
)
10753 def MenuBar_SetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10754 """MenuBar_SetAutoWindowMenu(bool enable)"""
10755 return _core_
.MenuBar_SetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10757 def MenuBar_GetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10758 """MenuBar_GetAutoWindowMenu() -> bool"""
10759 return _core_
.MenuBar_GetAutoWindowMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10761 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
10763 class MenuItem(Object
):
10764 """Proxy of C++ MenuItem class"""
10765 def __repr__(self
):
10766 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxMenuItem instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
10767 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
10769 __init__(self, Menu parentMenu=None, int id=ID_ANY, String text=EmptyString,
10770 String help=EmptyString, int kind=ITEM_NORMAL,
10771 Menu subMenu=None) -> MenuItem
10773 newobj
= _core_
.new_MenuItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
10774 self
.this
= newobj
.this
10777 def GetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10778 """GetMenu(self) -> Menu"""
10779 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10781 def SetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10782 """SetMenu(self, Menu menu)"""
10783 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10785 def SetId(*args
, **kwargs
):
10786 """SetId(self, int id)"""
10787 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetId(*args
, **kwargs
)
10789 def GetId(*args
, **kwargs
):
10790 """GetId(self) -> int"""
10791 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetId(*args
, **kwargs
)
10793 def IsSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
):
10794 """IsSeparator(self) -> bool"""
10795 return _core_
.MenuItem_IsSeparator(*args
, **kwargs
)
10797 def SetText(*args
, **kwargs
):
10798 """SetText(self, String str)"""
10799 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetText(*args
, **kwargs
)
10801 def GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10802 """GetLabel(self) -> String"""
10803 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10805 def GetText(*args
, **kwargs
):
10806 """GetText(self) -> String"""
10807 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetText(*args
, **kwargs
)
10809 def GetLabelFromText(*args
, **kwargs
):
10810 """GetLabelFromText(String text) -> String"""
10811 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetLabelFromText(*args
, **kwargs
)
10813 GetLabelFromText
= staticmethod(GetLabelFromText
)
10814 def GetKind(*args
, **kwargs
):
10815 """GetKind(self) -> int"""
10816 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetKind(*args
, **kwargs
)
10818 def SetKind(*args
, **kwargs
):
10819 """SetKind(self, int kind)"""
10820 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetKind(*args
, **kwargs
)
10822 def SetCheckable(*args
, **kwargs
):
10823 """SetCheckable(self, bool checkable)"""
10824 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetCheckable(*args
, **kwargs
)
10826 def IsCheckable(*args
, **kwargs
):
10827 """IsCheckable(self) -> bool"""
10828 return _core_
.MenuItem_IsCheckable(*args
, **kwargs
)
10830 def IsSubMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10831 """IsSubMenu(self) -> bool"""
10832 return _core_
.MenuItem_IsSubMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10834 def SetSubMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10835 """SetSubMenu(self, Menu menu)"""
10836 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetSubMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10838 def GetSubMenu(*args
, **kwargs
):
10839 """GetSubMenu(self) -> Menu"""
10840 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetSubMenu(*args
, **kwargs
)
10842 def Enable(*args
, **kwargs
):
10843 """Enable(self, bool enable=True)"""
10844 return _core_
.MenuItem_Enable(*args
, **kwargs
)
10846 def IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
):
10847 """IsEnabled(self) -> bool"""
10848 return _core_
.MenuItem_IsEnabled(*args
, **kwargs
)
10850 def Check(*args
, **kwargs
):
10851 """Check(self, bool check=True)"""
10852 return _core_
.MenuItem_Check(*args
, **kwargs
)
10854 def IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
):
10855 """IsChecked(self) -> bool"""
10856 return _core_
.MenuItem_IsChecked(*args
, **kwargs
)
10858 def Toggle(*args
, **kwargs
):
10860 return _core_
.MenuItem_Toggle(*args
, **kwargs
)
10862 def SetHelp(*args
, **kwargs
):
10863 """SetHelp(self, String str)"""
10864 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetHelp(*args
, **kwargs
)
10866 def GetHelp(*args
, **kwargs
):
10867 """GetHelp(self) -> String"""
10868 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetHelp(*args
, **kwargs
)
10870 def GetAccel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10871 """GetAccel(self) -> AcceleratorEntry"""
10872 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetAccel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10874 def SetAccel(*args
, **kwargs
):
10875 """SetAccel(self, AcceleratorEntry accel)"""
10876 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetAccel(*args
, **kwargs
)
10878 def SetFont(*args
, **kwargs
):
10879 """SetFont(self, Font font)"""
10880 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetFont(*args
, **kwargs
)
10882 def GetFont(*args
, **kwargs
):
10883 """GetFont(self) -> Font"""
10884 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetFont(*args
, **kwargs
)
10886 def SetTextColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
10887 """SetTextColour(self, Colour colText)"""
10888 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetTextColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
10890 def GetTextColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
10891 """GetTextColour(self) -> Colour"""
10892 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetTextColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
10894 def SetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
10895 """SetBackgroundColour(self, Colour colBack)"""
10896 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
10898 def GetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
):
10899 """GetBackgroundColour(self) -> Colour"""
10900 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetBackgroundColour(*args
, **kwargs
)
10902 def SetBitmaps(*args
, **kwargs
):
10903 """SetBitmaps(self, Bitmap bmpChecked, Bitmap bmpUnchecked=wxNullBitmap)"""
10904 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetBitmaps(*args
, **kwargs
)
10906 def SetDisabledBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
10907 """SetDisabledBitmap(self, Bitmap bmpDisabled)"""
10908 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetDisabledBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
)
10910 def GetDisabledBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
10911 """GetDisabledBitmap(self) -> Bitmap"""
10912 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetDisabledBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
)
10914 def SetMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
10915 """SetMarginWidth(self, int nWidth)"""
10916 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
10918 def GetMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
10919 """GetMarginWidth(self) -> int"""
10920 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
10922 def GetDefaultMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
10923 """GetDefaultMarginWidth() -> int"""
10924 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetDefaultMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
10926 GetDefaultMarginWidth
= staticmethod(GetDefaultMarginWidth
)
10927 def IsOwnerDrawn(*args
, **kwargs
):
10928 """IsOwnerDrawn(self) -> bool"""
10929 return _core_
.MenuItem_IsOwnerDrawn(*args
, **kwargs
)
10931 def SetOwnerDrawn(*args
, **kwargs
):
10932 """SetOwnerDrawn(self, bool ownerDrawn=True)"""
10933 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetOwnerDrawn(*args
, **kwargs
)
10935 def ResetOwnerDrawn(*args
, **kwargs
):
10936 """ResetOwnerDrawn(self)"""
10937 return _core_
.MenuItem_ResetOwnerDrawn(*args
, **kwargs
)
10939 def SetBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
10940 """SetBitmap(self, Bitmap bitmap)"""
10941 return _core_
.MenuItem_SetBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
)
10943 def GetBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
):
10944 """GetBitmap(self) -> Bitmap"""
10945 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetBitmap(*args
, **kwargs
)
10948 class MenuItemPtr(MenuItem
):
10949 def __init__(self
, this
):
10951 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
10952 self
.__class
__ = MenuItem
10953 _core_
.MenuItem_swigregister(MenuItemPtr
)
10955 def MenuItem_GetLabelFromText(*args
, **kwargs
):
10956 """MenuItem_GetLabelFromText(String text) -> String"""
10957 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetLabelFromText(*args
, **kwargs
)
10959 def MenuItem_GetDefaultMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
):
10960 """MenuItem_GetDefaultMarginWidth() -> int"""
10961 return _core_
.MenuItem_GetDefaultMarginWidth(*args
, **kwargs
)
10963 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
10965 class Control(Window
):
10967 This is the base class for a control or 'widget'.
10969 A control is generally a small window which processes user input
10970 and/or displays one or more item of data.
10972 def __repr__(self
):
10973 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxControl instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
10974 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
10976 __init__(self, Window parent, int id=-1, Point pos=DefaultPosition,
10977 Size size=DefaultSize, long style=0, Validator validator=DefaultValidator,
10978 String name=ControlNameStr) -> Control
10980 Create a Control. Normally you should only call this from a subclass'
10981 __init__ as a plain old wx.Control is not very useful.
10983 newobj
= _core_
.new_Control(*args
, **kwargs
)
10984 self
.this
= newobj
.this
10987 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
10989 def Create(*args
, **kwargs
):
10991 Create(self, Window parent, int id=-1, Point pos=DefaultPosition,
10992 Size size=DefaultSize, long style=0, Validator validator=DefaultValidator,
10993 String name=ControlNameStr) -> bool
10995 Do the 2nd phase and create the GUI control.
10997 return _core_
.Control_Create(*args
, **kwargs
)
10999 def Command(*args
, **kwargs
):
11001 Command(self, CommandEvent event)
11003 Simulates the effect of the user issuing a command to the item.
11005 :see: `wx.CommandEvent`
11008 return _core_
.Control_Command(*args
, **kwargs
)
11010 def GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
11012 GetLabel(self) -> String
11014 Return a control's text.
11016 return _core_
.Control_GetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
11018 def SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
):
11020 SetLabel(self, String label)
11022 Sets the item's text.
11024 return _core_
.Control_SetLabel(*args
, **kwargs
)
11026 def GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
):
11028 GetClassDefaultAttributes(int variant=WINDOW_VARIANT_NORMAL) -> VisualAttributes
11030 Get the default attributes for this class. This is useful if you want
11031 to use the same font or colour in your own control as in a standard
11032 control -- which is a much better idea than hard coding specific
11033 colours or fonts which might look completely out of place on the
11034 user's system, especially if it uses themes.
11036 The variant parameter is only relevant under Mac currently and is
11037 ignore under other platforms. Under Mac, it will change the size of
11038 the returned font. See `wx.Window.SetWindowVariant` for more about
11041 return _core_
.Control_GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
)
11043 GetClassDefaultAttributes
= staticmethod(GetClassDefaultAttributes
)
11045 class ControlPtr(Control
):
11046 def __init__(self
, this
):
11048 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
11049 self
.__class
__ = Control
11050 _core_
.Control_swigregister(ControlPtr
)
11051 ControlNameStr
= cvar
.ControlNameStr
11053 def PreControl(*args
, **kwargs
):
11055 PreControl() -> Control
11057 Precreate a Control control for 2-phase creation
11059 val
= _core_
.new_PreControl(*args
, **kwargs
)
11063 def Control_GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
):
11065 Control_GetClassDefaultAttributes(int variant=WINDOW_VARIANT_NORMAL) -> VisualAttributes
11067 Get the default attributes for this class. This is useful if you want
11068 to use the same font or colour in your own control as in a standard
11069 control -- which is a much better idea than hard coding specific
11070 colours or fonts which might look completely out of place on the
11071 user's system, especially if it uses themes.
11073 The variant parameter is only relevant under Mac currently and is
11074 ignore under other platforms. Under Mac, it will change the size of
11075 the returned font. See `wx.Window.SetWindowVariant` for more about
11078 return _core_
.Control_GetClassDefaultAttributes(*args
, **kwargs
)
11080 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
11082 class ItemContainer(object):
11084 The wx.ItemContainer class defines an interface which is implemented
11085 by all controls which have string subitems, each of which may be
11086 selected, such as `wx.ListBox`, `wx.CheckListBox`, `wx.Choice` as well
11087 as `wx.ComboBox` which implements an extended interface deriving from
11090 It defines the methods for accessing the control's items and although
11091 each of the derived classes implements them differently, they still
11092 all conform to the same interface.
11094 The items in a wx.ItemContainer have (non empty) string labels and,
11095 optionally, client data associated with them.
11098 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
11099 def __repr__(self
):
11100 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxItemContainer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
11101 def Append(*args
, **kwargs
):
11103 Append(self, String item, PyObject clientData=None) -> int
11105 Adds the item to the control, associating the given data with the item
11106 if not None. The return value is the index of the newly added item
11107 which may be different from the last one if the control is sorted (e.g.
11108 has wx.LB_SORT or wx.CB_SORT style).
11110 return _core_
.ItemContainer_Append(*args
, **kwargs
)
11112 def AppendItems(*args
, **kwargs
):
11114 AppendItems(self, List strings)
11116 Apend several items at once to the control. Notice that calling this
11117 method may be much faster than appending the items one by one if you
11118 need to add a lot of items.
11120 return _core_
.ItemContainer_AppendItems(*args
, **kwargs
)
11122 def Insert(*args
, **kwargs
):
11124 Insert(self, String item, int pos, PyObject clientData=None) -> int
11126 Insert an item into the control before the item at the ``pos`` index,
11127 optionally associating some data object with the item.
11129 return _core_
.ItemContainer_Insert(*args
, **kwargs
)
11131 def Clear(*args
, **kwargs
):
11135 Removes all items from the control.
11137 return _core_
.ItemContainer_Clear(*args
, **kwargs
)
11139 def Delete(*args
, **kwargs
):
11141 Delete(self, int n)
11143 Deletes the item at the zero-based index 'n' from the control. Note
11144 that it is an error (signalled by a `wx.PyAssertionError` exception if
11145 enabled) to remove an item with the index negative or greater or equal
11146 than the number of items in the control.
11148 return _core_
.ItemContainer_Delete(*args
, **kwargs
)
11150 def GetClientData(*args
, **kwargs
):
11152 GetClientData(self, int n) -> PyObject
11154 Returns the client data associated with the given item, (if any.)
11156 return _core_
.ItemContainer_GetClientData(*args
, **kwargs
)
11158 def SetClientData(*args
, **kwargs
):
11160 SetClientData(self, int n, PyObject clientData)
11162 Associate the given client data with the item at position n.
11164 return _core_
.ItemContainer_SetClientData(*args
, **kwargs
)
11166 def GetCount(*args
, **kwargs
):
11168 GetCount(self) -> int
11170 Returns the number of items in the control.
11172 return _core_
.ItemContainer_GetCount(*args
, **kwargs
)
11174 def IsEmpty(*args
, **kwargs
):
11176 IsEmpty(self) -> bool
11178 Returns True if the control is empty or False if it has some items.
11180 return _core_
.ItemContainer_IsEmpty(*args
, **kwargs
)
11182 def GetString(*args
, **kwargs
):
11184 GetString(self, int n) -> String
11186 Returns the label of the item with the given index.
11188 return _core_
.ItemContainer_GetString(*args
, **kwargs
)
11190 def GetStrings(*args
, **kwargs
):
11191 """GetStrings(self) -> wxArrayString"""
11192 return _core_
.ItemContainer_GetStrings(*args
, **kwargs
)
11194 def SetString(*args
, **kwargs
):
11196 SetString(self, int n, String s)
11198 Sets the label for the given item.
11200 return _core_
.ItemContainer_SetString(*args
, **kwargs
)
11202 def FindString(*args
, **kwargs
):
11204 FindString(self, String s) -> int
11206 Finds an item whose label matches the given string. Returns the
11207 zero-based position of the item, or ``wx.NOT_FOUND`` if the string was not
11210 return _core_
.ItemContainer_FindString(*args
, **kwargs
)
11212 def SetSelection(*args
, **kwargs
):
11214 SetSelection(self, int n)
11216 Sets the item at index 'n' to be the selected item.
11218 return _core_
.ItemContainer_SetSelection(*args
, **kwargs
)
11220 def GetSelection(*args
, **kwargs
):
11222 GetSelection(self) -> int
11224 Returns the index of the selected item or ``wx.NOT_FOUND`` if no item
11227 return _core_
.ItemContainer_GetSelection(*args
, **kwargs
)
11229 def SetStringSelection(*args
, **kwargs
):
11230 """SetStringSelection(self, String s) -> bool"""
11231 return _core_
.ItemContainer_SetStringSelection(*args
, **kwargs
)
11233 def GetStringSelection(*args
, **kwargs
):
11235 GetStringSelection(self) -> String
11237 Returns the label of the selected item or an empty string if no item
11240 return _core_
.ItemContainer_GetStringSelection(*args
, **kwargs
)
11242 def Select(*args
, **kwargs
):
11244 Select(self, int n)
11246 This is the same as `SetSelection` and exists only because it is
11247 slightly more natural for controls which support multiple selection.
11249 return _core_
.ItemContainer_Select(*args
, **kwargs
)
11252 class ItemContainerPtr(ItemContainer
):
11253 def __init__(self
, this
):
11255 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
11256 self
.__class
__ = ItemContainer
11257 _core_
.ItemContainer_swigregister(ItemContainerPtr
)
11259 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
11261 class ControlWithItems(Control
,ItemContainer
):
11263 wx.ControlWithItems combines the ``wx.ItemContainer`` class with the
11264 wx.Control class, and is used for the base class of various controls
11267 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
11268 def __repr__(self
):
11269 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxControlWithItems instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
11271 class ControlWithItemsPtr(ControlWithItems
):
11272 def __init__(self
, this
):
11274 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
11275 self
.__class
__ = ControlWithItems
11276 _core_
.ControlWithItems_swigregister(ControlWithItemsPtr
)
11278 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
11280 class SizerItem(Object
):
11282 The wx.SizerItem class is used to track the position, size and other
11283 attributes of each item managed by a `wx.Sizer`. In normal usage user
11284 code should never need to deal directly with a wx.SizerItem, but
11285 custom classes derived from `wx.PySizer` will probably need to use the
11286 collection of wx.SizerItems held by wx.Sizer when calculating layout.
11288 :see: `wx.Sizer`, `wx.GBSizerItem`
11290 def __repr__(self
):
11291 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxSizerItem instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
11292 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
11294 __init__(self) -> SizerItem
11296 Constructs an empty wx.SizerItem. Either a window, sizer or spacer
11297 size will need to be set before this item can be used in a Sizer.
11299 You will probably never need to create a wx.SizerItem directly as they
11300 are created automatically when the sizer's Add, Insert or Prepend
11301 methods are called.
11303 :see: `wx.SizerItemSpacer`, `wx.SizerItemWindow`, `wx.SizerItemSizer`
11305 newobj
= _core_
.new_SizerItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
11306 self
.this
= newobj
.this
11309 def DeleteWindows(*args
, **kwargs
):
11311 DeleteWindows(self)
11313 Destroy the window or the windows in a subsizer, depending on the type
11316 return _core_
.SizerItem_DeleteWindows(*args
, **kwargs
)
11318 def DetachSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11322 Enable deleting the SizerItem without destroying the contained sizer.
11324 return _core_
.SizerItem_DetachSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11326 def GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11328 GetSize(self) -> Size
11330 Get the current size of the item, as set in the last Layout.
11332 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11334 def CalcMin(*args
, **kwargs
):
11336 CalcMin(self) -> Size
11338 Calculates the minimum desired size for the item, including any space
11341 return _core_
.SizerItem_CalcMin(*args
, **kwargs
)
11343 def SetDimension(*args
, **kwargs
):
11345 SetDimension(self, Point pos, Size size)
11347 Set the position and size of the space allocated for this item by the
11348 sizer, and adjust the position and size of the item (window or
11349 subsizer) to be within that space taking alignment and borders into
11352 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetDimension(*args
, **kwargs
)
11354 def GetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11356 GetMinSize(self) -> Size
11358 Get the minimum size needed for the item.
11360 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11362 def GetMinSizeWithBorder(*args
, **kwargs
):
11364 GetMinSizeWithBorder(self) -> Size
11366 Get the minimum size needed for the item with space for the borders
11369 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetMinSizeWithBorder(*args
, **kwargs
)
11371 def SetInitSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11372 """SetInitSize(self, int x, int y)"""
11373 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetInitSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11375 def SetRatioWH(*args
, **kwargs
):
11377 SetRatioWH(self, int width, int height)
11379 Set the ratio item attribute.
11381 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetRatioWH(*args
, **kwargs
)
11383 def SetRatioSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11385 SetRatioSize(self, Size size)
11387 Set the ratio item attribute.
11389 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetRatioSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11391 def SetRatio(*args
, **kwargs
):
11393 SetRatio(self, float ratio)
11395 Set the ratio item attribute.
11397 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetRatio(*args
, **kwargs
)
11399 def GetRatio(*args
, **kwargs
):
11401 GetRatio(self) -> float
11403 Set the ratio item attribute.
11405 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetRatio(*args
, **kwargs
)
11407 def GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
):
11409 GetRect(self) -> Rect
11411 Returns the rectangle that the sizer item should occupy
11413 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetRect(*args
, **kwargs
)
11415 def IsWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
11417 IsWindow(self) -> bool
11419 Is this sizer item a window?
11421 return _core_
.SizerItem_IsWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
11423 def IsSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11425 IsSizer(self) -> bool
11427 Is this sizer item a subsizer?
11429 return _core_
.SizerItem_IsSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11431 def IsSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11433 IsSpacer(self) -> bool
11435 Is this sizer item a spacer?
11437 return _core_
.SizerItem_IsSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11439 def SetProportion(*args
, **kwargs
):
11441 SetProportion(self, int proportion)
11443 Set the proportion value for this item.
11445 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetProportion(*args
, **kwargs
)
11447 def GetProportion(*args
, **kwargs
):
11449 GetProportion(self) -> int
11451 Get the proportion value for this item.
11453 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetProportion(*args
, **kwargs
)
11455 SetOption
= wx
._deprecated
(SetProportion
, "Please use `SetProportion` instead.")
11456 GetOption
= wx
._deprecated
(GetProportion
, "Please use `GetProportion` instead.")
11457 def SetFlag(*args
, **kwargs
):
11459 SetFlag(self, int flag)
11461 Set the flag value for this item.
11463 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetFlag(*args
, **kwargs
)
11465 def GetFlag(*args
, **kwargs
):
11467 GetFlag(self) -> int
11469 Get the flag value for this item.
11471 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetFlag(*args
, **kwargs
)
11473 def SetBorder(*args
, **kwargs
):
11475 SetBorder(self, int border)
11477 Set the border value for this item.
11479 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetBorder(*args
, **kwargs
)
11481 def GetBorder(*args
, **kwargs
):
11483 GetBorder(self) -> int
11485 Get the border value for this item.
11487 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetBorder(*args
, **kwargs
)
11489 def GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
11491 GetWindow(self) -> Window
11493 Get the window (if any) that is managed by this sizer item.
11495 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
11497 def SetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
11499 SetWindow(self, Window window)
11501 Set the window to be managed by this sizer item.
11503 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
11505 def GetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11507 GetSizer(self) -> Sizer
11509 Get the subsizer (if any) that is managed by this sizer item.
11511 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11513 def SetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11515 SetSizer(self, Sizer sizer)
11517 Set the subsizer to be managed by this sizer item.
11519 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11521 def GetSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11523 GetSpacer(self) -> Size
11525 Get the size of the spacer managed by this sizer item.
11527 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11529 def SetSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11531 SetSpacer(self, Size size)
11533 Set the size of the spacer to be managed by this sizer item.
11535 return _core_
.SizerItem_SetSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11537 def Show(*args
, **kwargs
):
11539 Show(self, bool show)
11541 Set the show item attribute, which sizers use to determine if the item
11542 is to be made part of the layout or not. If the item is tracking a
11543 window then it is shown or hidden as needed.
11545 return _core_
.SizerItem_Show(*args
, **kwargs
)
11547 def IsShown(*args
, **kwargs
):
11549 IsShown(self) -> bool
11551 Is the item to be shown in the layout?
11553 return _core_
.SizerItem_IsShown(*args
, **kwargs
)
11555 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
11557 GetPosition(self) -> Point
11559 Returns the current position of the item, as set in the last Layout.
11561 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
11563 def GetUserData(*args
, **kwargs
):
11565 GetUserData(self) -> PyObject
11567 Returns the userData associated with this sizer item, or None if there
11570 return _core_
.SizerItem_GetUserData(*args
, **kwargs
)
11573 class SizerItemPtr(SizerItem
):
11574 def __init__(self
, this
):
11576 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
11577 self
.__class
__ = SizerItem
11578 _core_
.SizerItem_swigregister(SizerItemPtr
)
11580 def SizerItemWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
11582 SizerItemWindow(Window window, int proportion, int flag, int border,
11583 PyObject userData=None) -> SizerItem
11585 Constructs a `wx.SizerItem` for tracking a window.
11587 val
= _core_
.new_SizerItemWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
11591 def SizerItemSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11593 SizerItemSpacer(int width, int height, int proportion, int flag, int border,
11594 PyObject userData=None) -> SizerItem
11596 Constructs a `wx.SizerItem` for tracking a spacer.
11598 val
= _core_
.new_SizerItemSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11602 def SizerItemSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
11604 SizerItemSizer(Sizer sizer, int proportion, int flag, int border,
11605 PyObject userData=None) -> SizerItem
11607 Constructs a `wx.SizerItem` for tracking a subsizer
11609 val
= _core_
.new_SizerItemSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
11613 class Sizer(Object
):
11615 wx.Sizer is the abstract base class used for laying out subwindows in
11616 a window. You cannot use wx.Sizer directly; instead, you will have to
11617 use one of the sizer classes derived from it such as `wx.BoxSizer`,
11618 `wx.StaticBoxSizer`, `wx.NotebookSizer`, `wx.GridSizer`, `wx.FlexGridSizer`
11619 and `wx.GridBagSizer`.
11621 The concept implemented by sizers in wxWidgets is closely related to
11622 layout tools in other GUI toolkits, such as Java's AWT, the GTK
11623 toolkit or the Qt toolkit. It is based upon the idea of the individual
11624 subwindows reporting their minimal required size and their ability to
11625 get stretched if the size of the parent window has changed. This will
11626 most often mean that the programmer does not set the original size of
11627 a dialog in the beginning, rather the dialog will assigned a sizer and
11628 this sizer will be queried about the recommended size. The sizer in
11629 turn will query its children, which can be normal windows or contorls,
11630 empty space or other sizers, so that a hierarchy of sizers can be
11631 constructed. Note that wxSizer does not derive from wxWindow and thus
11632 do not interfere with tab ordering and requires very little resources
11633 compared to a real window on screen.
11635 What makes sizers so well fitted for use in wxWidgets is the fact that
11636 every control reports its own minimal size and the algorithm can
11637 handle differences in font sizes or different window (dialog item)
11638 sizes on different platforms without problems. If for example the
11639 standard font as well as the overall design of Mac widgets requires
11640 more space than on Windows, then the initial size of a dialog using a
11641 sizer will automatically be bigger on Mac than on Windows.
11643 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
11644 def __repr__(self
):
11645 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxSizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
11646 def _setOORInfo(*args
, **kwargs
):
11647 """_setOORInfo(self, PyObject _self)"""
11648 return _core_
.Sizer__setOORInfo(*args
, **kwargs
)
11650 def Add(*args
, **kwargs
):
11652 Add(self, item, int proportion=0, int flag=0, int border=0,
11653 PyObject userData=None) -> wx.SizerItem
11655 Appends a child item to the sizer.
11657 return _core_
.Sizer_Add(*args
, **kwargs
)
11659 def Insert(*args
, **kwargs
):
11661 Insert(self, int before, item, int proportion=0, int flag=0, int border=0,
11662 PyObject userData=None) -> wx.SizerItem
11664 Inserts a new item into the list of items managed by this sizer before
11665 the item at index *before*. See `Add` for a description of the parameters.
11667 return _core_
.Sizer_Insert(*args
, **kwargs
)
11669 def Prepend(*args
, **kwargs
):
11671 Prepend(self, item, int proportion=0, int flag=0, int border=0,
11672 PyObject userData=None) -> wx.SizerItem
11674 Adds a new item to the begining of the list of sizer items managed by
11675 this sizer. See `Add` for a description of the parameters.
11677 return _core_
.Sizer_Prepend(*args
, **kwargs
)
11679 def Remove(*args
, **kwargs
):
11681 Remove(self, item) -> bool
11683 Removes an item from the sizer and destroys it. This method does not
11684 cause any layout or resizing to take place, call `Layout` to update
11685 the layout on screen after removing a child from the sizer. The
11686 *item* parameter can be either a window, a sizer, or the zero-based
11687 index of an item to remove. Returns True if the child item was found
11690 return _core_
.Sizer_Remove(*args
, **kwargs
)
11692 def Detach(*args
, **kwargs
):
11694 Detach(self, item) -> bool
11696 Detaches an item from the sizer without destroying it. This method
11697 does not cause any layout or resizing to take place, call `Layout` to
11698 do so. The *item* parameter can be either a window, a sizer, or the
11699 zero-based index of the item to be detached. Returns True if the child item
11700 was found and detached.
11702 return _core_
.Sizer_Detach(*args
, **kwargs
)
11704 def GetItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
11706 GetItem(self, item) -> wx.SizerItem
11708 Returns the `wx.SizerItem` which holds the *item* given. The *item*
11709 parameter can be either a window, a sizer, or the zero-based index of
11710 the item to be found.
11712 return _core_
.Sizer_GetItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
11714 def _SetItemMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11715 """_SetItemMinSize(self, PyObject item, Size size)"""
11716 return _core_
.Sizer__SetItemMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11718 def SetItemMinSize(self
, item
, *args
):
11720 SetItemMinSize(self, item, Size size)
11722 Sets the minimum size that will be allocated for an item in the sizer.
11723 The *item* parameter can be either a window, a sizer, or the
11724 zero-based index of the item. If a window or sizer is given then it
11725 will be searched for recursivly in subsizers if neccessary.
11728 # for backward compatibility accept separate width,height args too
11729 return self
._SetItemMinSize
(item
, args
)
11731 return self
._SetItemMinSize
(item
, args
[0])
11733 def AddItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
11735 AddItem(self, SizerItem item)
11737 Adds a `wx.SizerItem` to the sizer.
11739 return _core_
.Sizer_AddItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
11741 def InsertItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
11743 InsertItem(self, int index, SizerItem item)
11745 Inserts a `wx.SizerItem` to the sizer at the position given by *index*.
11747 return _core_
.Sizer_InsertItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
11749 def PrependItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
11751 PrependItem(self, SizerItem item)
11753 Prepends a `wx.SizerItem` to the sizer.
11755 return _core_
.Sizer_PrependItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
11757 def AddMany(self
, items
):
11759 AddMany is a convenience method for adding several items
11760 to a sizer at one time. Simply pass it a list of tuples,
11761 where each tuple consists of the parameters that you
11762 would normally pass to the `Add` method.
11765 if type(item
) != type(()) or (len(item
) == 2 and type(item
[0]) == type(1)):
11769 # for backwards compatibility only, please do not use in new code
11770 def AddWindow(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11771 """Compatibility alias for `Add`."""
11772 return self
.Add(*args
, **kw
)
11773 def AddSizer(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11774 """Compatibility alias for `Add`."""
11775 return self
.Add(*args
, **kw
)
11776 def AddSpacer(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11777 """Compatibility alias for `Add`."""
11778 return self
.Add(*args
, **kw
)
11780 def PrependWindow(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11781 """Compatibility alias for `Prepend`."""
11782 return self
.Prepend(*args
, **kw
)
11783 def PrependSizer(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11784 """Compatibility alias for `Prepend`."""
11785 return self
.Prepend(*args
, **kw
)
11786 def PrependSpacer(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11787 """Compatibility alias for `Prepend`."""
11788 return self
.Prepend(*args
, **kw
)
11790 def InsertWindow(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11791 """Compatibility alias for `Insert`."""
11792 return self
.Insert(*args
, **kw
)
11793 def InsertSizer(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11794 """Compatibility alias for `Insert`."""
11795 return self
.Insert(*args
, **kw
)
11796 def InsertSpacer(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11797 """Compatibility alias for `Insert`."""
11798 return self
.Insert(*args
, **kw
)
11800 def RemoveWindow(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11801 """Compatibility alias for `Remove`."""
11802 return self
.Remove(*args
, **kw
)
11803 def RemoveSizer(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11804 """Compatibility alias for `Remove`."""
11805 return self
.Remove(*args
, **kw
)
11806 def RemovePos(self
, *args
, **kw
):
11807 """Compatibility alias for `Remove`."""
11808 return self
.Remove(*args
, **kw
)
11811 def SetDimension(*args
, **kwargs
):
11813 SetDimension(self, int x, int y, int width, int height)
11815 Call this to force the sizer to take the given dimension and thus
11816 force the items owned by the sizer to resize themselves according to
11817 the rules defined by the parameter in the `Add`, `Insert` or `Prepend`
11820 return _core_
.Sizer_SetDimension(*args
, **kwargs
)
11822 def SetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11824 SetMinSize(self, Size size)
11826 Call this to give the sizer a minimal size. Normally, the sizer will
11827 calculate its minimal size based purely on how much space its children
11828 need. After calling this method `GetMinSize` will return either the
11829 minimal size as requested by its children or the minimal size set
11830 here, depending on which is bigger.
11832 return _core_
.Sizer_SetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11834 def GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11836 GetSize(self) -> Size
11838 Returns the current size of the space managed by the sizer.
11840 return _core_
.Sizer_GetSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11842 def GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
11844 GetPosition(self) -> Point
11846 Returns the current position of the sizer's managed space.
11848 return _core_
.Sizer_GetPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
11850 def GetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
11852 GetMinSize(self) -> Size
11854 Returns the minimal size of the sizer. This is either the combined
11855 minimal size of all the children and their borders or the minimal size
11856 set by SetMinSize, depending on which is bigger.
11858 return _core_
.Sizer_GetMinSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
11860 def GetSizeTuple(self
):
11861 return self
.GetSize().Get()
11862 def GetPositionTuple(self
):
11863 return self
.GetPosition().Get()
11864 def GetMinSizeTuple(self
):
11865 return self
.GetMinSize().Get()
11867 def RecalcSizes(*args
, **kwargs
):
11871 Using the sizes calculated by `CalcMin` reposition and resize all the
11872 items managed by this sizer. You should not need to call this directly as
11873 it is called by `Layout`.
11875 return _core_
.Sizer_RecalcSizes(*args
, **kwargs
)
11877 def CalcMin(*args
, **kwargs
):
11879 CalcMin(self) -> Size
11881 This method is where the sizer will do the actual calculation of its
11882 children's minimal sizes. You should not need to call this directly as
11883 it is called by `Layout`.
11885 return _core_
.Sizer_CalcMin(*args
, **kwargs
)
11887 def Layout(*args
, **kwargs
):
11891 This method will force the recalculation and layout of the items
11892 controlled by the sizer using the current space allocated to the
11893 sizer. Normally this is called automatically from the owning window's
11894 EVT_SIZE handler, but it is also useful to call it from user code when
11895 one of the items in a sizer change size, or items are added or
11898 return _core_
.Sizer_Layout(*args
, **kwargs
)
11900 def Fit(*args
, **kwargs
):
11902 Fit(self, Window window) -> Size
11904 Tell the sizer to resize the *window* to match the sizer's minimal
11905 size. This is commonly done in the constructor of the window itself in
11906 order to set its initial size to match the needs of the children as
11907 determined by the sizer. Returns the new size.
11909 For a top level window this is the total window size, not the client size.
11911 return _core_
.Sizer_Fit(*args
, **kwargs
)
11913 def FitInside(*args
, **kwargs
):
11915 FitInside(self, Window window)
11917 Tell the sizer to resize the *virtual size* of the *window* to match the
11918 sizer's minimal size. This will not alter the on screen size of the
11919 window, but may cause the addition/removal/alteration of scrollbars
11920 required to view the virtual area in windows which manage it.
11922 :see: `wx.ScrolledWindow.SetScrollbars`, `SetVirtualSizeHints`
11925 return _core_
.Sizer_FitInside(*args
, **kwargs
)
11927 def SetSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
):
11929 SetSizeHints(self, Window window)
11931 Tell the sizer to set (and `Fit`) the minimal size of the *window* to
11932 match the sizer's minimal size. This is commonly done in the
11933 constructor of the window itself if the window is resizable (as are
11934 many dialogs under Unix and frames on probably all platforms) in order
11935 to prevent the window from being sized smaller than the minimal size
11936 required by the sizer.
11938 return _core_
.Sizer_SetSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
)
11940 def SetVirtualSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
):
11942 SetVirtualSizeHints(self, Window window)
11944 Tell the sizer to set the minimal size of the window virtual area to
11945 match the sizer's minimal size. For windows with managed scrollbars
11946 this will set them appropriately.
11948 :see: `wx.ScrolledWindow.SetScrollbars`
11951 return _core_
.Sizer_SetVirtualSizeHints(*args
, **kwargs
)
11953 def Clear(*args
, **kwargs
):
11955 Clear(self, bool deleteWindows=False)
11957 Clear all items from the sizer, optionally destroying the window items
11960 return _core_
.Sizer_Clear(*args
, **kwargs
)
11962 def DeleteWindows(*args
, **kwargs
):
11964 DeleteWindows(self)
11966 Destroy all windows managed by the sizer.
11968 return _core_
.Sizer_DeleteWindows(*args
, **kwargs
)
11970 def GetChildren(*args
, **kwargs
):
11972 GetChildren(self) -> list
11974 Returns a list of all the `wx.SizerItem` objects managed by the sizer.
11976 return _core_
.Sizer_GetChildren(*args
, **kwargs
)
11978 def Show(*args
, **kwargs
):
11980 Show(self, item, bool show=True, bool recursive=false) -> bool
11982 Shows or hides an item managed by the sizer. To make a sizer item
11983 disappear or reappear, use Show followed by `Layout`. The *item*
11984 parameter can be either a window, a sizer, or the zero-based index of
11985 the item. Use the recursive parameter to show or hide an item in a
11986 subsizer. Returns True if the item was found.
11988 return _core_
.Sizer_Show(*args
, **kwargs
)
11990 def IsShown(*args
, **kwargs
):
11992 IsShown(self, item)
11994 Determines if the item is currently shown. sizer. To make a sizer
11995 item disappear or reappear, use Show followed by `Layout`. The *item*
11996 parameter can be either a window, a sizer, or the zero-based index of
11999 return _core_
.Sizer_IsShown(*args
, **kwargs
)
12001 def Hide(self
, item
, recursive
=False):
12003 A convenience method for `Show` (item, False, recursive).
12005 return self
.Show(item
, False, recursive
)
12007 def ShowItems(*args
, **kwargs
):
12009 ShowItems(self, bool show)
12011 Recursively call `wx.SizerItem.Show` on all sizer items.
12013 return _core_
.Sizer_ShowItems(*args
, **kwargs
)
12016 class SizerPtr(Sizer
):
12017 def __init__(self
, this
):
12019 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12020 self
.__class
__ = Sizer
12021 _core_
.Sizer_swigregister(SizerPtr
)
12023 class PySizer(Sizer
):
12025 wx.PySizer is a special version of `wx.Sizer` that has been
12026 instrumented to allow the C++ virtual methods to be overloaded in
12027 Python derived classes. You would derive from this class if you are
12028 wanting to implement a custom sizer in Python code. Simply implement
12029 `CalcMin` and `RecalcSizes` in the derived class and you're all set.
12032 class MySizer(wx.PySizer):
12033 def __init__(self):
12034 wx.PySizer.__init__(self)
12037 for item in self.GetChildren():
12038 # calculate the total minimum width and height needed
12039 # by all items in the sizer according to this sizer's
12040 # layout algorithm.
12042 return wx.Size(width, height)
12044 def RecalcSizes(self):
12045 # find the space allotted to this sizer
12046 pos = self.GetPosition()
12047 size = self.GetSize()
12048 for item in self.GetChildren():
12049 # Recalculate (if necessary) the position and size of
12050 # each item and then call item.SetDimension to do the
12051 # actual positioning and sizing of the items within the
12052 # space alloted to this sizer.
12054 item.SetDimension(itemPos, itemSize)
12057 When `Layout` is called it first calls `CalcMin` followed by
12058 `RecalcSizes` so you can optimize a bit by saving the results of
12059 `CalcMin` and reusing them in `RecalcSizes`.
12061 :see: `wx.SizerItem`, `wx.Sizer.GetChildren`
12065 def __repr__(self
):
12066 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxPySizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12067 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12069 __init__(self) -> PySizer
12071 Creates a wx.PySizer. Must be called from the __init__ in the derived
12074 newobj
= _core_
.new_PySizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12075 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12078 self
._setCallbackInfo
(self
, PySizer
);self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
12080 def _setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
):
12081 """_setCallbackInfo(self, PyObject self, PyObject _class)"""
12082 return _core_
.PySizer__setCallbackInfo(*args
, **kwargs
)
12085 class PySizerPtr(PySizer
):
12086 def __init__(self
, this
):
12088 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12089 self
.__class
__ = PySizer
12090 _core_
.PySizer_swigregister(PySizerPtr
)
12092 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
12094 class BoxSizer(Sizer
):
12096 The basic idea behind a box sizer is that windows will most often be
12097 laid out in rather simple basic geometry, typically in a row or a
12098 column or nested hierarchies of either. A wx.BoxSizer will lay out
12099 its items in a simple row or column, depending on the orientation
12100 parameter passed to the constructor.
12102 def __repr__(self
):
12103 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxBoxSizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12104 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12106 __init__(self, int orient=HORIZONTAL) -> BoxSizer
12108 Constructor for a wx.BoxSizer. *orient* may be one of ``wx.VERTICAL``
12109 or ``wx.HORIZONTAL`` for creating either a column sizer or a row
12112 newobj
= _core_
.new_BoxSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12113 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12116 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
12118 def GetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
):
12120 GetOrientation(self) -> int
12122 Returns the current orientation of the sizer.
12124 return _core_
.BoxSizer_GetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
)
12126 def SetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
):
12128 SetOrientation(self, int orient)
12130 Resets the orientation of the sizer.
12132 return _core_
.BoxSizer_SetOrientation(*args
, **kwargs
)
12135 class BoxSizerPtr(BoxSizer
):
12136 def __init__(self
, this
):
12138 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12139 self
.__class
__ = BoxSizer
12140 _core_
.BoxSizer_swigregister(BoxSizerPtr
)
12142 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
12144 class StaticBoxSizer(BoxSizer
):
12146 wx.StaticBoxSizer derives from and functions identically to the
12147 `wx.BoxSizer` and adds a `wx.StaticBox` around the items that the sizer
12148 manages. Note that this static box must be created separately and
12149 passed to the sizer constructor.
12151 def __repr__(self
):
12152 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxStaticBoxSizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12153 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12155 __init__(self, StaticBox box, int orient=HORIZONTAL) -> StaticBoxSizer
12157 Constructor. It takes an associated static box and the orientation
12158 *orient* as parameters - orient can be either of ``wx.VERTICAL`` or
12161 newobj
= _core_
.new_StaticBoxSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12162 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12165 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
12167 def GetStaticBox(*args
, **kwargs
):
12169 GetStaticBox(self) -> StaticBox
12171 Returns the static box associated with this sizer.
12173 return _core_
.StaticBoxSizer_GetStaticBox(*args
, **kwargs
)
12176 class StaticBoxSizerPtr(StaticBoxSizer
):
12177 def __init__(self
, this
):
12179 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12180 self
.__class
__ = StaticBoxSizer
12181 _core_
.StaticBoxSizer_swigregister(StaticBoxSizerPtr
)
12183 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
12185 class GridSizer(Sizer
):
12187 A grid sizer is a sizer which lays out its children in a
12188 two-dimensional table with all cells having the same size. In other
12189 words, the width of each cell within the grid is the width of the
12190 widest item added to the sizer and the height of each grid cell is the
12191 height of the tallest item. An optional vertical and/or horizontal
12192 gap between items can also be specified (in pixels.)
12194 Items are placed in the cells of the grid in the order they are added,
12195 in row-major order. In other words, the first row is filled first,
12196 then the second, and so on until all items have been added. (If
12197 neccessary, additional rows will be added as items are added.) If you
12198 need to have greater control over the cells that items are placed in
12199 then use the `wx.GridBagSizer`.
12202 def __repr__(self
):
12203 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxGridSizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12204 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12206 __init__(self, int rows=1, int cols=0, int vgap=0, int hgap=0) -> GridSizer
12208 Constructor for a wx.GridSizer. *rows* and *cols* determine the number
12209 of columns and rows in the sizer - if either of the parameters is
12210 zero, it will be calculated to from the total number of children in
12211 the sizer, thus making the sizer grow dynamically. *vgap* and *hgap*
12212 define extra space between all children.
12214 newobj
= _core_
.new_GridSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12215 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12218 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
12220 def SetCols(*args
, **kwargs
):
12222 SetCols(self, int cols)
12224 Sets the number of columns in the sizer.
12226 return _core_
.GridSizer_SetCols(*args
, **kwargs
)
12228 def SetRows(*args
, **kwargs
):
12230 SetRows(self, int rows)
12232 Sets the number of rows in the sizer.
12234 return _core_
.GridSizer_SetRows(*args
, **kwargs
)
12236 def SetVGap(*args
, **kwargs
):
12238 SetVGap(self, int gap)
12240 Sets the vertical gap (in pixels) between the cells in the sizer.
12242 return _core_
.GridSizer_SetVGap(*args
, **kwargs
)
12244 def SetHGap(*args
, **kwargs
):
12246 SetHGap(self, int gap)
12248 Sets the horizontal gap (in pixels) between cells in the sizer
12250 return _core_
.GridSizer_SetHGap(*args
, **kwargs
)
12252 def GetCols(*args
, **kwargs
):
12254 GetCols(self) -> int
12256 Returns the number of columns in the sizer.
12258 return _core_
.GridSizer_GetCols(*args
, **kwargs
)
12260 def GetRows(*args
, **kwargs
):
12262 GetRows(self) -> int
12264 Returns the number of rows in the sizer.
12266 return _core_
.GridSizer_GetRows(*args
, **kwargs
)
12268 def GetVGap(*args
, **kwargs
):
12270 GetVGap(self) -> int
12272 Returns the vertical gap (in pixels) between the cells in the sizer.
12274 return _core_
.GridSizer_GetVGap(*args
, **kwargs
)
12276 def GetHGap(*args
, **kwargs
):
12278 GetHGap(self) -> int
12280 Returns the horizontal gap (in pixels) between cells in the sizer.
12282 return _core_
.GridSizer_GetHGap(*args
, **kwargs
)
12285 class GridSizerPtr(GridSizer
):
12286 def __init__(self
, this
):
12288 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12289 self
.__class
__ = GridSizer
12290 _core_
.GridSizer_swigregister(GridSizerPtr
)
12292 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
12294 FLEX_GROWMODE_NONE
= _core_
.FLEX_GROWMODE_NONE
12295 FLEX_GROWMODE_SPECIFIED
= _core_
.FLEX_GROWMODE_SPECIFIED
12296 FLEX_GROWMODE_ALL
= _core_
.FLEX_GROWMODE_ALL
12297 class FlexGridSizer(GridSizer
):
12299 A flex grid sizer is a sizer which lays out its children in a
12300 two-dimensional table with all table cells in one row having the same
12301 height and all cells in one column having the same width, but all
12302 rows or all columns are not necessarily the same height or width as in
12303 the `wx.GridSizer`.
12305 wx.FlexGridSizer can also size items equally in one direction but
12306 unequally ("flexibly") in the other. If the sizer is only flexible
12307 in one direction (this can be changed using `SetFlexibleDirection`), it
12308 needs to be decided how the sizer should grow in the other ("non
12309 flexible") direction in order to fill the available space. The
12310 `SetNonFlexibleGrowMode` method serves this purpose.
12314 def __repr__(self
):
12315 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxFlexGridSizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12316 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12318 __init__(self, int rows=1, int cols=0, int vgap=0, int hgap=0) -> FlexGridSizer
12320 Constructor for a wx.FlexGridSizer. *rows* and *cols* determine the
12321 number of columns and rows in the sizer - if either of the parameters
12322 is zero, it will be calculated to from the total number of children in
12323 the sizer, thus making the sizer grow dynamically. *vgap* and *hgap*
12324 define extra space between all children.
12326 newobj
= _core_
.new_FlexGridSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12327 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12330 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
12332 def AddGrowableRow(*args
, **kwargs
):
12334 AddGrowableRow(self, size_t idx, int proportion=0)
12336 Specifies that row *idx* (starting from zero) should be grown if there
12337 is extra space available to the sizer.
12339 The *proportion* parameter has the same meaning as the stretch factor
12340 for the box sizers except that if all proportions are 0, then all
12341 columns are resized equally (instead of not being resized at all).
12343 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_AddGrowableRow(*args
, **kwargs
)
12345 def RemoveGrowableRow(*args
, **kwargs
):
12347 RemoveGrowableRow(self, size_t idx)
12349 Specifies that row *idx* is no longer growable.
12351 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_RemoveGrowableRow(*args
, **kwargs
)
12353 def AddGrowableCol(*args
, **kwargs
):
12355 AddGrowableCol(self, size_t idx, int proportion=0)
12357 Specifies that column *idx* (starting from zero) should be grown if
12358 there is extra space available to the sizer.
12360 The *proportion* parameter has the same meaning as the stretch factor
12361 for the box sizers except that if all proportions are 0, then all
12362 columns are resized equally (instead of not being resized at all).
12364 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_AddGrowableCol(*args
, **kwargs
)
12366 def RemoveGrowableCol(*args
, **kwargs
):
12368 RemoveGrowableCol(self, size_t idx)
12370 Specifies that column *idx* is no longer growable.
12372 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_RemoveGrowableCol(*args
, **kwargs
)
12374 def SetFlexibleDirection(*args
, **kwargs
):
12376 SetFlexibleDirection(self, int direction)
12378 Specifies whether the sizer should flexibly resize its columns, rows,
12379 or both. Argument *direction* can be one of the following values. Any
12380 other value is ignored.
12382 ============== =======================================
12383 wx.VERTICAL Rows are flexibly sized.
12384 wx.HORIZONTAL Columns are flexibly sized.
12385 wx.BOTH Both rows and columns are flexibly sized
12386 (this is the default value).
12387 ============== =======================================
12389 Note that this method does not trigger relayout.
12392 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_SetFlexibleDirection(*args
, **kwargs
)
12394 def GetFlexibleDirection(*args
, **kwargs
):
12396 GetFlexibleDirection(self) -> int
12398 Returns a value that specifies whether the sizer
12399 flexibly resizes its columns, rows, or both (default).
12401 :see: `SetFlexibleDirection`
12403 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_GetFlexibleDirection(*args
, **kwargs
)
12405 def SetNonFlexibleGrowMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
12407 SetNonFlexibleGrowMode(self, int mode)
12409 Specifies how the sizer should grow in the non-flexible direction if
12410 there is one (so `SetFlexibleDirection` must have been called
12411 previously). Argument *mode* can be one of the following values:
12413 ========================== =================================================
12414 wx.FLEX_GROWMODE_NONE Sizer doesn't grow in the non flexible direction.
12415 wx.FLEX_GROWMODE_SPECIFIED Sizer honors growable columns/rows set with
12416 `AddGrowableCol` and `AddGrowableRow`. In this
12417 case equal sizing applies to minimum sizes of
12418 columns or rows (this is the default value).
12419 wx.FLEX_GROWMODE_ALL Sizer equally stretches all columns or rows in
12420 the non flexible direction, whether they are
12421 growable or not in the flexbile direction.
12422 ========================== =================================================
12424 Note that this method does not trigger relayout.
12428 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_SetNonFlexibleGrowMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
12430 def GetNonFlexibleGrowMode(*args
, **kwargs
):
12432 GetNonFlexibleGrowMode(self) -> int
12434 Returns the value that specifies how the sizer grows in the
12435 non-flexible direction if there is one.
12437 :see: `SetNonFlexibleGrowMode`
12439 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_GetNonFlexibleGrowMode(*args
, **kwargs
)
12441 def GetRowHeights(*args
, **kwargs
):
12443 GetRowHeights(self) -> list
12445 Returns a list of integers representing the heights of each of the
12448 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_GetRowHeights(*args
, **kwargs
)
12450 def GetColWidths(*args
, **kwargs
):
12452 GetColWidths(self) -> list
12454 Returns a list of integers representing the widths of each of the
12455 columns in the sizer.
12457 return _core_
.FlexGridSizer_GetColWidths(*args
, **kwargs
)
12460 class FlexGridSizerPtr(FlexGridSizer
):
12461 def __init__(self
, this
):
12463 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12464 self
.__class
__ = FlexGridSizer
12465 _core_
.FlexGridSizer_swigregister(FlexGridSizerPtr
)
12467 class StdDialogButtonSizer(BoxSizer
):
12469 A special sizer that knows how to order and position standard buttons
12470 in order to conform to the current platform's standards. You simply
12471 need to add each `wx.Button` to the sizer, and be sure to create the
12472 buttons using the standard ID's. Then call `Realize` and the sizer
12473 will take care of the rest.
12476 def __repr__(self
):
12477 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxStdDialogButtonSizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12478 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12479 """__init__(self) -> StdDialogButtonSizer"""
12480 newobj
= _core_
.new_StdDialogButtonSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12481 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12484 def AddButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12486 AddButton(self, wxButton button)
12488 Use this to add the buttons to this sizer. Do not use the `Add`
12489 method in the base class.
12491 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_AddButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12493 def Realize(*args
, **kwargs
):
12497 This funciton needs to be called after all the buttons have been added
12498 to the sizer. It will reorder them and position them in a platform
12501 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_Realize(*args
, **kwargs
)
12503 def SetAffirmativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12504 """SetAffirmativeButton(self, wxButton button)"""
12505 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_SetAffirmativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12507 def SetNegativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12508 """SetNegativeButton(self, wxButton button)"""
12509 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_SetNegativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12511 def SetCancelButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12512 """SetCancelButton(self, wxButton button)"""
12513 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_SetCancelButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12515 def GetAffirmativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12516 """GetAffirmativeButton(self) -> wxButton"""
12517 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_GetAffirmativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12519 def GetApplyButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12520 """GetApplyButton(self) -> wxButton"""
12521 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_GetApplyButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12523 def GetNegativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12524 """GetNegativeButton(self) -> wxButton"""
12525 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_GetNegativeButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12527 def GetCancelButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12528 """GetCancelButton(self) -> wxButton"""
12529 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_GetCancelButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12531 def GetHelpButton(*args
, **kwargs
):
12532 """GetHelpButton(self) -> wxButton"""
12533 return _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_GetHelpButton(*args
, **kwargs
)
12536 class StdDialogButtonSizerPtr(StdDialogButtonSizer
):
12537 def __init__(self
, this
):
12539 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12540 self
.__class
__ = StdDialogButtonSizer
12541 _core_
.StdDialogButtonSizer_swigregister(StdDialogButtonSizerPtr
)
12543 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
12545 class GBPosition(object):
12547 This class represents the position of an item in a virtual grid of
12548 rows and columns managed by a `wx.GridBagSizer`. wxPython has
12549 typemaps that will automatically convert from a 2-element sequence of
12550 integers to a wx.GBPosition, so you can use the more pythonic
12551 representation of the position nearly transparently in Python code.
12553 def __repr__(self
):
12554 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxGBPosition instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12555 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12557 __init__(self, int row=0, int col=0) -> GBPosition
12559 This class represents the position of an item in a virtual grid of
12560 rows and columns managed by a `wx.GridBagSizer`. wxPython has
12561 typemaps that will automatically convert from a 2-element sequence of
12562 integers to a wx.GBPosition, so you can use the more pythonic
12563 representation of the position nearly transparently in Python code.
12565 newobj
= _core_
.new_GBPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
12566 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12569 def GetRow(*args
, **kwargs
):
12570 """GetRow(self) -> int"""
12571 return _core_
.GBPosition_GetRow(*args
, **kwargs
)
12573 def GetCol(*args
, **kwargs
):
12574 """GetCol(self) -> int"""
12575 return _core_
.GBPosition_GetCol(*args
, **kwargs
)
12577 def SetRow(*args
, **kwargs
):
12578 """SetRow(self, int row)"""
12579 return _core_
.GBPosition_SetRow(*args
, **kwargs
)
12581 def SetCol(*args
, **kwargs
):
12582 """SetCol(self, int col)"""
12583 return _core_
.GBPosition_SetCol(*args
, **kwargs
)
12585 def __eq__(*args
, **kwargs
):
12586 """__eq__(self, GBPosition other) -> bool"""
12587 return _core_
.GBPosition___eq__(*args
, **kwargs
)
12589 def __ne__(*args
, **kwargs
):
12590 """__ne__(self, GBPosition other) -> bool"""
12591 return _core_
.GBPosition___ne__(*args
, **kwargs
)
12593 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
12594 """Set(self, int row=0, int col=0)"""
12595 return _core_
.GBPosition_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
12597 def Get(*args
, **kwargs
):
12598 """Get(self) -> PyObject"""
12599 return _core_
.GBPosition_Get(*args
, **kwargs
)
12601 asTuple
= wx
._deprecated
(Get
, "asTuple is deprecated, use `Get` instead")
12602 def __str__(self
): return str(self
.Get())
12603 def __repr__(self
): return 'wx.GBPosition'+str(self
.Get())
12604 def __len__(self
): return len(self
.Get())
12605 def __getitem__(self
, index
): return self
.Get()[index
]
12606 def __setitem__(self
, index
, val
):
12607 if index
== 0: self
.SetRow(val
)
12608 elif index
== 1: self
.SetCol(val
)
12609 else: raise IndexError
12610 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Get() != (0,0)
12611 __safe_for_unpickling__
= True
12612 def __reduce__(self
): return (wx
.GBPosition
, self
.Get())
12614 row
= property(GetRow
, SetRow
)
12615 col
= property(GetCol
, SetCol
)
12618 class GBPositionPtr(GBPosition
):
12619 def __init__(self
, this
):
12621 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12622 self
.__class
__ = GBPosition
12623 _core_
.GBPosition_swigregister(GBPositionPtr
)
12625 class GBSpan(object):
12627 This class is used to hold the row and column spanning attributes of
12628 items in a `wx.GridBagSizer`. wxPython has typemaps that will
12629 automatically convert from a 2-element sequence of integers to a
12630 wx.GBSpan, so you can use the more pythonic representation of the span
12631 nearly transparently in Python code.
12634 def __repr__(self
):
12635 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxGBSpan instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12636 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12638 __init__(self, int rowspan=1, int colspan=1) -> GBSpan
12640 Construct a new wxGBSpan, optionally setting the rowspan and
12641 colspan. The default is (1,1). (Meaning that the item occupies one
12642 cell in each direction.
12644 newobj
= _core_
.new_GBSpan(*args
, **kwargs
)
12645 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12648 def GetRowspan(*args
, **kwargs
):
12649 """GetRowspan(self) -> int"""
12650 return _core_
.GBSpan_GetRowspan(*args
, **kwargs
)
12652 def GetColspan(*args
, **kwargs
):
12653 """GetColspan(self) -> int"""
12654 return _core_
.GBSpan_GetColspan(*args
, **kwargs
)
12656 def SetRowspan(*args
, **kwargs
):
12657 """SetRowspan(self, int rowspan)"""
12658 return _core_
.GBSpan_SetRowspan(*args
, **kwargs
)
12660 def SetColspan(*args
, **kwargs
):
12661 """SetColspan(self, int colspan)"""
12662 return _core_
.GBSpan_SetColspan(*args
, **kwargs
)
12664 def __eq__(*args
, **kwargs
):
12665 """__eq__(self, GBSpan other) -> bool"""
12666 return _core_
.GBSpan___eq__(*args
, **kwargs
)
12668 def __ne__(*args
, **kwargs
):
12669 """__ne__(self, GBSpan other) -> bool"""
12670 return _core_
.GBSpan___ne__(*args
, **kwargs
)
12672 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
12673 """Set(self, int rowspan=1, int colspan=1)"""
12674 return _core_
.GBSpan_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
12676 def Get(*args
, **kwargs
):
12677 """Get(self) -> PyObject"""
12678 return _core_
.GBSpan_Get(*args
, **kwargs
)
12680 asTuple
= wx
._deprecated
(Get
, "asTuple is deprecated, use `Get` instead")
12681 def __str__(self
): return str(self
.Get())
12682 def __repr__(self
): return 'wx.GBSpan'+str(self
.Get())
12683 def __len__(self
): return len(self
.Get())
12684 def __getitem__(self
, index
): return self
.Get()[index
]
12685 def __setitem__(self
, index
, val
):
12686 if index
== 0: self
.SetRowspan(val
)
12687 elif index
== 1: self
.SetColspan(val
)
12688 else: raise IndexError
12689 def __nonzero__(self
): return self
.Get() != (0,0)
12690 __safe_for_unpickling__
= True
12691 def __reduce__(self
): return (wx
.GBSpan
, self
.Get())
12693 rowspan
= property(GetRowspan
, SetRowspan
)
12694 colspan
= property(GetColspan
, SetColspan
)
12697 class GBSpanPtr(GBSpan
):
12698 def __init__(self
, this
):
12700 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12701 self
.__class
__ = GBSpan
12702 _core_
.GBSpan_swigregister(GBSpanPtr
)
12704 class GBSizerItem(SizerItem
):
12706 The wx.GBSizerItem class is used to track the additional data about
12707 items in a `wx.GridBagSizer` such as the item's position in the grid
12708 and how many rows or columns it spans.
12711 def __repr__(self
):
12712 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxGBSizerItem instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12713 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12715 __init__(self) -> GBSizerItem
12717 Constructs an empty wx.GBSizerItem. Either a window, sizer or spacer
12718 size will need to be set, as well as a position and span before this
12719 item can be used in a Sizer.
12721 You will probably never need to create a wx.GBSizerItem directly as they
12722 are created automatically when the sizer's Add method is called.
12724 newobj
= _core_
.new_GBSizerItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
12725 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12728 def GetPos(*args
, **kwargs
):
12730 GetPos(self) -> GBPosition
12732 Get the grid position of the item
12734 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_GetPos(*args
, **kwargs
)
12736 def GetPosTuple(self
): return self
.GetPos().Get()
12737 def GetSpan(*args
, **kwargs
):
12739 GetSpan(self) -> GBSpan
12741 Get the row and column spanning of the item
12743 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_GetSpan(*args
, **kwargs
)
12745 def GetSpanTuple(self
): return self
.GetSpan().Get()
12746 def SetPos(*args
, **kwargs
):
12748 SetPos(self, GBPosition pos) -> bool
12750 If the item is already a member of a sizer then first ensure that
12751 there is no other item that would intersect with this one at the new
12752 position, then set the new position. Returns True if the change is
12753 successful and after the next Layout() the item will be moved.
12755 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_SetPos(*args
, **kwargs
)
12757 def SetSpan(*args
, **kwargs
):
12759 SetSpan(self, GBSpan span) -> bool
12761 If the item is already a member of a sizer then first ensure that
12762 there is no other item that would intersect with this one with its new
12763 spanning size, then set the new spanning. Returns True if the change
12764 is successful and after the next Layout() the item will be resized.
12767 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_SetSpan(*args
, **kwargs
)
12769 def Intersects(*args
, **kwargs
):
12771 Intersects(self, GBSizerItem other) -> bool
12773 Returns True if this item and the other item instersect.
12775 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_Intersects(*args
, **kwargs
)
12777 def IntersectsPos(*args
, **kwargs
):
12779 IntersectsPos(self, GBPosition pos, GBSpan span) -> bool
12781 Returns True if the given pos/span would intersect with this item.
12783 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_IntersectsPos(*args
, **kwargs
)
12785 def GetEndPos(*args
, **kwargs
):
12787 GetEndPos(self) -> GBPosition
12789 Get the row and column of the endpoint of this item.
12791 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_GetEndPos(*args
, **kwargs
)
12793 def GetGBSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
12795 GetGBSizer(self) -> GridBagSizer
12797 Get the sizer this item is a member of.
12799 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_GetGBSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12801 def SetGBSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
12803 SetGBSizer(self, GridBagSizer sizer)
12805 Set the sizer this item is a member of.
12807 return _core_
.GBSizerItem_SetGBSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12810 class GBSizerItemPtr(GBSizerItem
):
12811 def __init__(self
, this
):
12813 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
12814 self
.__class
__ = GBSizerItem
12815 _core_
.GBSizerItem_swigregister(GBSizerItemPtr
)
12816 DefaultSpan
= cvar
.DefaultSpan
12818 def GBSizerItemWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
12820 GBSizerItemWindow(Window window, GBPosition pos, GBSpan span, int flag,
12821 int border, PyObject userData=None) -> GBSizerItem
12823 Construct a `wx.GBSizerItem` for a window.
12825 val
= _core_
.new_GBSizerItemWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
12829 def GBSizerItemSizer(*args
, **kwargs
):
12831 GBSizerItemSizer(Sizer sizer, GBPosition pos, GBSpan span, int flag,
12832 int border, PyObject userData=None) -> GBSizerItem
12834 Construct a `wx.GBSizerItem` for a sizer
12836 val
= _core_
.new_GBSizerItemSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12840 def GBSizerItemSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
):
12842 GBSizerItemSpacer(int width, int height, GBPosition pos, GBSpan span,
12843 int flag, int border, PyObject userData=None) -> GBSizerItem
12845 Construct a `wx.GBSizerItem` for a spacer.
12847 val
= _core_
.new_GBSizerItemSpacer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12851 class GridBagSizer(FlexGridSizer
):
12853 A `wx.Sizer` that can lay out items in a virtual grid like a
12854 `wx.FlexGridSizer` but in this case explicit positioning of the items
12855 is allowed using `wx.GBPosition`, and items can optionally span more
12856 than one row and/or column using `wx.GBSpan`. The total size of the
12857 virtual grid is determined by the largest row and column that items are
12858 positioned at, adjusted for spanning.
12861 def __repr__(self
):
12862 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxGridBagSizer instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
12863 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
12865 __init__(self, int vgap=0, int hgap=0) -> GridBagSizer
12867 Constructor, with optional parameters to specify the gap between the
12870 newobj
= _core_
.new_GridBagSizer(*args
, **kwargs
)
12871 self
.this
= newobj
.this
12874 self
._setOORInfo
(self
)
12876 def Add(*args
, **kwargs
):
12878 Add(self, item, GBPosition pos, GBSpan span=DefaultSpan, int flag=0,
12879 int border=0, userData=None) -> wx.GBSizerItem
12881 Adds an item to the sizer at the grid cell *pos*, optionally spanning
12882 more than one row or column as specified with *span*. The remaining
12883 args behave similarly to `wx.Sizer.Add`.
12885 Returns True if the item was successfully placed at the given cell
12886 position, False if something was already there.
12889 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_Add(*args
, **kwargs
)
12891 def AddItem(*args
, **kwargs
):
12893 Add(self, GBSizerItem item) -> wx.GBSizerItem
12895 Add an item to the sizer using a `wx.GBSizerItem`. Returns True if
12896 the item was successfully placed at its given cell position, False if
12897 something was already there.
12899 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_AddItem(*args
, **kwargs
)
12901 def GetCellSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
12903 GetCellSize(self, int row, int col) -> Size
12905 Get the size of the specified cell, including hgap and
12906 vgap. Only valid after a Layout.
12908 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_GetCellSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
12910 def GetEmptyCellSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
12912 GetEmptyCellSize(self) -> Size
12914 Get the size used for cells in the grid with no item.
12916 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_GetEmptyCellSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
12918 def SetEmptyCellSize(*args
, **kwargs
):
12920 SetEmptyCellSize(self, Size sz)
12922 Set the size used for cells in the grid with no item.
12924 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_SetEmptyCellSize(*args
, **kwargs
)
12926 def GetItemPosition(*args
):
12928 GetItemPosition(self, item) -> GBPosition
12930 Get the grid position of the specified *item* where *item* is either a
12931 window or subsizer that is a member of this sizer, or a zero-based
12934 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_GetItemPosition(*args
)
12936 def SetItemPosition(*args
):
12938 SetItemPosition(self, item, GBPosition pos) -> bool
12940 Set the grid position of the specified *item* where *item* is either a
12941 window or subsizer that is a member of this sizer, or a zero-based
12942 index of an item. Returns True on success. If the move is not
12943 allowed (because an item is already there) then False is returned.
12946 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_SetItemPosition(*args
)
12948 def GetItemSpan(*args
):
12950 GetItemSpan(self, item) -> GBSpan
12952 Get the row/col spanning of the specified *item* where *item* is
12953 either a window or subsizer that is a member of this sizer, or a
12954 zero-based index of an item.
12956 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_GetItemSpan(*args
)
12958 def SetItemSpan(*args
):
12960 SetItemSpan(self, item, GBSpan span) -> bool
12962 Set the row/col spanning of the specified *item* where *item* is
12963 either a window or subsizer that is a member of this sizer, or a
12964 zero-based index of an item. Returns True on success. If the move is
12965 not allowed (because an item is already there) then False is returned.
12967 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_SetItemSpan(*args
)
12969 def FindItem(*args
):
12971 FindItem(self, item) -> GBSizerItem
12973 Find the sizer item for the given window or subsizer, returns None if
12974 not found. (non-recursive)
12976 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_FindItem(*args
)
12978 def FindItemAtPosition(*args
, **kwargs
):
12980 FindItemAtPosition(self, GBPosition pos) -> GBSizerItem
12982 Return the sizer item for the given grid cell, or None if there is no
12983 item at that position. (non-recursive)
12985 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_FindItemAtPosition(*args
, **kwargs
)
12987 def FindItemAtPoint(*args
, **kwargs
):
12989 FindItemAtPoint(self, Point pt) -> GBSizerItem
12991 Return the sizer item located at the point given in *pt*, or None if
12992 there is no item at that point. The (x,y) coordinates in pt correspond
12993 to the client coordinates of the window using the sizer for
12994 layout. (non-recursive)
12996 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_FindItemAtPoint(*args
, **kwargs
)
12998 def CheckForIntersection(*args
, **kwargs
):
13000 CheckForIntersection(self, GBSizerItem item, GBSizerItem excludeItem=None) -> bool
13002 Look at all items and see if any intersect (or would overlap) the
13003 given *item*. Returns True if so, False if there would be no overlap.
13004 If an *excludeItem* is given then it will not be checked for
13005 intersection, for example it may be the item we are checking the
13009 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_CheckForIntersection(*args
, **kwargs
)
13011 def CheckForIntersectionPos(*args
, **kwargs
):
13013 CheckForIntersectionPos(self, GBPosition pos, GBSpan span, GBSizerItem excludeItem=None) -> bool
13015 Look at all items and see if any intersect (or would overlap) the
13016 given position and span. Returns True if so, False if there would be
13017 no overlap. If an *excludeItem* is given then it will not be checked
13018 for intersection, for example it may be the item we are checking the
13021 return _core_
.GridBagSizer_CheckForIntersectionPos(*args
, **kwargs
)
13024 class GridBagSizerPtr(GridBagSizer
):
13025 def __init__(self
, this
):
13027 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
13028 self
.__class
__ = GridBagSizer
13029 _core_
.GridBagSizer_swigregister(GridBagSizerPtr
)
13031 #---------------------------------------------------------------------------
13035 Right
= _core_
.Right
13036 Bottom
= _core_
.Bottom
13037 Width
= _core_
.Width
13038 Height
= _core_
.Height
13039 Centre
= _core_
.Centre
13040 Center
= _core_
.Center
13041 CentreX
= _core_
.CentreX
13042 CentreY
= _core_
.CentreY
13043 Unconstrained
= _core_
.Unconstrained
13045 PercentOf
= _core_
.PercentOf
13046 Above
= _core_
.Above
13047 Below
= _core_
.Below
13048 LeftOf
= _core_
.LeftOf
13049 RightOf
= _core_
.RightOf
13050 SameAs
= _core_
.SameAs
13051 Absolute
= _core_
.Absolute
13052 class IndividualLayoutConstraint(Object
):
13054 Objects of this class are stored in the `wx.LayoutConstraints` class as
13055 one of eight possible constraints that a window can be involved in.
13056 You will never need to create an instance of
13057 wx.IndividualLayoutConstraint, rather you should create a
13058 `wx.LayoutConstraints` instance and use the individual contstraints
13061 def __init__(self
): raise RuntimeError, "No constructor defined"
13062 def __repr__(self
):
13063 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxIndividualLayoutConstraint instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
13064 def Set(*args
, **kwargs
):
13066 Set(self, int rel, Window otherW, int otherE, int val=0, int marg=wxLAYOUT_DEFAULT_MARGIN)
13068 Sets the properties of the constraint. Normally called by one of the
13069 convenience functions such as Above, RightOf, SameAs.
13071 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_Set(*args
, **kwargs
)
13073 def LeftOf(*args
, **kwargs
):
13075 LeftOf(self, Window sibling, int marg=0)
13077 Constrains this edge to be to the left of the given window, with an
13078 optional margin. Implicitly, this is relative to the left edge of the
13081 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_LeftOf(*args
, **kwargs
)
13083 def RightOf(*args
, **kwargs
):
13085 RightOf(self, Window sibling, int marg=0)
13087 Constrains this edge to be to the right of the given window, with an
13088 optional margin. Implicitly, this is relative to the right edge of the
13091 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_RightOf(*args
, **kwargs
)
13093 def Above(*args
, **kwargs
):
13095 Above(self, Window sibling, int marg=0)
13097 Constrains this edge to be above the given window, with an optional
13098 margin. Implicitly, this is relative to the top edge of the other
13101 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_Above(*args
, **kwargs
)
13103 def Below(*args
, **kwargs
):
13105 Below(self, Window sibling, int marg=0)
13107 Constrains this edge to be below the given window, with an optional
13108 margin. Implicitly, this is relative to the bottom edge of the other
13111 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_Below(*args
, **kwargs
)
13113 def SameAs(*args
, **kwargs
):
13115 SameAs(self, Window otherW, int edge, int marg=0)
13117 Constrains this edge or dimension to be to the same as the edge of the
13118 given window, with an optional margin.
13120 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_SameAs(*args
, **kwargs
)
13122 def PercentOf(*args
, **kwargs
):
13124 PercentOf(self, Window otherW, int wh, int per)
13126 Constrains this edge or dimension to be to a percentage of the given
13127 window, with an optional margin.
13129 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_PercentOf(*args
, **kwargs
)
13131 def Absolute(*args
, **kwargs
):
13133 Absolute(self, int val)
13135 Constrains this edge or dimension to be the given absolute value.
13137 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_Absolute(*args
, **kwargs
)
13139 def Unconstrained(*args
, **kwargs
):
13141 Unconstrained(self)
13143 Sets this edge or dimension to be unconstrained, that is, dependent on
13144 other edges and dimensions from which this value can be deduced.
13146 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_Unconstrained(*args
, **kwargs
)
13148 def AsIs(*args
, **kwargs
):
13152 Sets this edge or constraint to be whatever the window's value is at
13153 the moment. If either of the width and height constraints are *as is*,
13154 the window will not be resized, but moved instead. This is important
13155 when considering panel items which are intended to have a default
13156 size, such as a button, which may take its size from the size of the
13159 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_AsIs(*args
, **kwargs
)
13161 def GetOtherWindow(*args
, **kwargs
):
13162 """GetOtherWindow(self) -> Window"""
13163 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetOtherWindow(*args
, **kwargs
)
13165 def GetMyEdge(*args
, **kwargs
):
13166 """GetMyEdge(self) -> int"""
13167 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetMyEdge(*args
, **kwargs
)
13169 def SetEdge(*args
, **kwargs
):
13170 """SetEdge(self, int which)"""
13171 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_SetEdge(*args
, **kwargs
)
13173 def SetValue(*args
, **kwargs
):
13174 """SetValue(self, int v)"""
13175 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_SetValue(*args
, **kwargs
)
13177 def GetMargin(*args
, **kwargs
):
13178 """GetMargin(self) -> int"""
13179 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetMargin(*args
, **kwargs
)
13181 def SetMargin(*args
, **kwargs
):
13182 """SetMargin(self, int m)"""
13183 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_SetMargin(*args
, **kwargs
)
13185 def GetValue(*args
, **kwargs
):
13186 """GetValue(self) -> int"""
13187 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetValue(*args
, **kwargs
)
13189 def GetPercent(*args
, **kwargs
):
13190 """GetPercent(self) -> int"""
13191 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetPercent(*args
, **kwargs
)
13193 def GetOtherEdge(*args
, **kwargs
):
13194 """GetOtherEdge(self) -> int"""
13195 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetOtherEdge(*args
, **kwargs
)
13197 def GetDone(*args
, **kwargs
):
13198 """GetDone(self) -> bool"""
13199 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetDone(*args
, **kwargs
)
13201 def SetDone(*args
, **kwargs
):
13202 """SetDone(self, bool d)"""
13203 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_SetDone(*args
, **kwargs
)
13205 def GetRelationship(*args
, **kwargs
):
13206 """GetRelationship(self) -> int"""
13207 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetRelationship(*args
, **kwargs
)
13209 def SetRelationship(*args
, **kwargs
):
13210 """SetRelationship(self, int r)"""
13211 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_SetRelationship(*args
, **kwargs
)
13213 def ResetIfWin(*args
, **kwargs
):
13215 ResetIfWin(self, Window otherW) -> bool
13217 Reset constraint if it mentions otherWin
13219 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_ResetIfWin(*args
, **kwargs
)
13221 def SatisfyConstraint(*args
, **kwargs
):
13223 SatisfyConstraint(self, LayoutConstraints constraints, Window win) -> bool
13225 Try to satisfy constraint
13227 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_SatisfyConstraint(*args
, **kwargs
)
13229 def GetEdge(*args
, **kwargs
):
13231 GetEdge(self, int which, Window thisWin, Window other) -> int
13233 Get the value of this edge or dimension, or if this
13234 is not determinable, -1.
13236 return _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_GetEdge(*args
, **kwargs
)
13239 class IndividualLayoutConstraintPtr(IndividualLayoutConstraint
):
13240 def __init__(self
, this
):
13242 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
13243 self
.__class
__ = IndividualLayoutConstraint
13244 _core_
.IndividualLayoutConstraint_swigregister(IndividualLayoutConstraintPtr
)
13246 class LayoutConstraints(Object
):
13248 **Note:** constraints are now deprecated and you should use sizers
13251 Objects of this class can be associated with a window to define its
13252 layout constraints, with respect to siblings or its parent.
13254 The class consists of the following eight constraints of class
13255 wx.IndividualLayoutConstraint, some or all of which should be accessed
13256 directly to set the appropriate constraints.
13258 * left: represents the left hand edge of the window
13259 * right: represents the right hand edge of the window
13260 * top: represents the top edge of the window
13261 * bottom: represents the bottom edge of the window
13262 * width: represents the width of the window
13263 * height: represents the height of the window
13264 * centreX: represents the horizontal centre point of the window
13265 * centreY: represents the vertical centre point of the window
13267 Most constraints are initially set to have the relationship
13268 wxUnconstrained, which means that their values should be calculated by
13269 looking at known constraints. The exceptions are width and height,
13270 which are set to wxAsIs to ensure that if the user does not specify a
13271 constraint, the existing width and height will be used, to be
13272 compatible with panel items which often have take a default size. If
13273 the constraint is ``wx.AsIs``, the dimension will not be changed.
13275 :see: `wx.IndividualLayoutConstraint`, `wx.Window.SetConstraints`
13278 def __repr__(self
):
13279 return "<%s.%s; proxy of C++ wxLayoutConstraints instance at %s>" % (self
.__class
__.__module
__, self
.__class
__.__name
__, self
.this
,)
13280 left
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_left_get
)
13281 top
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_top_get
)
13282 right
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_right_get
)
13283 bottom
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_bottom_get
)
13284 width
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_width_get
)
13285 height
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_height_get
)
13286 centreX
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_centreX_get
)
13287 centreY
= property(_core_
.LayoutConstraints_centreY_get
)
13288 def __init__(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
13289 """__init__(self) -> LayoutConstraints"""
13290 newobj
= _core_
.new_LayoutConstraints(*args
, **kwargs
)
13291 self
.this
= newobj
.this
13294 def SatisfyConstraints(*args
, **kwargs
):
13295 """SatisfyConstraints(Window win) -> (areSatisfied, noChanges)"""
13296 return _core_
.LayoutConstraints_SatisfyConstraints(*args
, **kwargs
)
13298 def AreSatisfied(*args
, **kwargs
):
13299 """AreSatisfied(self) -> bool"""
13300 return _core_
.LayoutConstraints_AreSatisfied(*args
, **kwargs
)
13303 class LayoutConstraintsPtr(LayoutConstraints
):
13304 def __init__(self
, this
):
13306 if not hasattr(self
,"thisown"): self
.thisown
= 0
13307 self
.__class
__ = LayoutConstraints
13308 _core_
.LayoutConstraints_swigregister(LayoutConstraintsPtr
)
13310 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13312 # Use Python's bool constants if available, make some if not
13316 __builtins__
.True = 1==1
13317 __builtins__
.False = 1==0
13318 def bool(value
): return not not value
13319 __builtins__
.bool = bool
13323 # workarounds for bad wxRTTI names
13324 __wxPyPtrTypeMap
['wxGauge95'] = 'wxGauge'
13325 __wxPyPtrTypeMap
['wxSlider95'] = 'wxSlider'
13326 __wxPyPtrTypeMap
['wxStatusBar95'] = 'wxStatusBar'
13329 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13330 # Load version numbers from __version__... Ensure that major and minor
13331 # versions are the same for both wxPython and wxWidgets.
13333 from __version__
import *
13334 __version__
= VERSION_STRING
13336 assert MAJOR_VERSION
== _core_
.MAJOR_VERSION
, "wxPython/wxWidgets version mismatch"
13337 assert MINOR_VERSION
== _core_
.MINOR_VERSION
, "wxPython/wxWidgets version mismatch"
13338 if RELEASE_VERSION
!= _core_
.RELEASE_VERSION
:
13340 warnings
.warn("wxPython/wxWidgets release number mismatch")
13342 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13344 # Set wxPython's default string<-->unicode conversion encoding from
13345 # the locale, but only if Python's default hasn't been changed. (We
13346 # assume that if the user has customized it already then that is the
13347 # encoding we need to use as well.)
13349 # The encoding selected here is used when string or unicode objects
13350 # need to be converted in order to pass them to wxWidgets. Please be
13351 # aware that the default encoding within the same locale may be
13352 # slightly different on different platforms. For example, please see
13353 # http://www.alanwood.net/demos/charsetdiffs.html for differences
13354 # between the common latin/roman encodings.
13356 default
= _sys
.getdefaultencoding()
13357 if default
== 'ascii':
13361 default
= locale
.getdefaultlocale()[1]
13362 codecs
.lookup(default
)
13363 except (ValueError, LookupError, TypeError):
13364 default
= _sys
.getdefaultencoding()
13368 wx
.SetDefaultPyEncoding(default
)
13371 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13373 class PyDeadObjectError(AttributeError):
13376 class _wxPyDeadObject(object):
13378 Instances of wx objects that are OOR capable will have their __class__
13379 changed to this class when the C++ object is deleted. This should help
13380 prevent crashes due to referencing a bogus C++ pointer.
13382 reprStr
= "wxPython wrapper for DELETED %s object! (The C++ object no longer exists.)"
13383 attrStr
= "The C++ part of the %s object has been deleted, attribute access no longer allowed."
13385 def __repr__(self
):
13386 if not hasattr(self
, "_name"):
13387 self
._name
= "[unknown]"
13388 return self
.reprStr
% self
._name
13390 def __getattr__(self
, *args
):
13391 if not hasattr(self
, "_name"):
13392 self
._name
= "[unknown]"
13393 raise PyDeadObjectError(self
.attrStr
% self
._name
)
13395 def __nonzero__(self
):
13400 class PyUnbornObjectError(AttributeError):
13403 class _wxPyUnbornObject(object):
13405 Some stock objects are created when the wx._core module is
13406 imported, but their C++ instance is not created until the wx.App
13407 object is created and initialized. These object instances will
13408 temporarily have their __class__ changed to this class so an
13409 exception will be raised if they are used before the C++ instance
13413 reprStr
= "wxPython wrapper for UNBORN object! (The C++ object is not initialized yet.)"
13414 attrStr
= "The C++ part of this object has not been initialized, attribute access not allowed."
13416 def __repr__(self
):
13417 #if not hasattr(self, "_name"):
13418 # self._name = "[unknown]"
13419 return self
.reprStr
#% self._name
13421 def __getattr__(self
, *args
):
13422 #if not hasattr(self, "_name"):
13423 # self._name = "[unknown]"
13424 raise PyUnbornObjectError(self
.attrStr
) # % self._name )
13426 def __nonzero__(self
):
13430 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13432 def CallAfter(callable, *args
, **kw
):
13434 Call the specified function after the current and pending event
13435 handlers have been completed. This is also good for making GUI
13436 method calls from non-GUI threads. Any extra positional or
13437 keyword args are passed on to the callable when it is called.
13439 :see: `wx.FutureCall`
13442 assert app
is not None, 'No wx.App created yet'
13444 if not hasattr(app
, "_CallAfterId"):
13445 app
._CallAfterId
= wx
.NewEventType()
13446 app
.Connect(-1, -1, app
._CallAfterId
,
13447 lambda event
: event
.callable(*event
.args
, **event
.kw
) )
13449 evt
.SetEventType(app
._CallAfterId
)
13450 evt
.callable = callable
13453 wx
.PostEvent(app
, evt
)
13455 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13460 A convenience class for `wx.Timer`, that calls the given callable
13461 object once after the given amount of milliseconds, passing any
13462 positional or keyword args. The return value of the callable is
13463 availbale after it has been run with the `GetResult` method.
13465 If you don't need to get the return value or restart the timer
13466 then there is no need to hold a reference to this object. It will
13467 hold a reference to itself while the timer is running (the timer
13468 has a reference to self.Notify) but the cycle will be broken when
13469 the timer completes, automatically cleaning up the wx.FutureCall
13472 :see: `wx.CallAfter`
13474 def __init__(self
, millis
, callable, *args
, **kwargs
):
13475 self
.millis
= millis
13476 self
.callable = callable
13477 self
.SetArgs(*args
, **kwargs
)
13479 self
.running
= False
13480 self
.hasRun
= False
13489 def Start(self
, millis
=None, *args
, **kwargs
):
13491 (Re)start the timer
13493 self
.hasRun
= False
13494 if millis
is not None:
13495 self
.millis
= millis
13497 self
.SetArgs(*args
, **kwargs
)
13499 self
.timer
= wx
.PyTimer(self
.Notify
)
13500 self
.timer
.Start(self
.millis
, wx
.TIMER_ONE_SHOT
)
13501 self
.running
= True
13507 Stop and destroy the timer.
13509 if self
.timer
is not None:
13514 def GetInterval(self
):
13515 if self
.timer
is not None:
13516 return self
.timer
.GetInterval()
13521 def IsRunning(self
):
13522 return self
.timer
is not None and self
.timer
.IsRunning()
13525 def SetArgs(self
, *args
, **kwargs
):
13527 (Re)set the args passed to the callable object. This is
13528 useful in conjunction with Restart if you want to schedule a
13529 new call to the same callable object but with different
13533 self
.kwargs
= kwargs
13539 def GetResult(self
):
13544 The timer has expired so call the callable.
13546 if self
.callable and getattr(self
.callable, 'im_self', True):
13548 self
.running
= False
13549 self
.result
= self
.callable(*self
.args
, **self
.kwargs
)
13551 if not self
.running
:
13552 # if it wasn't restarted, then cleanup
13553 wx
.CallAfter(self
.Stop
)
13557 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13558 # Control which items in this module should be documented by epydoc.
13559 # We allow only classes and functions, which will help reduce the size
13560 # of the docs by filtering out the zillions of constants, EVT objects,
13561 # and etc that don't make much sense by themselves, but are instead
13562 # documented (or will be) as part of the classes/functions/methods
13563 # where they should be used.
13567 A filter for epydoc that only allows non-Ptr classes and
13568 fucntions, in order to reduce the clutter in the API docs.
13570 def __init__(self
, globals):
13571 self
._globals
= globals
13573 def __call__(self
, name
):
13575 obj
= self
._globals
.get(name
, None)
13576 if type(obj
) not in [type, types
.ClassType
, types
.FunctionType
, types
.BuiltinFunctionType
]:
13578 if name
.startswith('_') or name
.endswith('Ptr') or name
.startswith('EVT'):
13582 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13583 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13585 # Import other modules in this package that should show up in the
13586 # "core" wx namespace
13588 from _windows
import *
13589 from _controls
import *
13590 from _misc
import *
13593 # Fixup the stock objects since they can't be used yet. (They will be
13594 # restored in wx.PyApp.OnInit.)
13595 _core_
._wxPyFixStockObjects
()
13597 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------
13598 #----------------------------------------------------------------------------